summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/usr/dash
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorDaniel Baumann <daniel.baumann@progress-linux.org>2024-04-19 17:06:04 +0000
committerDaniel Baumann <daniel.baumann@progress-linux.org>2024-04-19 17:06:04 +0000
commit2f0649f6fe411d7e07c8d56cf8ea56db53536da8 (patch)
tree778611fb52176dce1ad06c68e87b2cb348ca0f7b /usr/dash
parentInitial commit. (diff)
downloadklibc-upstream.tar.xz
klibc-upstream.zip
Adding upstream version 2.0.13.upstream/2.0.13upstream
Signed-off-by: Daniel Baumann <daniel.baumann@progress-linux.org>
Diffstat (limited to 'usr/dash')
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/.gitignore13
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/Kbuild103
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/README.dash50
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/TOUR343
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/alias.c227
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/alias.h52
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/arith_yacc.c304
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/arith_yacc.h89
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/arith_yylex.c240
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/bltin/bltin.h89
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/bltin/echo.1109
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/bltin/printf.1354
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/bltin/printf.c470
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/bltin/test.1309
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/bltin/test.c543
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/builtins.def.in93
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/cd.c313
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/cd.h35
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/config.h191
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/error.c232
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/error.h133
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/eval.c1092
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/eval.h59
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/exec.c859
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/exec.h77
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/expand.c1728
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/expand.h88
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/cmv47
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/dirs71
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/kill47
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/login36
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/newgrp35
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/popd71
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/pushd71
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/funcs/suspend39
-rwxr-xr-xusr/dash/gendeps.pl38
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/hetio.c397
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/hetio.h22
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/histedit.c494
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/init.h39
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/input.c532
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/input.h66
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/jobs.c1504
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/jobs.h109
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/machdep.h53
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mail.c112
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mail.h38
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/main.c346
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/main.h54
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/memalloc.c302
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/memalloc.h100
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/miscbltin.c583
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/miscbltin.h31
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mkbuiltins115
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mkinit.c479
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mknodes.c448
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mksyntax.c315
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mktokens92
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/myhistedit.h45
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mystring.c257
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/mystring.h63
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/nodes.c.pat166
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/nodetypes151
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/options.c559
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/options.h86
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/output.c399
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/output.h123
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/parser.c1568
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/parser.h93
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/redir.c459
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/redir.h53
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/sh.12332
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/shell.h104
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/show.c406
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/show.h45
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/system.c199
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/system.h101
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/trap.c467
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/trap.h58
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/var.c710
-rw-r--r--usr/dash/var.h173
81 files changed, 23498 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/usr/dash/.gitignore b/usr/dash/.gitignore
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..480952f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/.gitignore
@@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
+arith.[ch]
+.builtins.def.d
+builtins.[ch]
+builtins.def
+init.c
+mkinit
+mknodes
+mksyntax
+nodes.[ch]
+sh
+sh.shared
+syntax.[ch]
+token.h
diff --git a/usr/dash/Kbuild b/usr/dash/Kbuild
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c0f8dcb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/Kbuild
@@ -0,0 +1,103 @@
+#
+# Kbuild file for dash
+#
+
+config-cppflags := -DBSD=1 -DSMALL -DJOBS=0 -DHAVE_CONFIG_H -DSHELL
+config-cppflags += -DGLOB_BROKEN -DIFS_BROKEN
+
+EXTRA_KLIBCCFLAGS := -I$(srctree)/$(src) -I$(objtree)/$(obj)
+EXTRA_KLIBCCFLAGS += -include $(srctree)/$(src)/config.h
+EXTRA_KLIBCCFLAGS += $(config-cppflags)
+
+HOST_EXTRACFLAGS := $(config-cppflags)
+
+init-o-files := alias.o arith_yacc.o arith_yylex.o cd.o error.o eval.o exec.o expand.o \
+ histedit.o input.o jobs.o mail.o main.o memalloc.o miscbltin.o \
+ mystring.o options.o parser.o redir.o show.o trap.o output.o \
+ bltin/printf.o system.o bltin/test.o var.o
+
+gen-o-files := builtins.o init.o nodes.o syntax.o
+
+static/sh-y := $(init-o-files) $(gen-o-files)
+
+hostprogs-y := mkinit mksyntax mknodes mksignames
+gen-h-files := builtins.h nodes.h syntax.h token.h
+
+static-y := static/sh
+
+# The shared binary
+shared-y := shared/sh
+shared/sh-y := $(static/sh-y)
+
+# For cleaning
+targets := static/sh static/sh.g shared/sh shared/sh.g $(gen-o-files)
+
+# explicit dependency for all generated files
+$(addprefix $(obj)/, $(static/sh-y)): $(addprefix $(obj)/, $(gen-h-files))
+
+# Generate token.h
+targets += token.h
+quiet_cmd_mktokens = GEN $@
+ cmd_mktokens = sh $< > $@
+$(obj)/token.h: $(src)/mktokens
+ $(call if_changed,mktokens)
+
+# Generate builtins.def
+targets += builtins.def
+quiet_cmd_mkbuiltins_def = GEN $@
+ cmd_mkbuiltins_def = $(HOSTCC) $(hostc_flags) -x c -E -o $@ $<
+$(obj)/builtins.def: $(src)/builtins.def.in $(src)/config.h
+ $(call if_changed,mkbuiltins_def)
+
+# Generate builtins{.c + .h}
+targets += builtins.c builtins.h
+quiet_cmd_mkbuiltins = GEN $@
+ cmd_mkbuiltins = mkdir -p $(obj)/bltin && cd $(obj) && \
+ sh $(srctree)/$(src)/mkbuiltins builtins.def
+$(obj)/builtins.c: $(src)/mkbuiltins $(obj)/builtins.def
+ $(call cmd,mkbuiltins)
+
+# side effect..
+$(obj)/builtins.h: $(obj)/builtins.c
+ $(Q):
+
+# Generate init.c
+targets += init.c
+init-c-files := $(addprefix $(srctree)/$(src)/, $(init-o-files:.o=.c))
+quiet_cmd_mkinit = GEN $@
+ cmd_mkinit = cd $(obj) && ./mkinit $(init-c-files)
+$(obj)/init.c: $(obj)/mkinit $(init-c-files)
+ $(call cmd,mkinit)
+
+# Generate nodes{.c + .h}
+targets += nodes.c nodes.h
+quiet_cmd_mknodes = GEN $@
+ cmd_mknodes = cd $(obj) && ./mknodes $(srctree)/$(src)/nodetypes \
+ $(srctree)/$(src)/nodes.c.pat
+$(obj)/nodes.c: $(obj)/mknodes $(src)/nodetypes $(src)/nodes.c.pat
+ $(call cmd,mknodes)
+
+# side effect..
+$(obj)/nodes.h: $(obj)/nodes.c
+ $(Q):
+
+# Generate syntax{.c + .h}
+targets += syntax.c syntax.h
+quiet_cmd_mksyntax = GEN $@
+ cmd_mksyntax = cd $(obj) && ./mksyntax
+$(obj)/syntax.c: $(obj)/mksyntax
+ $(call cmd,mksyntax)
+
+# side effect..
+$(obj)/syntax.h: $(obj)/syntax.c
+ $(Q):
+
+# Clean deletes the static and shared dir
+clean-dirs := static shared
+
+# Targets to install
+ifdef KLIBCSHAREDFLAGS
+install-y := shared/sh
+else
+install-y := static/sh
+endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/README.dash b/usr/dash/README.dash
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d67a5af
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/README.dash
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+This version of dash was obtained from
+
+git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/utils/dash/dash.git
+
+It corresponds up to changeset 46abc8c6d8a5e9a5712bdc1312c0b6960eec65a4
+omitting ee5cbe9fd6bc02f31b4d955606288de36c3d4eab.
+
+Several changes have been made for klibc:
+
+* The build system is changed from autotools to kbuild, with a static config.h
+* Use of strtod() is guarded by HAVE_STRTOD, which we don't define
+* The built-in times command, which requires floating-point support, is
+ disabled
+* The signal_names[] array is replaced by a signal_name() function using
+ klibc's own signal name array. decode_signal() is changed similarly.
+* The read built-in implements the -t option like bash
+* mktokens is modified to support out-of-tree builds
+* mkbuiltins is modified to sort with LC_ALL=C
+* Some header files have header guards added
+* Changelog and some manual pages are omitted
+* Automatic whitespace fixups
+
+HOWTO sync branch:
+
+1) Generate mailbox of patches and fix up their paths:
+
+ git format-patch --subject-prefix='' -N --stdout <changeset>.. \
+ | awk '(FNR == 1 || blank) && /^From / { header = 1; hash = $2 }
+ header && /^Subject:/ { sub("^Subject:", "Subject: [klibc] dash:") }
+ { print; blank = /^$/ }
+ header && blank {
+ print "[ dash commit", hash, "]"; print
+ header = 0
+ }' \
+ | filterdiff --strip 2 --addoldprefix a/usr/dash/ --addnewprefix b/usr/dash/ \
+ --exclude="*/configure.ac" --exclude="*/ChangeLog" \
+ --exclude="*/dash.1" --exclude="*/Makefile.am" \
+ --exclude="*/mksignames.c" \
+ > dash.mbox
+
+2) Import patches from mailbox:
+
+ git am --whitespace=fix -k -i -s ../dash/dash.mbox
+
+3) update config.h
+
+Generate klibc config.h in dash repository:
+ automake --add-missing
+ autoreconf
+ ./configure CC=klcc
diff --git a/usr/dash/TOUR b/usr/dash/TOUR
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..056e79b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/TOUR
@@ -0,0 +1,343 @@
+# @(#)TOUR 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+NOTE -- This is the original TOUR paper distributed with ash and
+does not represent the current state of the shell. It is provided anyway
+since it provides helpful information for how the shell is structured,
+but be warned that things have changed -- the current shell is
+still under development.
+
+================================================================
+
+ A Tour through Ash
+
+ Copyright 1989 by Kenneth Almquist.
+
+
+DIRECTORIES: The subdirectory bltin contains commands which can
+be compiled stand-alone. The rest of the source is in the main
+ash directory.
+
+SOURCE CODE GENERATORS: Files whose names begin with "mk" are
+programs that generate source code. A complete list of these
+programs is:
+
+ program intput files generates
+ ------- ------------ ---------
+ mkbuiltins builtins builtins.h builtins.c
+ mkinit *.c init.c
+ mknodes nodetypes nodes.h nodes.c
+ mksignames - signames.h signames.c
+ mksyntax - syntax.h syntax.c
+ mktokens - token.h
+ bltin/mkexpr unary_op binary_op operators.h operators.c
+
+There are undoubtedly too many of these. Mkinit searches all the
+C source files for entries looking like:
+
+ INIT {
+ x = 1; /* executed during initialization */
+ }
+
+ RESET {
+ x = 2; /* executed when the shell does a longjmp
+ back to the main command loop */
+ }
+
+It pulls this code out into routines which are when particular
+events occur. The intent is to improve modularity by isolating
+the information about which modules need to be explicitly
+initialized/reset within the modules themselves.
+
+Mkinit recognizes several constructs for placing declarations in
+the init.c file.
+ INCLUDE "file.h"
+includes a file. The storage class MKINIT makes a declaration
+available in the init.c file, for example:
+ MKINIT int funcnest; /* depth of function calls */
+MKINIT alone on a line introduces a structure or union declara-
+tion:
+ MKINIT
+ struct redirtab {
+ short renamed[10];
+ };
+Preprocessor #define statements are copied to init.c without any
+special action to request this.
+
+INDENTATION: The ash source is indented in multiples of six
+spaces. The only study that I have heard of on the subject con-
+cluded that the optimal amount to indent is in the range of four
+to six spaces. I use six spaces since it is not too big a jump
+from the widely used eight spaces. If you really hate six space
+indentation, use the adjind (source included) program to change
+it to something else.
+
+EXCEPTIONS: Code for dealing with exceptions appears in
+exceptions.c. The C language doesn't include exception handling,
+so I implement it using setjmp and longjmp. The global variable
+exception contains the type of exception. EXERROR is raised by
+calling error. EXINT is an interrupt.
+
+INTERRUPTS: In an interactive shell, an interrupt will cause an
+EXINT exception to return to the main command loop. (Exception:
+EXINT is not raised if the user traps interrupts using the trap
+command.) The INTOFF and INTON macros (defined in exception.h)
+provide uninterruptable critical sections. Between the execution
+of INTOFF and the execution of INTON, interrupt signals will be
+held for later delivery. INTOFF and INTON can be nested.
+
+MEMALLOC.C: Memalloc.c defines versions of malloc and realloc
+which call error when there is no memory left. It also defines a
+stack oriented memory allocation scheme. Allocating off a stack
+is probably more efficient than allocation using malloc, but the
+big advantage is that when an exception occurs all we have to do
+to free up the memory in use at the time of the exception is to
+restore the stack pointer. The stack is implemented using a
+linked list of blocks.
+
+STPUTC: If the stack were contiguous, it would be easy to store
+strings on the stack without knowing in advance how long the
+string was going to be:
+ p = stackptr;
+ *p++ = c; /* repeated as many times as needed */
+ stackptr = p;
+The folloing three macros (defined in memalloc.h) perform these
+operations, but grow the stack if you run off the end:
+ STARTSTACKSTR(p);
+ STPUTC(c, p); /* repeated as many times as needed */
+ grabstackstr(p);
+
+We now start a top-down look at the code:
+
+MAIN.C: The main routine performs some initialization, executes
+the user's profile if necessary, and calls cmdloop. Cmdloop is
+repeatedly parses and executes commands.
+
+OPTIONS.C: This file contains the option processing code. It is
+called from main to parse the shell arguments when the shell is
+invoked, and it also contains the set builtin. The -i and -j op-
+tions (the latter turns on job control) require changes in signal
+handling. The routines setjobctl (in jobs.c) and setinteractive
+(in trap.c) are called to handle changes to these options.
+
+PARSING: The parser code is all in parser.c. A recursive des-
+cent parser is used. Syntax tables (generated by mksyntax) are
+used to classify characters during lexical analysis. There are
+three tables: one for normal use, one for use when inside single
+quotes, and one for use when inside double quotes. The tables
+are machine dependent because they are indexed by character vari-
+ables and the range of a char varies from machine to machine.
+
+PARSE OUTPUT: The output of the parser consists of a tree of
+nodes. The various types of nodes are defined in the file node-
+types.
+
+Nodes of type NARG are used to represent both words and the con-
+tents of here documents. An early version of ash kept the con-
+tents of here documents in temporary files, but keeping here do-
+cuments in memory typically results in significantly better per-
+formance. It would have been nice to make it an option to use
+temporary files for here documents, for the benefit of small
+machines, but the code to keep track of when to delete the tem-
+porary files was complex and I never fixed all the bugs in it.
+(AT&T has been maintaining the Bourne shell for more than ten
+years, and to the best of my knowledge they still haven't gotten
+it to handle temporary files correctly in obscure cases.)
+
+The text field of a NARG structure points to the text of the
+word. The text consists of ordinary characters and a number of
+special codes defined in parser.h. The special codes are:
+
+ CTLVAR Variable substitution
+ CTLENDVAR End of variable substitution
+ CTLBACKQ Command substitution
+ CTLESC Escape next character
+
+A variable substitution contains the following elements:
+
+ CTLVAR type name '=' [ alternative-text CTLENDVAR ]
+
+The type field is a single character specifying the type of sub-
+stitution. The possible types are:
+
+ VSNORMAL $var
+ VSMINUS ${var-text}
+ VSMINUS|VSNUL ${var:-text}
+ VSPLUS ${var+text}
+ VSPLUS|VSNUL ${var:+text}
+ VSQUESTION ${var?text}
+ VSQUESTION|VSNUL ${var:?text}
+ VSASSIGN ${var=text}
+ VSASSIGN|VSNUL ${var=text}
+
+The name of the variable comes next, terminated by an equals
+sign. If the type is not VSNORMAL, then the text field in the
+substitution follows, terminated by a CTLENDVAR byte.
+
+Commands in back quotes are parsed and stored in a linked list.
+The locations of these commands in the string are indicated by
+the CTLBACKQ character.
+
+The character CTLESC escapes the next character, so that in case
+any of the CTL characters mentioned above appear in the input,
+they can be passed through transparently. CTLESC is also used to
+escape '*', '?', '[', and '!' characters which were quoted by the
+user and thus should not be used for file name generation.
+
+CTLESC characters have proved to be particularly tricky to get
+right. In the case of here documents which are not subject to
+variable and command substitution, the parser doesn't insert any
+CTLESC characters to begin with (so the contents of the text
+field can be written without any processing). Other here docu-
+ments, and words which are not subject to splitting and file name
+generation, have the CTLESC characters removed during the vari-
+able and command substitution phase. Words which are subject
+splitting and file name generation have the CTLESC characters re-
+moved as part of the file name phase.
+
+EXECUTION: Command execution is handled by the following files:
+ eval.c The top level routines.
+ redir.c Code to handle redirection of input and output.
+ jobs.c Code to handle forking, waiting, and job control.
+ exec.c Code to to path searches and the actual exec sys call.
+ expand.c Code to evaluate arguments.
+ var.c Maintains the variable symbol table. Called from expand.c.
+
+EVAL.C: Evaltree recursively executes a parse tree. The exit
+status is returned in the global variable exitstatus. The alter-
+native entry evalbackcmd is called to evaluate commands in back
+quotes. It saves the result in memory if the command is a buil-
+tin; otherwise it forks off a child to execute the command and
+connects the standard output of the child to a pipe.
+
+JOBS.C: To create a process, you call makejob to return a job
+structure, and then call forkshell (passing the job structure as
+an argument) to create the process. Waitforjob waits for a job
+to complete. These routines take care of process groups if job
+control is defined.
+
+REDIR.C: Ash allows file descriptors to be redirected and then
+restored without forking off a child process. This is accom-
+plished by duplicating the original file descriptors. The redir-
+tab structure records where the file descriptors have be dupli-
+cated to.
+
+EXEC.C: The routine find_command locates a command, and enters
+the command in the hash table if it is not already there. The
+third argument specifies whether it is to print an error message
+if the command is not found. (When a pipeline is set up,
+find_command is called for all the commands in the pipeline be-
+fore any forking is done, so to get the commands into the hash
+table of the parent process. But to make command hashing as
+transparent as possible, we silently ignore errors at that point
+and only print error messages if the command cannot be found
+later.)
+
+The routine shellexec is the interface to the exec system call.
+
+EXPAND.C: Arguments are processed in three passes. The first
+(performed by the routine argstr) performs variable and command
+substitution. The second (ifsbreakup) performs word splitting
+and the third (expandmeta) performs file name generation. If the
+"/u" directory is simulated, then when "/u/username" is replaced
+by the user's home directory, the flag "didudir" is set. This
+tells the cd command that it should print out the directory name,
+just as it would if the "/u" directory were implemented using
+symbolic links.
+
+VAR.C: Variables are stored in a hash table. Probably we should
+switch to extensible hashing. The variable name is stored in the
+same string as the value (using the format "name=value") so that
+no string copying is needed to create the environment of a com-
+mand. Variables which the shell references internally are preal-
+located so that the shell can reference the values of these vari-
+ables without doing a lookup.
+
+When a program is run, the code in eval.c sticks any environment
+variables which precede the command (as in "PATH=xxx command") in
+the variable table as the simplest way to strip duplicates, and
+then calls "environment" to get the value of the environment.
+There are two consequences of this. First, if an assignment to
+PATH precedes the command, the value of PATH before the assign-
+ment must be remembered and passed to shellexec. Second, if the
+program turns out to be a shell procedure, the strings from the
+environment variables which preceded the command must be pulled
+out of the table and replaced with strings obtained from malloc,
+since the former will automatically be freed when the stack (see
+the entry on memalloc.c) is emptied.
+
+BUILTIN COMMANDS: The procedures for handling these are scat-
+tered throughout the code, depending on which location appears
+most appropriate. They can be recognized because their names al-
+ways end in "cmd". The mapping from names to procedures is
+specified in the file builtins, which is processed by the mkbuil-
+tins command.
+
+A builtin command is invoked with argc and argv set up like a
+normal program. A builtin command is allowed to overwrite its
+arguments. Builtin routines can call nextopt to do option pars-
+ing. This is kind of like getopt, but you don't pass argc and
+argv to it. Builtin routines can also call error. This routine
+normally terminates the shell (or returns to the main command
+loop if the shell is interactive), but when called from a builtin
+command it causes the builtin command to terminate with an exit
+status of 2.
+
+The directory bltins contains commands which can be compiled in-
+dependently but can also be built into the shell for efficiency
+reasons. The makefile in this directory compiles these programs
+in the normal fashion (so that they can be run regardless of
+whether the invoker is ash), but also creates a library named
+bltinlib.a which can be linked with ash. The header file bltin.h
+takes care of most of the differences between the ash and the
+stand-alone environment. The user should call the main routine
+"main", and #define main to be the name of the routine to use
+when the program is linked into ash. This #define should appear
+before bltin.h is included; bltin.h will #undef main if the pro-
+gram is to be compiled stand-alone.
+
+CD.C: This file defines the cd and pwd builtins. The pwd com-
+mand runs /bin/pwd the first time it is invoked (unless the user
+has already done a cd to an absolute pathname), but then
+remembers the current directory and updates it when the cd com-
+mand is run, so subsequent pwd commands run very fast. The main
+complication in the cd command is in the docd command, which
+resolves symbolic links into actual names and informs the user
+where the user ended up if he crossed a symbolic link.
+
+SIGNALS: Trap.c implements the trap command. The routine set-
+signal figures out what action should be taken when a signal is
+received and invokes the signal system call to set the signal ac-
+tion appropriately. When a signal that a user has set a trap for
+is caught, the routine "onsig" sets a flag. The routine dotrap
+is called at appropriate points to actually handle the signal.
+When an interrupt is caught and no trap has been set for that
+signal, the routine "onint" in error.c is called.
+
+OUTPUT: Ash uses it's own output routines. There are three out-
+put structures allocated. "Output" represents the standard out-
+put, "errout" the standard error, and "memout" contains output
+which is to be stored in memory. This last is used when a buil-
+tin command appears in backquotes, to allow its output to be col-
+lected without doing any I/O through the UNIX operating system.
+The variables out1 and out2 normally point to output and errout,
+respectively, but they are set to point to memout when appropri-
+ate inside backquotes.
+
+INPUT: The basic input routine is pgetc, which reads from the
+current input file. There is a stack of input files; the current
+input file is the top file on this stack. The code allows the
+input to come from a string rather than a file. (This is for the
+-c option and the "." and eval builtin commands.) The global
+variable plinno is saved and restored when files are pushed and
+popped from the stack. The parser routines store the number of
+the current line in this variable.
+
+DEBUGGING: If DEBUG is defined in shell.h, then the shell will
+write debugging information to the file $HOME/trace. Most of
+this is done using the TRACE macro, which takes a set of printf
+arguments inside two sets of parenthesis. Example:
+"TRACE(("n=%d0, n))". The double parenthesis are necessary be-
+cause the preprocessor can't handle functions with a variable
+number of arguments. Defining DEBUG also causes the shell to
+generate a core dump if it is sent a quit signal. The tracing
+code is in show.c.
diff --git a/usr/dash/alias.c b/usr/dash/alias.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..daeacbb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/alias.c
@@ -0,0 +1,227 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "alias.h"
+#include "options.h" /* XXX for argptr (should remove?) */
+
+#define ATABSIZE 39
+
+struct alias *atab[ATABSIZE];
+
+STATIC void setalias(const char *, const char *);
+STATIC struct alias *freealias(struct alias *);
+STATIC struct alias **__lookupalias(const char *);
+
+STATIC
+void
+setalias(const char *name, const char *val)
+{
+ struct alias *ap, **app;
+
+ app = __lookupalias(name);
+ ap = *app;
+ INTOFF;
+ if (ap) {
+ if (!(ap->flag & ALIASINUSE)) {
+ ckfree(ap->val);
+ }
+ ap->val = savestr(val);
+ ap->flag &= ~ALIASDEAD;
+ } else {
+ /* not found */
+ ap = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct alias));
+ ap->name = savestr(name);
+ ap->val = savestr(val);
+ ap->flag = 0;
+ ap->next = 0;
+ *app = ap;
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+int
+unalias(const char *name)
+{
+ struct alias **app;
+
+ app = __lookupalias(name);
+
+ if (*app) {
+ INTOFF;
+ *app = freealias(*app);
+ INTON;
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ return (1);
+}
+
+void
+rmaliases(void)
+{
+ struct alias *ap, **app;
+ int i;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (i = 0; i < ATABSIZE; i++) {
+ app = &atab[i];
+ for (ap = *app; ap; ap = *app) {
+ *app = freealias(*app);
+ if (ap == *app) {
+ app = &ap->next;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+struct alias *
+lookupalias(const char *name, int check)
+{
+ struct alias *ap = *__lookupalias(name);
+
+ if (check && ap && (ap->flag & ALIASINUSE))
+ return (NULL);
+ return (ap);
+}
+
+/*
+ * TODO - sort output
+ */
+int
+aliascmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char *n, *v;
+ int ret = 0;
+ struct alias *ap;
+
+ if (argc == 1) {
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < ATABSIZE; i++)
+ for (ap = atab[i]; ap; ap = ap->next) {
+ printalias(ap);
+ }
+ return (0);
+ }
+ while ((n = *++argv) != NULL) {
+ if ((v = strchr(n+1, '=')) == NULL) { /* n+1: funny ksh stuff */
+ if ((ap = *__lookupalias(n)) == NULL) {
+ outfmt(out2, "%s: %s not found\n", "alias", n);
+ ret = 1;
+ } else
+ printalias(ap);
+ } else {
+ *v++ = '\0';
+ setalias(n, v);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (ret);
+}
+
+int
+unaliascmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ while ((i = nextopt("a")) != '\0') {
+ if (i == 'a') {
+ rmaliases();
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+ for (i = 0; *argptr; argptr++) {
+ if (unalias(*argptr)) {
+ outfmt(out2, "%s: %s not found\n", "unalias", *argptr);
+ i = 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (i);
+}
+
+STATIC struct alias *
+freealias(struct alias *ap) {
+ struct alias *next;
+
+ if (ap->flag & ALIASINUSE) {
+ ap->flag |= ALIASDEAD;
+ return ap;
+ }
+
+ next = ap->next;
+ ckfree(ap->name);
+ ckfree(ap->val);
+ ckfree(ap);
+ return next;
+}
+
+void
+printalias(const struct alias *ap) {
+ out1fmt("%s=%s\n", ap->name, single_quote(ap->val));
+}
+
+STATIC struct alias **
+__lookupalias(const char *name) {
+ unsigned int hashval;
+ struct alias **app;
+ const char *p;
+ unsigned int ch;
+
+ p = name;
+
+ ch = (unsigned char)*p;
+ hashval = ch << 4;
+ while (ch) {
+ hashval += ch;
+ ch = (unsigned char)*++p;
+ }
+ app = &atab[hashval % ATABSIZE];
+
+ for (; *app; app = &(*app)->next) {
+ if (equal(name, (*app)->name)) {
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return app;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/alias.h b/usr/dash/alias.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fb841d6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/alias.h
@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)alias.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#define ALIASINUSE 1
+#define ALIASDEAD 2
+
+struct alias {
+ struct alias *next;
+ char *name;
+ char *val;
+ int flag;
+};
+
+struct alias *lookupalias(const char *, int);
+int aliascmd(int, char **);
+int unaliascmd(int, char **);
+void rmaliases(void);
+int unalias(const char *);
+void printalias(const struct alias *);
diff --git a/usr/dash/arith_yacc.c b/usr/dash/arith_yacc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1a087c3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/arith_yacc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,304 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 2007
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "arith_yacc.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "var.h"
+
+#if ARITH_BOR + 11 != ARITH_BORASS || ARITH_ASS + 11 != ARITH_EQ
+#error Arithmetic tokens are out of order.
+#endif
+
+static const char *arith_startbuf;
+
+const char *arith_buf;
+union yystype yylval;
+
+static int last_token;
+
+#define ARITH_PRECEDENCE(op, prec) [op - ARITH_BINOP_MIN] = prec
+
+static const char prec[ARITH_BINOP_MAX - ARITH_BINOP_MIN] = {
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_MUL, 0),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_DIV, 0),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_REM, 0),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_ADD, 1),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_SUB, 1),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_LSHIFT, 2),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_RSHIFT, 2),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_LT, 3),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_LE, 3),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_GT, 3),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_GE, 3),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_EQ, 4),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_NE, 4),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_BAND, 5),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_BXOR, 6),
+ ARITH_PRECEDENCE(ARITH_BOR, 7),
+};
+
+#define ARITH_MAX_PREC 8
+
+static void yyerror(const char *s) __attribute__ ((noreturn));
+static void yyerror(const char *s)
+{
+ sh_error("arithmetic expression: %s: \"%s\"", s, arith_startbuf);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+static inline int arith_prec(int op)
+{
+ return prec[op - ARITH_BINOP_MIN];
+}
+
+static inline int higher_prec(int op1, int op2)
+{
+ return arith_prec(op1) < arith_prec(op2);
+}
+
+static intmax_t do_binop(int op, intmax_t a, intmax_t b)
+{
+ switch (op) {
+ default:
+ case ARITH_REM:
+ case ARITH_DIV:
+ if (!b)
+ yyerror("division by zero");
+ return op == ARITH_REM ? a % b : a / b;
+ case ARITH_MUL:
+ return a * b;
+ case ARITH_ADD:
+ return a + b;
+ case ARITH_SUB:
+ return a - b;
+ case ARITH_LSHIFT:
+ return a << b;
+ case ARITH_RSHIFT:
+ return a >> b;
+ case ARITH_LT:
+ return a < b;
+ case ARITH_LE:
+ return a <= b;
+ case ARITH_GT:
+ return a > b;
+ case ARITH_GE:
+ return a >= b;
+ case ARITH_EQ:
+ return a == b;
+ case ARITH_NE:
+ return a != b;
+ case ARITH_BAND:
+ return a & b;
+ case ARITH_BXOR:
+ return a ^ b;
+ case ARITH_BOR:
+ return a | b;
+ }
+}
+
+static intmax_t assignment(int var, int noeval);
+
+static intmax_t primary(int token, union yystype *val, int op, int noeval)
+{
+ intmax_t result;
+
+again:
+ switch (token) {
+ case ARITH_LPAREN:
+ result = assignment(op, noeval);
+ if (last_token != ARITH_RPAREN)
+ yyerror("expecting ')'");
+ last_token = yylex();
+ return result;
+ case ARITH_NUM:
+ last_token = op;
+ return val->val;
+ case ARITH_VAR:
+ last_token = op;
+ return noeval ? val->val : lookupvarint(val->name);
+ case ARITH_ADD:
+ token = op;
+ *val = yylval;
+ op = yylex();
+ goto again;
+ case ARITH_SUB:
+ *val = yylval;
+ return -primary(op, val, yylex(), noeval);
+ case ARITH_NOT:
+ *val = yylval;
+ return !primary(op, val, yylex(), noeval);
+ case ARITH_BNOT:
+ *val = yylval;
+ return ~primary(op, val, yylex(), noeval);
+ default:
+ yyerror("expecting primary");
+ }
+}
+
+static intmax_t binop2(intmax_t a, int op, int prec, int noeval)
+{
+ for (;;) {
+ union yystype val;
+ intmax_t b;
+ int op2;
+ int token;
+
+ token = yylex();
+ val = yylval;
+
+ b = primary(token, &val, yylex(), noeval);
+
+ op2 = last_token;
+ if (op2 >= ARITH_BINOP_MIN && op2 < ARITH_BINOP_MAX &&
+ higher_prec(op2, op)) {
+ b = binop2(b, op2, arith_prec(op), noeval);
+ op2 = last_token;
+ }
+
+ a = noeval ? b : do_binop(op, a, b);
+
+ if (op2 < ARITH_BINOP_MIN || op2 >= ARITH_BINOP_MAX ||
+ arith_prec(op2) >= prec)
+ return a;
+
+ op = op2;
+ }
+}
+
+static intmax_t binop(int token, union yystype *val, int op, int noeval)
+{
+ intmax_t a = primary(token, val, op, noeval);
+
+ op = last_token;
+ if (op < ARITH_BINOP_MIN || op >= ARITH_BINOP_MAX)
+ return a;
+
+ return binop2(a, op, ARITH_MAX_PREC, noeval);
+}
+
+static intmax_t and(int token, union yystype *val, int op, int noeval)
+{
+ intmax_t a = binop(token, val, op, noeval);
+ intmax_t b;
+
+ op = last_token;
+ if (op != ARITH_AND)
+ return a;
+
+ token = yylex();
+ *val = yylval;
+
+ b = and(token, val, yylex(), noeval | !a);
+
+ return a && b;
+}
+
+static intmax_t or(int token, union yystype *val, int op, int noeval)
+{
+ intmax_t a = and(token, val, op, noeval);
+ intmax_t b;
+
+ op = last_token;
+ if (op != ARITH_OR)
+ return a;
+
+ token = yylex();
+ *val = yylval;
+
+ b = or(token, val, yylex(), noeval | !!a);
+
+ return a || b;
+}
+
+static intmax_t cond(int token, union yystype *val, int op, int noeval)
+{
+ intmax_t a = or(token, val, op, noeval);
+ intmax_t b;
+ intmax_t c;
+
+ if (last_token != ARITH_QMARK)
+ return a;
+
+ b = assignment(yylex(), noeval | !a);
+
+ if (last_token != ARITH_COLON)
+ yyerror("expecting ':'");
+
+ token = yylex();
+ *val = yylval;
+
+ c = cond(token, val, yylex(), noeval | !!a);
+
+ return a ? b : c;
+}
+
+static intmax_t assignment(int var, int noeval)
+{
+ union yystype val = yylval;
+ int op = yylex();
+ intmax_t result;
+
+ if (var != ARITH_VAR)
+ return cond(var, &val, op, noeval);
+
+ if (op != ARITH_ASS && (op < ARITH_ASS_MIN || op >= ARITH_ASS_MAX))
+ return cond(var, &val, op, noeval);
+
+ result = assignment(yylex(), noeval);
+ if (noeval)
+ return result;
+
+ return setvarint(val.name,
+ op == ARITH_ASS ? result :
+ do_binop(op - 11, lookupvarint(val.name), result), 0);
+}
+
+intmax_t arith(const char *s)
+{
+ intmax_t result;
+
+ arith_buf = arith_startbuf = s;
+
+ result = assignment(yylex(), 0);
+
+ if (last_token)
+ yyerror("expecting EOF");
+
+ return result;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/arith_yacc.h b/usr/dash/arith_yacc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ff34d52
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/arith_yacc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,89 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 2007
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#define ARITH_ASS 1
+
+#define ARITH_OR 2
+#define ARITH_AND 3
+#define ARITH_BAD 4
+#define ARITH_NUM 5
+#define ARITH_VAR 6
+#define ARITH_NOT 7
+
+#define ARITH_BINOP_MIN 8
+#define ARITH_LE 8
+#define ARITH_GE 9
+#define ARITH_LT 10
+#define ARITH_GT 11
+#define ARITH_EQ 12
+#define ARITH_REM 13
+#define ARITH_BAND 14
+#define ARITH_LSHIFT 15
+#define ARITH_RSHIFT 16
+#define ARITH_MUL 17
+#define ARITH_ADD 18
+#define ARITH_BOR 19
+#define ARITH_SUB 20
+#define ARITH_BXOR 21
+#define ARITH_DIV 22
+#define ARITH_NE 23
+#define ARITH_BINOP_MAX 24
+
+#define ARITH_ASS_MIN 24
+#define ARITH_REMASS 24
+#define ARITH_BANDASS 25
+#define ARITH_LSHIFTASS 26
+#define ARITH_RSHIFTASS 27
+#define ARITH_MULASS 28
+#define ARITH_ADDASS 29
+#define ARITH_BORASS 30
+#define ARITH_SUBASS 31
+#define ARITH_BXORASS 32
+#define ARITH_DIVASS 33
+#define ARITH_ASS_MAX 34
+
+#define ARITH_LPAREN 34
+#define ARITH_RPAREN 35
+#define ARITH_BNOT 36
+#define ARITH_QMARK 37
+#define ARITH_COLON 38
+
+union yystype {
+ intmax_t val;
+ char *name;
+};
+
+extern union yystype yylval;
+
+int yylex(void);
diff --git a/usr/dash/arith_yylex.c b/usr/dash/arith_yylex.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ec5b5b2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/arith_yylex.c
@@ -0,0 +1,240 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 2002
+ * Herbert Xu.
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include "arith_yacc.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+#if ARITH_BOR + 11 != ARITH_BORASS || ARITH_ASS + 11 != ARITH_EQ
+#error Arithmetic tokens are out of order.
+#endif
+
+extern const char *arith_buf;
+
+int
+yylex()
+{
+ int value;
+ const char *buf = arith_buf;
+ const char *p;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ value = *buf;
+ switch (value) {
+ case ' ':
+ case '\t':
+ case '\n':
+ buf++;
+ continue;
+ default:
+ return ARITH_BAD;
+ case '0':
+ case '1':
+ case '2':
+ case '3':
+ case '4':
+ case '5':
+ case '6':
+ case '7':
+ case '8':
+ case '9':
+ yylval.val = strtoimax(buf, (char **)&arith_buf, 0);
+ return ARITH_NUM;
+ case 'A':
+ case 'B':
+ case 'C':
+ case 'D':
+ case 'E':
+ case 'F':
+ case 'G':
+ case 'H':
+ case 'I':
+ case 'J':
+ case 'K':
+ case 'L':
+ case 'M':
+ case 'N':
+ case 'O':
+ case 'P':
+ case 'Q':
+ case 'R':
+ case 'S':
+ case 'T':
+ case 'U':
+ case 'V':
+ case 'W':
+ case 'X':
+ case 'Y':
+ case 'Z':
+ case '_':
+ case 'a':
+ case 'b':
+ case 'c':
+ case 'd':
+ case 'e':
+ case 'f':
+ case 'g':
+ case 'h':
+ case 'i':
+ case 'j':
+ case 'k':
+ case 'l':
+ case 'm':
+ case 'n':
+ case 'o':
+ case 'p':
+ case 'q':
+ case 'r':
+ case 's':
+ case 't':
+ case 'u':
+ case 'v':
+ case 'w':
+ case 'x':
+ case 'y':
+ case 'z':
+ p = buf;
+ while (buf++, is_in_name(*buf))
+ ;
+ yylval.name = stalloc(buf - p + 1);
+ *(char *)mempcpy(yylval.name, p, buf - p) = 0;
+ value = ARITH_VAR;
+ goto out;
+ case '=':
+ value += ARITH_ASS - '=';
+checkeq:
+ buf++;
+checkeqcur:
+ if (*buf != '=')
+ goto out;
+ value += 11;
+ break;
+ case '>':
+ switch (*++buf) {
+ case '=':
+ value += ARITH_GE - '>';
+ break;
+ case '>':
+ value += ARITH_RSHIFT - '>';
+ goto checkeq;
+ default:
+ value += ARITH_GT - '>';
+ goto out;
+ }
+ break;
+ case '<':
+ switch (*++buf) {
+ case '=':
+ value += ARITH_LE - '<';
+ break;
+ case '<':
+ value += ARITH_LSHIFT - '<';
+ goto checkeq;
+ default:
+ value += ARITH_LT - '<';
+ goto out;
+ }
+ break;
+ case '|':
+ if (*++buf != '|') {
+ value += ARITH_BOR - '|';
+ goto checkeqcur;
+ }
+ value += ARITH_OR - '|';
+ break;
+ case '&':
+ if (*++buf != '&') {
+ value += ARITH_BAND - '&';
+ goto checkeqcur;
+ }
+ value += ARITH_AND - '&';
+ break;
+ case '!':
+ if (*++buf != '=') {
+ value += ARITH_NOT - '!';
+ goto out;
+ }
+ value += ARITH_NE - '!';
+ break;
+ case 0:
+ goto out;
+ case '(':
+ value += ARITH_LPAREN - '(';
+ break;
+ case ')':
+ value += ARITH_RPAREN - ')';
+ break;
+ case '*':
+ value += ARITH_MUL - '*';
+ goto checkeq;
+ case '/':
+ value += ARITH_DIV - '/';
+ goto checkeq;
+ case '%':
+ value += ARITH_REM - '%';
+ goto checkeq;
+ case '+':
+ value += ARITH_ADD - '+';
+ goto checkeq;
+ case '-':
+ value += ARITH_SUB - '-';
+ goto checkeq;
+ case '~':
+ value += ARITH_BNOT - '~';
+ break;
+ case '^':
+ value += ARITH_BXOR - '^';
+ goto checkeq;
+ case '?':
+ value += ARITH_QMARK - '?';
+ break;
+ case ':':
+ value += ARITH_COLON - ':';
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ buf++;
+out:
+ arith_buf = buf;
+ return value;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/bltin/bltin.h b/usr/dash/bltin/bltin.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f5ac06f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/bltin/bltin.h
@@ -0,0 +1,89 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)bltin.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * This file is included by programs which are optionally built into the
+ * shell. If SHELL is defined, we try to map the standard UNIX library
+ * routines to ash routines using defines.
+ */
+
+#include "../shell.h"
+#include "../mystring.h"
+#include "../options.h"
+#ifdef SHELL
+#include "../memalloc.h"
+#include "../output.h"
+#include "../error.h"
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+#undef stdout
+#undef stderr
+#undef putc
+#undef putchar
+#undef fileno
+#define stdout out1
+#define stderr out2
+#define printf out1fmt
+#define putc(c, file) outc(c, file)
+#define putchar(c) out1c(c)
+#define FILE struct output
+#define fprintf outfmt
+#define fputs outstr
+#define fflush flushout
+#define fileno(f) ((f)->fd)
+#define ferror outerr
+#endif
+#define INITARGS(argv)
+#define error sh_error
+#define warn sh_warn
+#define warnx sh_warnx
+#define exit sh_exit
+#define setprogname(s)
+#define getprogname() commandname
+#define setlocate(l,s) 0
+
+#define getenv(p) bltinlookup((p),0)
+
+#else
+#undef NULL
+#include <stdio.h>
+#undef main
+#define INITARGS(argv) if ((commandname = argv[0]) == NULL) {fputs("Argc is zero\n", stderr); exit(2);} else
+#endif
+
+int echocmd(int, char **);
+
+
+extern const char *commandname;
diff --git a/usr/dash/bltin/echo.1 b/usr/dash/bltin/echo.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fbc7fb4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/bltin/echo.1
@@ -0,0 +1,109 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\" Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+.\" Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" Kenneth Almquist.
+.\" Copyright 1989 by Kenneth Almquist
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)echo.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt ECHO 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm echo
+.Nd produce message in a shell script
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm
+.Op Fl n | Fl e
+.Ar args ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm
+prints its arguments on the standard output, separated by spaces.
+Unless the
+.Fl n
+option is present, a newline is output following the arguments.
+The
+.Fl e
+option causes
+.Nm
+to treat the escape sequences specially, as described in the following
+paragraph.
+The
+.Fl e
+option is the default, and is provided solely for compatibility with
+other systems.
+Only one of the options
+.Fl n
+and
+.Fl e
+may be given.
+.Pp
+If any of the following sequences of characters is encountered during
+output, the sequence is not output. Instead, the specified action is
+performed:
+.Bl -tag -width indent
+.It Li \eb
+A backspace character is output.
+.It Li \ec
+Subsequent output is suppressed. This is normally used at the end of the
+last argument to suppress the trailing newline that
+.Nm
+would otherwise output.
+.It Li \ef
+Output a form feed.
+.It Li \en
+Output a newline character.
+.It Li \er
+Output a carriage return.
+.It Li \et
+Output a (horizontal) tab character.
+.It Li \ev
+Output a vertical tab.
+.It Li \e0 Ns Ar digits
+Output the character whose value is given by zero to three digits.
+If there are zero digits, a nul character is output.
+.It Li \e\e
+Output a backslash.
+.El
+.Sh HINTS
+Remember that backslash is special to the shell and needs to be escaped.
+To output a message to standard error, say
+.Pp
+.D1 echo message \*[Gt]\*[Am]2
+.Sh BUGS
+The octal character escape mechanism
+.Pq Li \e0 Ns Ar digits
+differs from the
+C language mechanism.
+.Pp
+There is no way to force
+.Nm
+to treat its arguments literally, rather than interpreting them as
+options and escape sequences.
diff --git a/usr/dash/bltin/printf.1 b/usr/dash/bltin/printf.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b1265a5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/bltin/printf.1
@@ -0,0 +1,354 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\" Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+.\" Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" from: @(#)printf.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/6/93
+.\"
+.Dd November 5, 1993
+.Dt PRINTF 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm printf
+.Nd formatted output
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm
+.Ar format
+.Op Ar arguments ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm
+formats and prints its arguments, after the first, under control
+of the
+.Ar format .
+The
+.Ar format
+is a character string which contains three types of objects: plain characters,
+which are simply copied to standard output, character escape sequences which
+are converted and copied to the standard output, and format specifications,
+each of which causes printing of the next successive
+.Ar argument .
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar arguments
+after the first are treated as strings if the corresponding format is
+either
+.Cm b ,
+.Cm B ,
+.Cm c
+or
+.Cm s ;
+otherwise it is evaluated as a C constant, with the following extensions:
+.Pp
+.Bl -bullet -offset indent -compact
+.It
+A leading plus or minus sign is allowed.
+.It
+If the leading character is a single or double quote, the value is the
+.Tn ASCII
+code of the next character.
+.El
+.Pp
+The format string is reused as often as necessary to satisfy the
+.Ar arguments .
+Any extra format specifications are evaluated with zero or the null
+string.
+.Pp
+Character escape sequences are in backslash notation as defined in
+.St -ansiC .
+The characters and their meanings are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -offset indent
+.It Cm \ee
+Write an \*[Lt]escape\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \ea
+Write a \*[Lt]bell\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \eb
+Write a \*[Lt]backspace\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \ef
+Write a \*[Lt]form-feed\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \en
+Write a \*[Lt]new-line\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \er
+Write a \*[Lt]carriage return\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \et
+Write a \*[Lt]tab\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \ev
+Write a \*[Lt]vertical tab\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \e\'
+Write a \*[Lt]single quote\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \e"
+Write a \*[Lt]double quote\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \e\e
+Write a backslash character.
+.It Cm \e Ns Ar num
+Write an 8\-bit character whose
+.Tn ASCII
+value is the 1\-, 2\-, or 3\-digit octal number
+.Ar num .
+.It Cm \ex Ns Ar xx
+Write an 8\-bit character whose
+.Tn ASCII
+value is the 1\- or 2\-digit hexadecimal number
+.Ar xx .
+.El
+.Pp
+Each format specification is introduced by the percent character
+(``%'').
+The remainder of the format specification includes,
+in the following order:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It "Zero or more of the following flags:"
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Cm #
+A `#' character
+specifying that the value should be printed in an ``alternative form''.
+For
+.Cm b ,
+.Cm c ,
+.Cm d ,
+and
+.Cm s
+formats, this option has no effect.
+For the
+.Cm o
+format the precision of the number is increased to force the first
+character of the output string to a zero.
+For the
+.Cm x
+.Pq Cm X
+format, a non-zero result has the string
+.Li 0x
+.Pq Li 0X
+prepended to it.
+For
+.Cm e ,
+.Cm E ,
+.Cm f ,
+.Cm g ,
+and
+.Cm G
+formats, the result will always contain a decimal point, even if no
+digits follow the point (normally, a decimal point only appears in the
+results of those formats if a digit follows the decimal point).
+For
+.Cm g
+and
+.Cm G
+formats, trailing zeros are not removed from the result as they
+would otherwise be.
+.\" I turned this off - decided it isn't a valid use of '#'
+.\" For the
+.\" .Cm B
+.\" format, backslash-escape sequences are expanded first;
+.It Cm \&\-
+A minus sign `\-' which specifies
+.Em left adjustment
+of the output in the indicated field;
+.It Cm \&+
+A `+' character specifying that there should always be
+a sign placed before the number when using signed formats.
+.It Sq \&\ \&
+A space specifying that a blank should be left before a positive number
+for a signed format.
+A `+' overrides a space if both are used;
+.It Cm \&0
+A zero `0' character indicating that zero-padding should be used
+rather than blank-padding.
+A `\-' overrides a `0' if both are used;
+.El
+.It "Field Width:"
+An optional digit string specifying a
+.Em field width ;
+if the output string has fewer characters than the field width it will
+be blank-padded on the left (or right, if the left-adjustment indicator
+has been given) to make up the field width (note that a leading zero
+is a flag, but an embedded zero is part of a field width);
+.It Precision :
+An optional period,
+.Sq Cm \&.\& ,
+followed by an optional digit string giving a
+.Em precision
+which specifies the number of digits to appear after the decimal point,
+for
+.Cm e
+and
+.Cm f
+formats, or the maximum number of characters to be printed
+from a string
+.Sm off
+.Pf ( Cm b No ,
+.Sm on
+.Cm B
+and
+.Cm s
+formats); if the digit string is missing, the precision is treated
+as zero;
+.It Format :
+A character which indicates the type of format to use (one of
+.Cm diouxXfwEgGbBcs ) .
+.El
+.Pp
+A field width or precision may be
+.Sq Cm \&*
+instead of a digit string.
+In this case an
+.Ar argument
+supplies the field width or precision.
+.Pp
+The format characters and their meanings are:
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Cm diouXx
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed as a signed decimal (d or i), unsigned octal, unsigned decimal,
+or unsigned hexadecimal (X or x), respectively.
+.It Cm f
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed in the style
+.Sm off
+.Pf [\-]ddd Cm \&. No ddd
+.Sm on
+where the number of d's
+after the decimal point is equal to the precision specification for
+the argument.
+If the precision is missing, 6 digits are given; if the precision
+is explicitly 0, no digits and no decimal point are printed.
+.It Cm eE
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed in the style
+.Sm off
+.Pf [\-]d Cm \&. No ddd Cm e No \\*(Pmdd
+.Sm on
+where there
+is one digit before the decimal point and the number after is equal to
+the precision specification for the argument; when the precision is
+missing, 6 digits are produced.
+An upper-case E is used for an `E' format.
+.It Cm gG
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed in style
+.Cm f
+or in style
+.Cm e
+.Pq Cm E
+whichever gives full precision in minimum space.
+.It Cm b
+Characters from the string
+.Ar argument
+are printed with backslash-escape sequences expanded.
+.br
+The following additional backslash-escape sequences are supported:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Cm \ec
+Causes
+.Nm
+to ignore any remaining characters in the string operand containing it,
+any remaining string operands, and any additional characters in
+the format operand.
+.It Cm \e0 Ns Ar num
+Write an 8\-bit character whose
+.Tn ASCII
+value is the 1\-, 2\-, or 3\-digit
+octal number
+.Ar num .
+.It Cm \e^ Ns Ar c
+Write the control character
+.Ar c .
+Generates characters `\e000' through `\e037`, and `\e177' (from `\e^?').
+.It Cm \eM\- Ns Ar c
+Write the character
+.Ar c
+with the 8th bit set.
+Generates characters `\e241' through `\e376`.
+.It Cm \eM^ Ns Ar c
+Write the control character
+.Ar c
+with the 8th bit set.
+Generates characters `\e000' through `\e037`, and `\e177' (from `\eM^?').
+.El
+.It Cm B
+Characters from the string
+.Ar argument
+are printed with unprintable characters backslash-escaped using the
+.Sm off
+.Pf ` Cm \e Ar c No ',
+.Pf ` Cm \e^ Ar c No ',
+.Pf ` Cm \eM\- Ar c No '
+or
+.Pf ` Cm \eM^ Ar c No ',
+.Sm on
+formats described above.
+.It Cm c
+The first character of
+.Ar argument
+is printed.
+.It Cm s
+Characters from the string
+.Ar argument
+are printed until the end is reached or until the number of characters
+indicated by the precision specification is reached; if the
+precision is omitted, all characters in the string are printed.
+.It Cm \&%
+Print a `%'; no argument is used.
+.El
+.Pp
+In no case does a non-existent or small field width cause truncation of
+a field; padding takes place only if the specified field width exceeds
+the actual width.
+.Sh EXIT STATUS
+.Nm
+exits 0 on success, 1 on failure.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr echo 1 ,
+.Xr printf 3 ,
+.Xr printf 9
+.Xr vis 3
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm
+utility conforms to
+.St -p1003.1-2001 .
+.Pp
+Support for the floating point formats and `*' as a field width and precision
+are optional in POSIX.
+.Pp
+The behaviour of the %B format and the \e', \e", \exxx, \ee and
+\e[M][\-|^]c escape sequences are undefined in POSIX.
+.Sh BUGS
+Since the floating point numbers are translated from
+.Tn ASCII
+to floating-point and
+then back again, floating-point precision may be lost.
+.Pp
+Hexadecimal character constants are restricted to, and should be specified
+as, two character constants. This is contrary to the ISO C standard but
+does guarantee detection of the end of the constant.
diff --git a/usr/dash/bltin/printf.c b/usr/dash/bltin/printf.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b32b54f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/bltin/printf.c
@@ -0,0 +1,470 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+static int conv_escape_str(char *);
+static char *conv_escape(char *, int *);
+static int getchr(void);
+static intmax_t getintmax(void);
+static uintmax_t getuintmax(void);
+static char *getstr(void);
+static char *mklong(const char *, const char *);
+static void check_conversion(const char *, const char *);
+#ifdef HAVE_STRTOD
+static double getdouble(void);
+#endif
+
+static int rval;
+static char **gargv;
+
+#define isodigit(c) ((c) >= '0' && (c) <= '7')
+#define octtobin(c) ((c) - '0')
+
+#include "bltin.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+#define PF(f, func) { \
+ switch ((char *)param - (char *)array) { \
+ default: \
+ (void)printf(f, array[0], array[1], func); \
+ break; \
+ case sizeof(*param): \
+ (void)printf(f, array[0], func); \
+ break; \
+ case 0: \
+ (void)printf(f, func); \
+ break; \
+ } \
+}
+
+int printfcmd(int argc, char *argv[])
+{
+ char *fmt;
+ char *format;
+ int ch;
+
+ rval = 0;
+
+ nextopt(nullstr);
+
+ argv = argptr;
+ format = *argv;
+
+ if (!format) {
+ warnx("usage: printf format [arg ...]");
+ goto err;
+ }
+
+ gargv = ++argv;
+
+#define SKIP1 "#-+ 0"
+#define SKIP2 "*0123456789"
+ do {
+ /*
+ * Basic algorithm is to scan the format string for conversion
+ * specifications -- once one is found, find out if the field
+ * width or precision is a '*'; if it is, gather up value.
+ * Note, format strings are reused as necessary to use up the
+ * provided arguments, arguments of zero/null string are
+ * provided to use up the format string.
+ */
+
+ /* find next format specification */
+ for (fmt = format; (ch = *fmt++) ;) {
+ char *start;
+ char nextch;
+ int array[2];
+ int *param;
+
+ if (ch == '\\') {
+ int c_ch;
+ fmt = conv_escape(fmt, &c_ch);
+ ch = c_ch;
+ goto pc;
+ }
+ if (ch != '%' || (*fmt == '%' && (++fmt || 1))) {
+pc:
+ putchar(ch);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Ok - we've found a format specification,
+ Save its address for a later printf(). */
+ start = fmt - 1;
+ param = array;
+
+ /* skip to field width */
+ fmt += strspn(fmt, SKIP1);
+ if (*fmt == '*')
+ *param++ = getintmax();
+
+ /* skip to possible '.', get following precision */
+ fmt += strspn(fmt, SKIP2);
+ if (*fmt == '.')
+ ++fmt;
+ if (*fmt == '*')
+ *param++ = getintmax();
+
+ fmt += strspn(fmt, SKIP2);
+
+ ch = *fmt;
+ if (!ch) {
+ warnx("missing format character");
+ goto err;
+ }
+ /* null terminate format string to we can use it
+ as an argument to printf. */
+ nextch = fmt[1];
+ fmt[1] = 0;
+ switch (ch) {
+
+ case 'b': {
+ int done = conv_escape_str(getstr());
+ char *p = stackblock();
+ *fmt = 's';
+ PF(start, p);
+ /* escape if a \c was encountered */
+ if (done)
+ goto out;
+ *fmt = 'b';
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'c': {
+ int p = getchr();
+ PF(start, p);
+ break;
+ }
+ case 's': {
+ char *p = getstr();
+ PF(start, p);
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'd':
+ case 'i': {
+ intmax_t p = getintmax();
+ char *f = mklong(start, fmt);
+ PF(f, p);
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'o':
+ case 'u':
+ case 'x':
+ case 'X': {
+ uintmax_t p = getuintmax();
+ char *f = mklong(start, fmt);
+ PF(f, p);
+ break;
+ }
+#ifdef HAVE_STRTOD
+ case 'e':
+ case 'E':
+ case 'f':
+ case 'g':
+ case 'G': {
+ double p = getdouble();
+ PF(start, p);
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+ default:
+ warnx("%s: invalid directive", start);
+ goto err;
+ }
+ *++fmt = nextch;
+ }
+ } while (gargv != argv && *gargv);
+
+out:
+ return rval;
+err:
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Print SysV echo(1) style escape string
+ * Halts processing string if a \c escape is encountered.
+ */
+static int
+conv_escape_str(char *str)
+{
+ int ch;
+ char *cp;
+
+ /* convert string into a temporary buffer... */
+ STARTSTACKSTR(cp);
+
+ do {
+ int c;
+
+ ch = *str++;
+ if (ch != '\\')
+ continue;
+
+ ch = *str++;
+ if (ch == 'c') {
+ /* \c as in SYSV echo - abort all processing.... */
+ ch = 0x100;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * %b string octal constants are not like those in C.
+ * They start with a \0, and are followed by 0, 1, 2,
+ * or 3 octal digits.
+ */
+ if (ch == '0') {
+ unsigned char i;
+ i = 3;
+ ch = 0;
+ do {
+ unsigned k = octtobin(*str);
+ if (k > 7)
+ break;
+ str++;
+ ch <<= 3;
+ ch += k;
+ } while (--i);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Finally test for sequences valid in the format string */
+ str = conv_escape(str - 1, &c);
+ ch = c;
+ } while (STPUTC(ch, cp), (char)ch);
+
+ return ch;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Print "standard" escape characters
+ */
+static char *
+conv_escape(char *str, int *conv_ch)
+{
+ int value;
+ int ch;
+
+ ch = *str;
+
+ switch (ch) {
+ default:
+ case 0:
+ value = '\\';
+ goto out;
+
+ case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3':
+ case '4': case '5': case '6': case '7':
+ ch = 3;
+ value = 0;
+ do {
+ value <<= 3;
+ value += octtobin(*str++);
+ } while (isodigit(*str) && --ch);
+ goto out;
+
+ case '\\': value = '\\'; break; /* backslash */
+ case 'a': value = '\a'; break; /* alert */
+ case 'b': value = '\b'; break; /* backspace */
+ case 'f': value = '\f'; break; /* form-feed */
+ case 'n': value = '\n'; break; /* newline */
+ case 'r': value = '\r'; break; /* carriage-return */
+ case 't': value = '\t'; break; /* tab */
+ case 'v': value = '\v'; break; /* vertical-tab */
+ }
+
+ str++;
+out:
+ *conv_ch = value;
+ return str;
+}
+
+static char *
+mklong(const char *str, const char *ch)
+{
+ char *copy;
+ size_t len;
+
+ len = ch - str + 3;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(copy);
+ copy = makestrspace(len, copy);
+ memcpy(copy, str, len - 3);
+ copy[len - 3] = 'j';
+ copy[len - 2] = *ch;
+ copy[len - 1] = '\0';
+ return (copy);
+}
+
+static int
+getchr(void)
+{
+ int val = 0;
+
+ if (*gargv)
+ val = **gargv++;
+ return val;
+}
+
+static char *
+getstr(void)
+{
+ char *val = nullstr;
+
+ if (*gargv)
+ val = *gargv++;
+ return val;
+}
+
+static intmax_t
+getintmax(void)
+{
+ intmax_t val = 0;
+ char *cp, *ep;
+
+ cp = *gargv;
+ if (cp == NULL)
+ goto out;
+ gargv++;
+
+ val = (unsigned char) cp[1];
+ if (*cp == '\"' || *cp == '\'')
+ goto out;
+
+ errno = 0;
+ val = strtoimax(cp, &ep, 0);
+ check_conversion(cp, ep);
+out:
+ return val;
+}
+
+static uintmax_t
+getuintmax(void)
+{
+ uintmax_t val = 0;
+ char *cp, *ep;
+
+ cp = *gargv;
+ if (cp == NULL)
+ goto out;
+ gargv++;
+
+ val = (unsigned char) cp[1];
+ if (*cp == '\"' || *cp == '\'')
+ goto out;
+
+ errno = 0;
+ val = strtoumax(cp, &ep, 0);
+ check_conversion(cp, ep);
+out:
+ return val;
+}
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRTOD
+static double
+getdouble(void)
+{
+ double val;
+ char *cp, *ep;
+
+ cp = *gargv;
+ if (cp == NULL)
+ return 0;
+ gargv++;
+
+ if (*cp == '\"' || *cp == '\'')
+ return (unsigned char) cp[1];
+
+ errno = 0;
+ val = strtod(cp, &ep);
+ check_conversion(cp, ep);
+ return val;
+}
+#endif
+
+static void
+check_conversion(const char *s, const char *ep)
+{
+ if (*ep) {
+ if (ep == s)
+ warnx("%s: expected numeric value", s);
+ else
+ warnx("%s: not completely converted", s);
+ rval = 1;
+ } else if (errno == ERANGE) {
+ warnx("%s: %s", s, strerror(ERANGE));
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+}
+
+int
+echocmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int nonl = 0;
+ struct output *outs = out1;
+
+ if (!*++argv)
+ goto end;
+ if (equal(*argv, "-n")) {
+ nonl = ~nonl;
+ if (!*++argv)
+ goto end;
+ }
+
+ do {
+ int c;
+
+ nonl += conv_escape_str(*argv);
+ outstr(stackblock(), outs);
+ if (nonl > 0)
+ break;
+
+ c = ' ';
+ if (!*++argv) {
+end:
+ if (nonl) {
+ break;
+ }
+ c = '\n';
+ }
+ outc(c, outs);
+ } while (*argv);
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/bltin/test.1 b/usr/dash/bltin/test.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..42435fb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/bltin/test.1
@@ -0,0 +1,309 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\" Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+.\" Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)test.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt TEST 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm test ,
+.Nm \&[
+.Nd condition evaluation utility
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm test
+.Ar expression
+.Nm \&[
+.Ar expression Cm ]
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm test
+utility evaluates the expression and, if it evaluates
+to true, returns a zero (true) exit status; otherwise
+it returns 1 (false).
+If there is no expression, test also
+returns 1 (false).
+.Pp
+All operators and flags are separate arguments to the
+.Nm test
+utility.
+.Pp
+The following primaries are used to construct expression:
+.Bl -tag -width Ar
+.It Fl b Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a block special
+file.
+.It Fl c Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a character
+special file.
+.It Fl d Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a directory.
+.It Fl e Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists (regardless of type).
+.It Fl f Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a regular file.
+.It Fl g Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its set group ID flag
+is set.
+.It Fl h Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a symbolic link.
+.It Fl k Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its sticky bit is set.
+.It Fl n Ar string
+True if the length of
+.Ar string
+is nonzero.
+.It Fl p Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+is a named pipe
+.Po Tn FIFO Pc .
+.It Fl r Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is readable.
+.It Fl s Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and has a size greater
+than zero.
+.It Fl t Ar file_descriptor
+True if the file whose file descriptor number
+is
+.Ar file_descriptor
+is open and is associated with a terminal.
+.It Fl u Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its set user ID flag
+is set.
+.It Fl w Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is writable.
+True
+indicates only that the write flag is on.
+The file is not writable on a read-only file
+system even if this test indicates true.
+.It Fl x Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is executable.
+True
+indicates only that the execute flag is on.
+If
+.Ar file
+is a directory, true indicates that
+.Ar file
+can be searched.
+.It Fl z Ar string
+True if the length of
+.Ar string
+is zero.
+.It Fl L Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a symbolic link.
+This operator is retained for compatibility with previous versions of
+this program.
+Do not rely on its existence; use
+.Fl h
+instead.
+.It Fl O Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its owner matches the effective user id of this process.
+.It Fl G Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its group matches the effective group id of this process.
+.It Fl S Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a socket.
+.It Ar file1 Fl nt Ar file2
+True if
+.Ar file1
+exists and is newer than
+.Ar file2 .
+.It Ar file1 Fl ot Ar file2
+True if
+.Ar file1
+exists and is older than
+.Ar file2 .
+.It Ar file1 Fl ef Ar file2
+True if
+.Ar file1
+and
+.Ar file2
+exist and refer to the same file.
+.It Ar string
+True if
+.Ar string
+is not the null
+string.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&= Ar \&s\&2
+True if the strings
+.Ar \&s\&1
+and
+.Ar \&s\&2
+are identical.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&!= Ar \&s\&2
+True if the strings
+.Ar \&s\&1
+and
+.Ar \&s\&2
+are not identical.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&\*[Lt] Ar \&s\&2
+True if string
+.Ar \&s\&1
+comes before
+.Ar \&s\&2
+based on the ASCII value of their characters.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&\*[Gt] Ar \&s\&2
+True if string
+.Ar \&s\&1
+comes after
+.Ar \&s\&2
+based on the ASCII value of their characters.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&eq Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integers
+.Ar \&n\&1
+and
+.Ar \&n\&2
+are algebraically
+equal.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&ne Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integers
+.Ar \&n\&1
+and
+.Ar \&n\&2
+are not
+algebraically equal.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&gt Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically
+greater than the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&ge Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically
+greater than or equal to the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&lt Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically less
+than the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&le Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically less
+than or equal to the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.El
+.Pp
+These primaries can be combined with the following operators:
+.Bl -tag -width Ar
+.It Cm \&! Ar expression
+True if
+.Ar expression
+is false.
+.It Ar expression1 Fl a Ar expression2
+True if both
+.Ar expression1
+and
+.Ar expression2
+are true.
+.It Ar expression1 Fl o Ar expression2
+True if either
+.Ar expression1
+or
+.Ar expression2
+are true.
+.It Cm \&( Ns Ar expression Ns Cm \&)
+True if expression is true.
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Fl a
+operator has higher precedence than the
+.Fl o
+operator.
+.Sh GRAMMAR AMBIGUITY
+The
+.Nm test
+grammar is inherently ambiguous.
+In order to assure a degree of consistency, the cases described in
+.St -p1003.2
+section 4.62.4,
+are evaluated consistently according to the rules specified in the
+standards document.
+All other cases are subject to the ambiguity in the command semantics.
+.Sh EXIT STATUS
+The
+.Nm test
+utility exits with one of the following values:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It 0
+expression evaluated to true.
+.It 1
+expression evaluated to false or expression was
+missing.
+.It \*[Gt]1
+An error occurred.
+.El
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm test
+utility implements a superset of the
+.St -p1003.2
+specification.
diff --git a/usr/dash/bltin/test.c b/usr/dash/bltin/test.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..90135e1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/bltin/test.c
@@ -0,0 +1,543 @@
+/*
+ * test(1); version 7-like -- author Erik Baalbergen
+ * modified by Eric Gisin to be used as built-in.
+ * modified by Arnold Robbins to add SVR3 compatibility
+ * (-x -c -b -p -u -g -k) plus Korn's -L -nt -ot -ef and new -S (socket).
+ * modified by J.T. Conklin for NetBSD.
+ *
+ * This program is in the Public Domain.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#include "bltin.h"
+
+/* test(1) accepts the following grammar:
+ oexpr ::= aexpr | aexpr "-o" oexpr ;
+ aexpr ::= nexpr | nexpr "-a" aexpr ;
+ nexpr ::= primary | "!" primary
+ primary ::= unary-operator operand
+ | operand binary-operator operand
+ | operand
+ | "(" oexpr ")"
+ ;
+ unary-operator ::= "-r"|"-w"|"-x"|"-f"|"-d"|"-c"|"-b"|"-p"|
+ "-u"|"-g"|"-k"|"-s"|"-t"|"-z"|"-n"|"-o"|"-O"|"-G"|"-L"|"-S";
+
+ binary-operator ::= "="|"!="|"-eq"|"-ne"|"-ge"|"-gt"|"-le"|"-lt"|
+ "-nt"|"-ot"|"-ef";
+ operand ::= <any legal UNIX file name>
+*/
+
+enum token {
+ EOI,
+ FILRD,
+ FILWR,
+ FILEX,
+ FILEXIST,
+ FILREG,
+ FILDIR,
+ FILCDEV,
+ FILBDEV,
+ FILFIFO,
+ FILSOCK,
+ FILSYM,
+ FILGZ,
+ FILTT,
+ FILSUID,
+ FILSGID,
+ FILSTCK,
+ FILNT,
+ FILOT,
+ FILEQ,
+ FILUID,
+ FILGID,
+ STREZ,
+ STRNZ,
+ STREQ,
+ STRNE,
+ STRLT,
+ STRGT,
+ INTEQ,
+ INTNE,
+ INTGE,
+ INTGT,
+ INTLE,
+ INTLT,
+ UNOT,
+ BAND,
+ BOR,
+ LPAREN,
+ RPAREN,
+ OPERAND
+};
+
+enum token_types {
+ UNOP,
+ BINOP,
+ BUNOP,
+ BBINOP,
+ PAREN
+};
+
+static struct t_op {
+ const char *op_text;
+ short op_num, op_type;
+} const ops [] = {
+ {"-r", FILRD, UNOP},
+ {"-w", FILWR, UNOP},
+ {"-x", FILEX, UNOP},
+ {"-e", FILEXIST,UNOP},
+ {"-f", FILREG, UNOP},
+ {"-d", FILDIR, UNOP},
+ {"-c", FILCDEV,UNOP},
+ {"-b", FILBDEV,UNOP},
+ {"-p", FILFIFO,UNOP},
+ {"-u", FILSUID,UNOP},
+ {"-g", FILSGID,UNOP},
+ {"-k", FILSTCK,UNOP},
+ {"-s", FILGZ, UNOP},
+ {"-t", FILTT, UNOP},
+ {"-z", STREZ, UNOP},
+ {"-n", STRNZ, UNOP},
+ {"-h", FILSYM, UNOP}, /* for backwards compat */
+ {"-O", FILUID, UNOP},
+ {"-G", FILGID, UNOP},
+ {"-L", FILSYM, UNOP},
+ {"-S", FILSOCK,UNOP},
+ {"=", STREQ, BINOP},
+ {"!=", STRNE, BINOP},
+ {"<", STRLT, BINOP},
+ {">", STRGT, BINOP},
+ {"-eq", INTEQ, BINOP},
+ {"-ne", INTNE, BINOP},
+ {"-ge", INTGE, BINOP},
+ {"-gt", INTGT, BINOP},
+ {"-le", INTLE, BINOP},
+ {"-lt", INTLT, BINOP},
+ {"-nt", FILNT, BINOP},
+ {"-ot", FILOT, BINOP},
+ {"-ef", FILEQ, BINOP},
+ {"!", UNOT, BUNOP},
+ {"-a", BAND, BBINOP},
+ {"-o", BOR, BBINOP},
+ {"(", LPAREN, PAREN},
+ {")", RPAREN, PAREN},
+ {0, 0, 0}
+};
+
+static char **t_wp;
+static struct t_op const *t_wp_op;
+
+static void syntax(const char *, const char *);
+static int oexpr(enum token);
+static int aexpr(enum token);
+static int nexpr(enum token);
+static int primary(enum token);
+static int binop(void);
+static int filstat(char *, enum token);
+static enum token t_lex(char **);
+static int isoperand(char **);
+static int newerf(const char *, const char *);
+static int olderf(const char *, const char *);
+static int equalf(const char *, const char *);
+#ifdef HAVE_FACCESSAT
+static int test_file_access(const char *, int);
+#else
+static int test_st_mode(const struct stat64 *, int);
+static int bash_group_member(gid_t);
+#endif
+
+static inline intmax_t getn(const char *s)
+{
+ return atomax10(s);
+}
+
+static const struct t_op *getop(const char *s)
+{
+ const struct t_op *op;
+
+ for (op = ops; op->op_text; op++) {
+ if (strcmp(s, op->op_text) == 0)
+ return op;
+ }
+
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+int
+testcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ const struct t_op *op;
+ enum token n;
+ int res;
+
+ if (*argv[0] == '[') {
+ if (*argv[--argc] != ']')
+ error("missing ]");
+ argv[argc] = NULL;
+ }
+
+ argv++;
+ argc--;
+
+ if (argc < 1)
+ return 1;
+
+ /*
+ * POSIX prescriptions: he who wrote this deserves the Nobel
+ * peace prize.
+ */
+ switch (argc) {
+ case 3:
+ op = getop(argv[1]);
+ if (op && op->op_type == BINOP) {
+ n = OPERAND;
+ goto eval;
+ }
+ /* fall through */
+
+ case 4:
+ if (!strcmp(argv[0], "(") && !strcmp(argv[argc - 1], ")")) {
+ argv[--argc] = NULL;
+ argv++;
+ argc--;
+ }
+ }
+
+ n = t_lex(argv);
+
+eval:
+ t_wp = argv;
+ res = !oexpr(n);
+ argv = t_wp;
+
+ if (argv[0] != NULL && argv[1] != NULL)
+ syntax(argv[0], "unexpected operator");
+
+ return res;
+}
+
+static void
+syntax(const char *op, const char *msg)
+{
+ if (op && *op)
+ error("%s: %s", op, msg);
+ else
+ error("%s", msg);
+}
+
+static int
+oexpr(enum token n)
+{
+ int res = 0;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ res |= aexpr(n);
+ n = t_lex(t_wp + 1);
+ if (n != BOR)
+ break;
+ n = t_lex(t_wp += 2);
+ }
+ return res;
+}
+
+static int
+aexpr(enum token n)
+{
+ int res = 1;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ if (!nexpr(n))
+ res = 0;
+ n = t_lex(t_wp + 1);
+ if (n != BAND)
+ break;
+ n = t_lex(t_wp += 2);
+ }
+ return res;
+}
+
+static int
+nexpr(enum token n)
+{
+ if (n == UNOT)
+ return !nexpr(t_lex(++t_wp));
+ return primary(n);
+}
+
+static int
+primary(enum token n)
+{
+ enum token nn;
+ int res;
+
+ if (n == EOI)
+ return 0; /* missing expression */
+ if (n == LPAREN) {
+ if ((nn = t_lex(++t_wp)) == RPAREN)
+ return 0; /* missing expression */
+ res = oexpr(nn);
+ if (t_lex(++t_wp) != RPAREN)
+ syntax(NULL, "closing paren expected");
+ return res;
+ }
+ if (t_wp_op && t_wp_op->op_type == UNOP) {
+ /* unary expression */
+ if (*++t_wp == NULL)
+ syntax(t_wp_op->op_text, "argument expected");
+ switch (n) {
+ case STREZ:
+ return strlen(*t_wp) == 0;
+ case STRNZ:
+ return strlen(*t_wp) != 0;
+ case FILTT:
+ return isatty(getn(*t_wp));
+#ifdef HAVE_FACCESSAT
+ case FILRD:
+ return test_file_access(*t_wp, R_OK);
+ case FILWR:
+ return test_file_access(*t_wp, W_OK);
+ case FILEX:
+ return test_file_access(*t_wp, X_OK);
+#endif
+ default:
+ return filstat(*t_wp, n);
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (t_lex(t_wp + 1), t_wp_op && t_wp_op->op_type == BINOP) {
+ return binop();
+ }
+
+ return strlen(*t_wp) > 0;
+}
+
+static int
+binop(void)
+{
+ const char *opnd1, *opnd2;
+ struct t_op const *op;
+
+ opnd1 = *t_wp;
+ (void) t_lex(++t_wp);
+ op = t_wp_op;
+
+ if ((opnd2 = *++t_wp) == (char *)0)
+ syntax(op->op_text, "argument expected");
+
+ switch (op->op_num) {
+ default:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ abort();
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+#endif
+ case STREQ:
+ return strcmp(opnd1, opnd2) == 0;
+ case STRNE:
+ return strcmp(opnd1, opnd2) != 0;
+ case STRLT:
+ return strcmp(opnd1, opnd2) < 0;
+ case STRGT:
+ return strcmp(opnd1, opnd2) > 0;
+ case INTEQ:
+ return getn(opnd1) == getn(opnd2);
+ case INTNE:
+ return getn(opnd1) != getn(opnd2);
+ case INTGE:
+ return getn(opnd1) >= getn(opnd2);
+ case INTGT:
+ return getn(opnd1) > getn(opnd2);
+ case INTLE:
+ return getn(opnd1) <= getn(opnd2);
+ case INTLT:
+ return getn(opnd1) < getn(opnd2);
+ case FILNT:
+ return newerf (opnd1, opnd2);
+ case FILOT:
+ return olderf (opnd1, opnd2);
+ case FILEQ:
+ return equalf (opnd1, opnd2);
+ }
+}
+
+static int
+filstat(char *nm, enum token mode)
+{
+ struct stat64 s;
+
+ if (mode == FILSYM ? lstat64(nm, &s) : stat64(nm, &s))
+ return 0;
+
+ switch (mode) {
+#ifndef HAVE_FACCESSAT
+ case FILRD:
+ return test_st_mode(&s, R_OK);
+ case FILWR:
+ return test_st_mode(&s, W_OK);
+ case FILEX:
+ return test_st_mode(&s, X_OK);
+#endif
+ case FILEXIST:
+ return 1;
+ case FILREG:
+ return S_ISREG(s.st_mode);
+ case FILDIR:
+ return S_ISDIR(s.st_mode);
+ case FILCDEV:
+ return S_ISCHR(s.st_mode);
+ case FILBDEV:
+ return S_ISBLK(s.st_mode);
+ case FILFIFO:
+ return S_ISFIFO(s.st_mode);
+ case FILSOCK:
+ return S_ISSOCK(s.st_mode);
+ case FILSYM:
+ return S_ISLNK(s.st_mode);
+ case FILSUID:
+ return (s.st_mode & S_ISUID) != 0;
+ case FILSGID:
+ return (s.st_mode & S_ISGID) != 0;
+ case FILSTCK:
+ return (s.st_mode & S_ISVTX) != 0;
+ case FILGZ:
+ return !!s.st_size;
+ case FILUID:
+ return s.st_uid == geteuid();
+ case FILGID:
+ return s.st_gid == getegid();
+ default:
+ return 1;
+ }
+}
+
+static enum token t_lex(char **tp)
+{
+ struct t_op const *op;
+ char *s = *tp;
+
+ if (s == 0) {
+ t_wp_op = (struct t_op *)0;
+ return EOI;
+ }
+
+ op = getop(s);
+ if (op && !(op->op_type == UNOP && isoperand(tp)) &&
+ !(op->op_num == LPAREN && !tp[1])) {
+ t_wp_op = op;
+ return op->op_num;
+ }
+
+ t_wp_op = (struct t_op *)0;
+ return OPERAND;
+}
+
+static int isoperand(char **tp)
+{
+ struct t_op const *op;
+ char *s;
+
+ if (!(s = tp[1]))
+ return 1;
+ if (!tp[2])
+ return 0;
+
+ op = getop(s);
+ return op && op->op_type == BINOP;
+}
+
+static int
+newerf (const char *f1, const char *f2)
+{
+ struct stat b1, b2;
+
+ return (stat (f1, &b1) == 0 &&
+ stat (f2, &b2) == 0 &&
+ b1.st_mtime > b2.st_mtime);
+}
+
+static int
+olderf (const char *f1, const char *f2)
+{
+ struct stat b1, b2;
+
+ return (stat (f1, &b1) == 0 &&
+ stat (f2, &b2) == 0 &&
+ b1.st_mtime < b2.st_mtime);
+}
+
+static int
+equalf (const char *f1, const char *f2)
+{
+ struct stat b1, b2;
+
+ return (stat (f1, &b1) == 0 &&
+ stat (f2, &b2) == 0 &&
+ b1.st_dev == b2.st_dev &&
+ b1.st_ino == b2.st_ino);
+}
+
+#ifdef HAVE_FACCESSAT
+static int test_file_access(const char *path, int mode)
+{
+ return !faccessat(AT_FDCWD, path, mode, AT_EACCESS);
+}
+#else /* HAVE_FACCESSAT */
+/*
+ * Similar to what access(2) does, but uses the effective uid and gid.
+ * Doesn't make the mistake of telling root that any file is executable.
+ * Returns non-zero if the file is accessible.
+ */
+static int
+test_st_mode(const struct stat64 *st, int mode)
+{
+ int euid = geteuid();
+
+ if (euid == 0) {
+ /* Root can read or write any file. */
+ if (mode != X_OK)
+ return 1;
+
+ /* Root can execute any file that has any one of the execute
+ bits set. */
+ mode = S_IXUSR | S_IXGRP | S_IXOTH;
+ } else if (st->st_uid == euid)
+ mode <<= 6;
+ else if (bash_group_member(st->st_gid))
+ mode <<= 3;
+
+ return st->st_mode & mode;
+}
+
+/* Return non-zero if GID is one that we have in our groups list. */
+static int
+bash_group_member(gid_t gid)
+{
+ register int i;
+ gid_t *group_array;
+ int ngroups;
+
+ /* Short-circuit if possible, maybe saving a call to getgroups(). */
+ if (gid == getgid() || gid == getegid())
+ return (1);
+
+ ngroups = getgroups(0, NULL);
+ group_array = stalloc(ngroups * sizeof(gid_t));
+ if ((getgroups(ngroups, group_array)) != ngroups)
+ return (0);
+
+ /* Search through the list looking for GID. */
+ for (i = 0; i < ngroups; i++)
+ if (gid == group_array[i])
+ return (1);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+#endif /* HAVE_FACCESSAT */
diff --git a/usr/dash/builtins.def.in b/usr/dash/builtins.def.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e116963
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/builtins.def.in
@@ -0,0 +1,93 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)builtins.def 8.4 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+/*
+ * This file lists all the builtin commands. The first column is the name
+ * of a C routine.
+ * The -a flag specifies that this is a posix 'assignment builtin' command.
+ * The -s flag specifies that this is a posix 'special builtin' command.
+ * The -u flag specifies that this is a posix 'standard utility'.
+ * The -n flag specifies that this command has a special entry point.
+ * The rest of the line specifies the command name or names used to run
+ * the command.
+ */
+
+#ifndef JOBS
+#define JOBS 1
+#endif
+
+#if JOBS
+bgcmd -u bg
+fgcmd -u fg
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SMALL
+histcmd -u fc
+#endif
+
+breakcmd -s break -s continue
+cdcmd -u cd chdir
+commandcmd -u command
+dotcmd -s .
+echocmd echo
+evalcmd -ns eval
+execcmd -s exec
+exitcmd -s exit
+exportcmd -as export -as readonly
+falsecmd -u false
+getoptscmd -u getopts
+hashcmd hash
+jobscmd -u jobs
+localcmd -as local
+printfcmd printf
+pwdcmd pwd
+readcmd -u read
+returncmd -s return
+setcmd -s set
+shiftcmd -s shift
+trapcmd -s trap
+truecmd -s : -u true
+typecmd type
+umaskcmd -u umask
+unaliascmd -u unalias
+unsetcmd -s unset
+waitcmd -u wait
+aliascmd -au alias
+#ifdef HAVE_GETRLIMIT
+ulimitcmd ulimit
+#endif
+testcmd test [
+killcmd -u kill
diff --git a/usr/dash/cd.c b/usr/dash/cd.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..89c6c30
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/cd.c
@@ -0,0 +1,313 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+
+/*
+ * The cd and pwd commands.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "nodes.h" /* for jobs.h */
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "cd.h"
+
+#define CD_PHYSICAL 1
+#define CD_PRINT 2
+
+STATIC int docd(const char *, int);
+STATIC const char *updatepwd(const char *);
+STATIC char *getpwd(void);
+STATIC int cdopt(void);
+
+STATIC char *curdir = nullstr; /* current working directory */
+STATIC char *physdir = nullstr; /* physical working directory */
+
+STATIC int
+cdopt()
+{
+ int flags = 0;
+ int i, j;
+
+ j = 'L';
+ while ((i = nextopt("LP"))) {
+ if (i != j) {
+ flags ^= CD_PHYSICAL;
+ j = i;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return flags;
+}
+
+int
+cdcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ const char *dest;
+ const char *path;
+ const char *p;
+ char c;
+ struct stat statb;
+ int flags;
+
+ flags = cdopt();
+ dest = *argptr;
+ if (!dest)
+ dest = bltinlookup(homestr);
+ else if (dest[0] == '-' && dest[1] == '\0') {
+ dest = bltinlookup("OLDPWD");
+ flags |= CD_PRINT;
+ }
+ if (!dest)
+ dest = nullstr;
+ if (*dest == '/')
+ goto step6;
+ if (*dest == '.') {
+ c = dest[1];
+dotdot:
+ switch (c) {
+ case '\0':
+ case '/':
+ goto step6;
+ case '.':
+ c = dest[2];
+ if (c != '.')
+ goto dotdot;
+ }
+ }
+ if (!*dest)
+ dest = ".";
+ path = bltinlookup("CDPATH");
+ while (path) {
+ c = *path;
+ p = padvance(&path, dest);
+ if (stat(p, &statb) >= 0 && S_ISDIR(statb.st_mode)) {
+ if (c && c != ':')
+ flags |= CD_PRINT;
+docd:
+ if (!docd(p, flags))
+ goto out;
+ goto err;
+ }
+ }
+
+step6:
+ p = dest;
+ goto docd;
+
+err:
+ sh_error("can't cd to %s", dest);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+out:
+ if (flags & CD_PRINT)
+ out1fmt(snlfmt, curdir);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Actually do the chdir. We also call hashcd to let the routines in exec.c
+ * know that the current directory has changed.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+docd(const char *dest, int flags)
+{
+ const char *dir = 0;
+ int err;
+
+ TRACE(("docd(\"%s\", %d) called\n", dest, flags));
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if (!(flags & CD_PHYSICAL)) {
+ dir = updatepwd(dest);
+ if (dir)
+ dest = dir;
+ }
+ err = chdir(dest);
+ if (err)
+ goto out;
+ setpwd(dir, 1);
+ hashcd();
+out:
+ INTON;
+ return err;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Update curdir (the name of the current directory) in response to a
+ * cd command.
+ */
+
+STATIC const char *
+updatepwd(const char *dir)
+{
+ char *new;
+ char *p;
+ char *cdcomppath;
+ const char *lim;
+
+ cdcomppath = sstrdup(dir);
+ STARTSTACKSTR(new);
+ if (*dir != '/') {
+ if (curdir == nullstr)
+ return 0;
+ new = stputs(curdir, new);
+ }
+ new = makestrspace(strlen(dir) + 2, new);
+ lim = stackblock() + 1;
+ if (*dir != '/') {
+ if (new[-1] != '/')
+ USTPUTC('/', new);
+ if (new > lim && *lim == '/')
+ lim++;
+ } else {
+ USTPUTC('/', new);
+ cdcomppath++;
+ if (dir[1] == '/' && dir[2] != '/') {
+ USTPUTC('/', new);
+ cdcomppath++;
+ lim++;
+ }
+ }
+ p = strtok(cdcomppath, "/");
+ while (p) {
+ switch(*p) {
+ case '.':
+ if (p[1] == '.' && p[2] == '\0') {
+ while (new > lim) {
+ STUNPUTC(new);
+ if (new[-1] == '/')
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ } else if (p[1] == '\0')
+ break;
+ /* fall through */
+ default:
+ new = stputs(p, new);
+ USTPUTC('/', new);
+ }
+ p = strtok(0, "/");
+ }
+ if (new > lim)
+ STUNPUTC(new);
+ *new = 0;
+ return stackblock();
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Find out what the current directory is. If we already know the current
+ * directory, this routine returns immediately.
+ */
+inline
+STATIC char *
+getpwd()
+{
+#ifdef __GLIBC__
+ char *dir = getcwd(0, 0);
+ if (dir)
+ return dir;
+#else
+ char buf[PATH_MAX];
+ if(getcwd(buf, sizeof(buf)))
+ return savestr(buf);
+#endif
+ sh_warnx("getcwd() failed: %s", strerror(errno));
+ return nullstr;
+}
+
+int
+pwdcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int flags;
+ const char *dir = curdir;
+
+ flags = cdopt();
+ if (flags) {
+ if (physdir == nullstr)
+ setpwd(dir, 0);
+ dir = physdir;
+ }
+ out1fmt(snlfmt, dir);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+void
+setpwd(const char *val, int setold)
+{
+ char *oldcur, *dir;
+
+ oldcur = dir = curdir;
+
+ if (setold) {
+ setvar("OLDPWD", oldcur, VEXPORT);
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ if (physdir != nullstr) {
+ if (physdir != oldcur)
+ free(physdir);
+ physdir = nullstr;
+ }
+ if (oldcur == val || !val) {
+ char *s = getpwd();
+ physdir = s;
+ if (!val)
+ dir = s;
+ } else
+ dir = savestr(val);
+ if (oldcur != dir && oldcur != nullstr) {
+ free(oldcur);
+ }
+ curdir = dir;
+ INTON;
+ setvar("PWD", dir, VEXPORT);
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/cd.h b/usr/dash/cd.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8763161
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/cd.h
@@ -0,0 +1,35 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1995
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ */
+
+int cdcmd(int, char **);
+int pwdcmd(int, char **);
+void setpwd(const char *, int);
diff --git a/usr/dash/config.h b/usr/dash/config.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9757009
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/config.h
@@ -0,0 +1,191 @@
+/* config.h. Generated from config.h.in by configure. */
+/* config.h.in. Generated from configure.ac by autoheader. */
+
+/* Define if __attribute__((__alias__())) is supported */
+#define HAVE_ALIAS_ATTRIBUTE 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <alloca.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_ALLOCA_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `bsearch' function. */
+#define HAVE_BSEARCH 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the declaration of `isblank', and to 0 if you
+ don't. */
+#define HAVE_DECL_ISBLANK 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `faccessat' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_FACCESSAT */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `fnmatch' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_FNMATCH */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `getpwnam' function. */
+#define HAVE_GETPWNAM 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `getrlimit' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_GETRLIMIT */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `glob' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_GLOB */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <inttypes.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_INTTYPES_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `isalpha' function. */
+#define HAVE_ISALPHA 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `killpg' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_KILLPG */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <memory.h> header file. */
+/* #undef HAVE_MEMORY_H */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `mempcpy' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_MEMPCPY */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <paths.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_PATHS_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `sigsetmask' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_SIGSETMASK */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdint.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_STDINT_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdlib.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_STDLIB_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `stpcpy' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_STPCPY */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `strchrnul' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_STRCHRNUL */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <strings.h> header file. */
+/* #undef HAVE_STRINGS_H */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <string.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_STRING_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `strsignal' function. */
+#define HAVE_STRSIGNAL 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `strtod' function. */
+/* #undef HAVE_STRTOD */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `strtoimax' function. */
+#define HAVE_STRTOIMAX 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `strtoumax' function. */
+#define HAVE_STRTOUMAX 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the `sysconf' function. */
+#define HAVE_SYSCONF 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/stat.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_SYS_STAT_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/types.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the <unistd.h> header file. */
+#define HAVE_UNISTD_H 1
+
+/* Name of package */
+#define PACKAGE "dash"
+
+/* Define to the address where bug reports for this package should be sent. */
+#define PACKAGE_BUGREPORT ""
+
+/* Define to the full name of this package. */
+#define PACKAGE_NAME "dash"
+
+/* Define to the full name and version of this package. */
+#define PACKAGE_STRING "dash 0.5.7"
+
+/* Define to the one symbol short name of this package. */
+#define PACKAGE_TARNAME "dash"
+
+/* Define to the home page for this package. */
+#define PACKAGE_URL ""
+
+/* Define to the version of this package. */
+#define PACKAGE_VERSION "0.5.7"
+
+/* Define to printf format string for intmax_t */
+/* #undef PRIdMAX */
+
+/* The size of `intmax_t', as computed by sizeof. */
+#define SIZEOF_INTMAX_T 8
+
+/* The size of `long long int', as computed by sizeof. */
+#define SIZEOF_LONG_LONG_INT 8
+
+/* Define if you build with -DSMALL */
+#define SMALL 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if you have the ANSI C header files. */
+/* #undef STDC_HEADERS */
+
+/* Enable extensions on AIX 3, Interix. */
+#ifndef _ALL_SOURCE
+# define _ALL_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+/* Enable GNU extensions on systems that have them. */
+#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+/* Enable threading extensions on Solaris. */
+#ifndef _POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS
+# define _POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS 1
+#endif
+/* Enable extensions on HP NonStop. */
+#ifndef _TANDEM_SOURCE
+# define _TANDEM_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+/* Enable general extensions on Solaris. */
+#ifndef __EXTENSIONS__
+# define __EXTENSIONS__ 1
+#endif
+
+
+/* Version number of package */
+#define VERSION "0.5.7"
+
+/* Define if you build with -DWITH_LINENO */
+#define WITH_LINENO 1
+
+/* Define to 1 if on MINIX. */
+/* #undef _MINIX */
+
+/* Define to system shell path */
+/* #undef _PATH_BSHELL */
+
+/* Define to devnull device node path */
+/* #undef _PATH_DEVNULL */
+
+/* Define to tty device node path */
+/* #undef _PATH_TTY */
+
+/* Define to 2 if the system does not provide POSIX.1 features except with
+ this defined. */
+/* #undef _POSIX_1_SOURCE */
+
+/* Define to 1 if you need to in order for `stat' and other things to work. */
+/* #undef _POSIX_SOURCE */
+
+/* 64-bit operations are the same as 32-bit */
+#define fstat64 fstat
+
+/* 64-bit operations are the same as 32-bit */
+#define lstat64 lstat
+
+/* 64-bit operations are the same as 32-bit */
+#define open64 open
+
+/* klibc has bsd_signal instead of signal */
+/* #undef signal */
+
+/* 64-bit operations are the same as 32-bit */
+#define stat64 stat
diff --git a/usr/dash/error.c b/usr/dash/error.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9d31989
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/error.c
@@ -0,0 +1,232 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Errors and exceptions.
+ */
+
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+
+/*
+ * Code to handle exceptions in C.
+ */
+
+struct jmploc *handler;
+int exception;
+int suppressint;
+volatile sig_atomic_t intpending;
+int errlinno;
+
+
+static void exverror(int, const char *, va_list)
+ __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+
+/*
+ * Called to raise an exception. Since C doesn't include exceptions, we
+ * just do a longjmp to the exception handler. The type of exception is
+ * stored in the global variable "exception".
+ */
+
+void
+exraise(int e)
+{
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (handler == NULL)
+ abort();
+#endif
+ INTOFF;
+
+ exception = e;
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called from trap.c when a SIGINT is received. (If the user specifies
+ * that SIGINT is to be trapped or ignored using the trap builtin, then
+ * this routine is not called.) Suppressint is nonzero when interrupts
+ * are held using the INTOFF macro. (The test for iflag is just
+ * defensive programming.)
+ */
+
+void
+onint(void) {
+
+ intpending = 0;
+ sigclearmask();
+ if (!(rootshell && iflag)) {
+ signal(SIGINT, SIG_DFL);
+ raise(SIGINT);
+ }
+ exraise(EXINT);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+static void
+exvwarning2(const char *msg, va_list ap)
+{
+ struct output *errs;
+ const char *name;
+ const char *fmt;
+
+ errs = out2;
+ name = arg0 ? arg0 : "sh";
+ if (!commandname)
+ fmt = "%s: %d: ";
+ else
+ fmt = "%s: %d: %s: ";
+ outfmt(errs, fmt, name, errlinno, commandname);
+ doformat(errs, msg, ap);
+#if FLUSHERR
+ outc('\n', errs);
+#else
+ outcslow('\n', errs);
+#endif
+}
+
+#define exvwarning(a, b, c) exvwarning2(b, c)
+
+/*
+ * Exverror is called to raise the error exception. If the second argument
+ * is not NULL then error prints an error message using printf style
+ * formatting. It then raises the error exception.
+ */
+static void
+exverror(int cond, const char *msg, va_list ap)
+{
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (msg) {
+ va_list aq;
+ TRACE(("exverror(%d, \"", cond));
+ va_copy(aq, ap);
+ TRACEV((msg, aq));
+ va_end(aq);
+ TRACE(("\") pid=%d\n", getpid()));
+ } else
+ TRACE(("exverror(%d, NULL) pid=%d\n", cond, getpid()));
+ if (msg)
+#endif
+ exvwarning(-1, msg, ap);
+
+ flushall();
+ exraise(cond);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+void
+sh_error(const char *msg, ...)
+{
+ va_list ap;
+
+ exitstatus = 2;
+
+ va_start(ap, msg);
+ exverror(EXERROR, msg, ap);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+
+void
+exerror(int cond, const char *msg, ...)
+{
+ va_list ap;
+
+ va_start(ap, msg);
+ exverror(cond, msg, ap);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+/*
+ * error/warning routines for external builtins
+ */
+
+void
+sh_warnx(const char *fmt, ...)
+{
+ va_list ap;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ exvwarning(-1, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Return a string describing an error. The returned string may be a
+ * pointer to a static buffer that will be overwritten on the next call.
+ * Action describes the operation that got the error.
+ */
+
+const char *
+errmsg(int e, int action)
+{
+ if (e != ENOENT && e != ENOTDIR)
+ return strerror(e);
+
+ if (action & E_OPEN)
+ return "No such file";
+ else if (action & E_CREAT)
+ return "Directory nonexistent";
+ else
+ return "not found";
+}
+
+
+#ifdef REALLY_SMALL
+void
+__inton() {
+ if (--suppressint == 0 && intpending) {
+ onint();
+ }
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/error.h b/usr/dash/error.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f91d11d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/error.h
@@ -0,0 +1,133 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)error.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#ifndef DASH_ERROR_H
+#define DASH_ERROR_H
+
+#include <setjmp.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+
+/*
+ * Types of operations (passed to the errmsg routine).
+ */
+
+#define E_OPEN 01 /* opening a file */
+#define E_CREAT 02 /* creating a file */
+#define E_EXEC 04 /* executing a program */
+
+
+/*
+ * We enclose jmp_buf in a structure so that we can declare pointers to
+ * jump locations. The global variable handler contains the location to
+ * jump to when an exception occurs, and the global variable exception
+ * contains a code identifying the exeception. To implement nested
+ * exception handlers, the user should save the value of handler on entry
+ * to an inner scope, set handler to point to a jmploc structure for the
+ * inner scope, and restore handler on exit from the scope.
+ */
+
+struct jmploc {
+ jmp_buf loc;
+};
+
+extern struct jmploc *handler;
+extern int exception;
+
+/* exceptions */
+#define EXINT 0 /* SIGINT received */
+#define EXERROR 1 /* a generic error */
+#define EXEXIT 4 /* exit the shell */
+
+
+/*
+ * These macros allow the user to suspend the handling of interrupt signals
+ * over a period of time. This is similar to SIGHOLD to or sigblock, but
+ * much more efficient and portable. (But hacking the kernel is so much
+ * more fun than worrying about efficiency and portability. :-))
+ */
+
+extern int suppressint;
+extern volatile sig_atomic_t intpending;
+
+#define barrier() ({ __asm__ __volatile__ ("": : :"memory"); })
+#define INTOFF \
+ ({ \
+ suppressint++; \
+ barrier(); \
+ 0; \
+ })
+#ifdef REALLY_SMALL
+void __inton(void);
+#define INTON __inton()
+#else
+#define INTON \
+ ({ \
+ barrier(); \
+ if (--suppressint == 0 && intpending) onint(); \
+ 0; \
+ })
+#endif
+#define FORCEINTON \
+ ({ \
+ barrier(); \
+ suppressint = 0; \
+ if (intpending) onint(); \
+ 0; \
+ })
+#define SAVEINT(v) ((v) = suppressint)
+#define RESTOREINT(v) \
+ ({ \
+ barrier(); \
+ if ((suppressint = (v)) == 0 && intpending) onint(); \
+ 0; \
+ })
+#define CLEAR_PENDING_INT intpending = 0
+#define int_pending() intpending
+
+void exraise(int) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+#ifdef USE_NORETURN
+void onint(void) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+#else
+void onint(void);
+#endif
+extern int errlinno;
+void sh_error(const char *, ...) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+void exerror(int, const char *, ...) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+const char *errmsg(int, int);
+
+void sh_warnx(const char *, ...);
+
+#endif /* DASH_ERROR_H */
diff --git a/usr/dash/eval.c b/usr/dash/eval.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..145e0b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/eval.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1092 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+/*
+ * Evaluate a command.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "builtins.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#ifndef SMALL
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+#endif
+
+
+/* flags in argument to evaltree */
+#define EV_EXIT 01 /* exit after evaluating tree */
+#define EV_TESTED 02 /* exit status is checked; ignore -e flag */
+
+int evalskip; /* set if we are skipping commands */
+STATIC int skipcount; /* number of levels to skip */
+MKINIT int loopnest; /* current loop nesting level */
+static int funcline; /* starting line number of current function, or 0 if not in a function */
+
+
+char *commandname;
+int exitstatus; /* exit status of last command */
+int back_exitstatus; /* exit status of backquoted command */
+
+
+#if !defined(__alpha__) || (defined(__GNUC__) && __GNUC__ >= 3)
+STATIC
+#endif
+void evaltreenr(union node *, int) __attribute__ ((__noreturn__));
+STATIC void evalloop(union node *, int);
+STATIC void evalfor(union node *, int);
+STATIC void evalcase(union node *, int);
+STATIC void evalsubshell(union node *, int);
+STATIC void expredir(union node *);
+STATIC void evalpipe(union node *, int);
+#ifdef notyet
+STATIC void evalcommand(union node *, int, struct backcmd *);
+#else
+STATIC void evalcommand(union node *, int);
+#endif
+STATIC int evalbltin(const struct builtincmd *, int, char **, int);
+STATIC int evalfun(struct funcnode *, int, char **, int);
+STATIC void prehash(union node *);
+STATIC int eprintlist(struct output *, struct strlist *, int);
+STATIC int bltincmd(int, char **);
+
+
+STATIC const struct builtincmd bltin = {
+ .name = nullstr,
+ .builtin = bltincmd
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to reset things after an exception.
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "eval.h"
+
+RESET {
+ evalskip = 0;
+ loopnest = 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The eval commmand.
+ */
+
+static int evalcmd(int argc, char **argv, int flags)
+{
+ char *p;
+ char *concat;
+ char **ap;
+
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ p = argv[1];
+ if (argc > 2) {
+ STARTSTACKSTR(concat);
+ ap = argv + 2;
+ for (;;) {
+ concat = stputs(p, concat);
+ if ((p = *ap++) == NULL)
+ break;
+ STPUTC(' ', concat);
+ }
+ STPUTC('\0', concat);
+ p = grabstackstr(concat);
+ }
+ return evalstring(p, flags & EV_TESTED);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Execute a command or commands contained in a string.
+ */
+
+int
+evalstring(char *s, int flags)
+{
+ union node *n;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ int status;
+
+ setinputstring(s);
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+
+ status = 0;
+ while ((n = parsecmd(0)) != NEOF) {
+ evaltree(n, flags);
+ status = exitstatus;
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ if (evalskip)
+ break;
+ }
+ popfile();
+
+ return status;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Evaluate a parse tree. The value is left in the global variable
+ * exitstatus.
+ */
+
+void
+evaltree(union node *n, int flags)
+{
+ int checkexit = 0;
+ void (*evalfn)(union node *, int);
+ unsigned isor;
+ int status;
+ if (n == NULL) {
+ TRACE(("evaltree(NULL) called\n"));
+ goto out;
+ }
+#ifndef SMALL
+ displayhist = 1; /* show history substitutions done with fc */
+#endif
+ TRACE(("pid %d, evaltree(%p: %d, %d) called\n",
+ getpid(), n, n->type, flags));
+ switch (n->type) {
+ default:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ out1fmt("Node type = %d\n", n->type);
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+ flushout(out1);
+#endif
+ break;
+#endif
+ case NNOT:
+ evaltree(n->nnot.com, EV_TESTED);
+ status = !exitstatus;
+ goto setstatus;
+ case NREDIR:
+ errlinno = lineno = n->nredir.linno;
+ if (funcline)
+ lineno -= funcline - 1;
+ expredir(n->nredir.redirect);
+ pushredir(n->nredir.redirect);
+ status = redirectsafe(n->nredir.redirect, REDIR_PUSH);
+ if (!status) {
+ evaltree(n->nredir.n, flags & EV_TESTED);
+ status = exitstatus;
+ }
+ if (n->nredir.redirect)
+ popredir(0);
+ goto setstatus;
+ case NCMD:
+#ifdef notyet
+ if (eflag && !(flags & EV_TESTED))
+ checkexit = ~0;
+ evalcommand(n, flags, (struct backcmd *)NULL);
+ break;
+#else
+ evalfn = evalcommand;
+checkexit:
+ if (eflag && !(flags & EV_TESTED))
+ checkexit = ~0;
+ goto calleval;
+#endif
+ case NFOR:
+ evalfn = evalfor;
+ goto calleval;
+ case NWHILE:
+ case NUNTIL:
+ evalfn = evalloop;
+ goto calleval;
+ case NSUBSHELL:
+ case NBACKGND:
+ evalfn = evalsubshell;
+ goto checkexit;
+ case NPIPE:
+ evalfn = evalpipe;
+ goto checkexit;
+ case NCASE:
+ evalfn = evalcase;
+ goto calleval;
+ case NAND:
+ case NOR:
+ case NSEMI:
+#if NAND + 1 != NOR
+#error NAND + 1 != NOR
+#endif
+#if NOR + 1 != NSEMI
+#error NOR + 1 != NSEMI
+#endif
+ isor = n->type - NAND;
+ evaltree(
+ n->nbinary.ch1,
+ (flags | ((isor >> 1) - 1)) & EV_TESTED
+ );
+ if ((!exitstatus) == isor)
+ break;
+ if (!evalskip) {
+ n = n->nbinary.ch2;
+evaln:
+ evalfn = evaltree;
+calleval:
+ evalfn(n, flags);
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ case NIF:
+ evaltree(n->nif.test, EV_TESTED);
+ if (evalskip)
+ break;
+ if (exitstatus == 0) {
+ n = n->nif.ifpart;
+ goto evaln;
+ } else if (n->nif.elsepart) {
+ n = n->nif.elsepart;
+ goto evaln;
+ }
+ goto success;
+ case NDEFUN:
+ defun(n);
+success:
+ status = 0;
+setstatus:
+ exitstatus = status;
+ break;
+ }
+out:
+ if (checkexit & exitstatus)
+ goto exexit;
+
+ if (pendingsigs)
+ dotrap();
+
+ if (flags & EV_EXIT) {
+exexit:
+ exraise(EXEXIT);
+ }
+}
+
+
+#if !defined(__alpha__) || (defined(__GNUC__) && __GNUC__ >= 3)
+STATIC
+#endif
+void evaltreenr(union node *n, int flags)
+#ifdef HAVE_ATTRIBUTE_ALIAS
+ __attribute__ ((alias("evaltree")));
+#else
+{
+ evaltree(n, flags);
+ abort();
+}
+#endif
+
+
+STATIC void
+evalloop(union node *n, int flags)
+{
+ int status;
+
+ loopnest++;
+ status = 0;
+ flags &= EV_TESTED;
+ for (;;) {
+ int i;
+
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch1, EV_TESTED);
+ if (evalskip) {
+skipping: if (evalskip == SKIPCONT && --skipcount <= 0) {
+ evalskip = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (evalskip == SKIPBREAK && --skipcount <= 0)
+ evalskip = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ i = exitstatus;
+ if (n->type != NWHILE)
+ i = !i;
+ if (i != 0)
+ break;
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch2, flags);
+ status = exitstatus;
+ if (evalskip)
+ goto skipping;
+ }
+ loopnest--;
+ exitstatus = status;
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+evalfor(union node *n, int flags)
+{
+ struct arglist arglist;
+ union node *argp;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+
+ errlinno = lineno = n->nfor.linno;
+ if (funcline)
+ lineno -= funcline - 1;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ arglist.lastp = &arglist.list;
+ for (argp = n->nfor.args ; argp ; argp = argp->narg.next) {
+ expandarg(argp, &arglist, EXP_FULL | EXP_TILDE);
+ /* XXX */
+ if (evalskip)
+ goto out;
+ }
+ *arglist.lastp = NULL;
+
+ exitstatus = 0;
+ loopnest++;
+ flags &= EV_TESTED;
+ for (sp = arglist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next) {
+ setvar(n->nfor.var, sp->text, 0);
+ evaltree(n->nfor.body, flags);
+ if (evalskip) {
+ if (evalskip == SKIPCONT && --skipcount <= 0) {
+ evalskip = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (evalskip == SKIPBREAK && --skipcount <= 0)
+ evalskip = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ loopnest--;
+out:
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+evalcase(union node *n, int flags)
+{
+ union node *cp;
+ union node *patp;
+ struct arglist arglist;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+
+ errlinno = lineno = n->ncase.linno;
+ if (funcline)
+ lineno -= funcline - 1;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ arglist.lastp = &arglist.list;
+ expandarg(n->ncase.expr, &arglist, EXP_TILDE);
+ exitstatus = 0;
+ for (cp = n->ncase.cases ; cp && evalskip == 0 ; cp = cp->nclist.next) {
+ for (patp = cp->nclist.pattern ; patp ; patp = patp->narg.next) {
+ if (casematch(patp, arglist.list->text)) {
+ if (evalskip == 0) {
+ evaltree(cp->nclist.body, flags);
+ }
+ goto out;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+out:
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Kick off a subshell to evaluate a tree.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+evalsubshell(union node *n, int flags)
+{
+ struct job *jp;
+ int backgnd = (n->type == NBACKGND);
+ int status;
+
+ errlinno = lineno = n->nredir.linno;
+ if (funcline)
+ lineno -= funcline - 1;
+
+ expredir(n->nredir.redirect);
+ if (!backgnd && flags & EV_EXIT && !have_traps())
+ goto nofork;
+ INTOFF;
+ jp = makejob(n, 1);
+ if (forkshell(jp, n, backgnd) == 0) {
+ INTON;
+ flags |= EV_EXIT;
+ if (backgnd)
+ flags &=~ EV_TESTED;
+nofork:
+ redirect(n->nredir.redirect, 0);
+ evaltreenr(n->nredir.n, flags);
+ /* never returns */
+ }
+ status = 0;
+ if (! backgnd)
+ status = waitforjob(jp);
+ exitstatus = status;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Compute the names of the files in a redirection list.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+expredir(union node *n)
+{
+ union node *redir;
+
+ for (redir = n ; redir ; redir = redir->nfile.next) {
+ struct arglist fn;
+ fn.lastp = &fn.list;
+ switch (redir->type) {
+ case NFROMTO:
+ case NFROM:
+ case NTO:
+ case NCLOBBER:
+ case NAPPEND:
+ expandarg(redir->nfile.fname, &fn, EXP_TILDE | EXP_REDIR);
+ redir->nfile.expfname = fn.list->text;
+ break;
+ case NFROMFD:
+ case NTOFD:
+ if (redir->ndup.vname) {
+ expandarg(redir->ndup.vname, &fn, EXP_FULL | EXP_TILDE);
+ fixredir(redir, fn.list->text, 1);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Evaluate a pipeline. All the processes in the pipeline are children
+ * of the process creating the pipeline. (This differs from some versions
+ * of the shell, which make the last process in a pipeline the parent
+ * of all the rest.)
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+evalpipe(union node *n, int flags)
+{
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ int pipelen;
+ int prevfd;
+ int pip[2];
+
+ TRACE(("evalpipe(0x%lx) called\n", (long)n));
+ pipelen = 0;
+ for (lp = n->npipe.cmdlist ; lp ; lp = lp->next)
+ pipelen++;
+ flags |= EV_EXIT;
+ INTOFF;
+ jp = makejob(n, pipelen);
+ prevfd = -1;
+ for (lp = n->npipe.cmdlist ; lp ; lp = lp->next) {
+ prehash(lp->n);
+ pip[1] = -1;
+ if (lp->next) {
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0) {
+ close(prevfd);
+ sh_error("Pipe call failed");
+ }
+ }
+ if (forkshell(jp, lp->n, n->npipe.backgnd) == 0) {
+ INTON;
+ if (pip[1] >= 0) {
+ close(pip[0]);
+ }
+ if (prevfd > 0) {
+ dup2(prevfd, 0);
+ close(prevfd);
+ }
+ if (pip[1] > 1) {
+ dup2(pip[1], 1);
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ evaltreenr(lp->n, flags);
+ /* never returns */
+ }
+ if (prevfd >= 0)
+ close(prevfd);
+ prevfd = pip[0];
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ if (n->npipe.backgnd == 0) {
+ exitstatus = waitforjob(jp);
+ TRACE(("evalpipe: job done exit status %d\n", exitstatus));
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Execute a command inside back quotes. If it's a builtin command, we
+ * want to save its output in a block obtained from malloc. Otherwise
+ * we fork off a subprocess and get the output of the command via a pipe.
+ * Should be called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+void
+evalbackcmd(union node *n, struct backcmd *result)
+{
+ int pip[2];
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ result->fd = -1;
+ result->buf = NULL;
+ result->nleft = 0;
+ result->jp = NULL;
+ if (n == NULL) {
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0)
+ sh_error("Pipe call failed");
+ jp = makejob(n, 1);
+ if (forkshell(jp, n, FORK_NOJOB) == 0) {
+ FORCEINTON;
+ close(pip[0]);
+ if (pip[1] != 1) {
+ dup2(pip[1], 1);
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ ifsfree();
+ evaltreenr(n, EV_EXIT);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+ close(pip[1]);
+ result->fd = pip[0];
+ result->jp = jp;
+
+out:
+ TRACE(("evalbackcmd done: fd=%d buf=0x%x nleft=%d jp=0x%x\n",
+ result->fd, result->buf, result->nleft, result->jp));
+}
+
+static char **
+parse_command_args(char **argv, const char **path)
+{
+ char *cp, c;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ cp = *++argv;
+ if (!cp)
+ return 0;
+ if (*cp++ != '-')
+ break;
+ if (!(c = *cp++))
+ break;
+ if (c == '-' && !*cp) {
+ if (!*++argv)
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ do {
+ switch (c) {
+ case 'p':
+ *path = defpath;
+ break;
+ default:
+ /* run 'typecmd' for other options */
+ return 0;
+ }
+ } while ((c = *cp++));
+ }
+ return argv;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Execute a simple command.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+#ifdef notyet
+evalcommand(union node *cmd, int flags, struct backcmd *backcmd)
+#else
+evalcommand(union node *cmd, int flags)
+#endif
+{
+ struct localvar_list *localvar_stop;
+ struct redirtab *redir_stop;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ union node *argp;
+ struct arglist arglist;
+ struct arglist varlist;
+ char **argv;
+ int argc;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+#ifdef notyet
+ int pip[2];
+#endif
+ struct cmdentry cmdentry;
+ struct job *jp;
+ char *lastarg;
+ const char *path;
+ int spclbltin;
+ int execcmd;
+ int status;
+ char **nargv;
+
+ errlinno = lineno = cmd->ncmd.linno;
+ if (funcline)
+ lineno -= funcline - 1;
+
+ /* First expand the arguments. */
+ TRACE(("evalcommand(0x%lx, %d) called\n", (long)cmd, flags));
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ localvar_stop = pushlocalvars();
+ back_exitstatus = 0;
+
+ cmdentry.cmdtype = CMDBUILTIN;
+ cmdentry.u.cmd = &bltin;
+ varlist.lastp = &varlist.list;
+ *varlist.lastp = NULL;
+ arglist.lastp = &arglist.list;
+ *arglist.lastp = NULL;
+
+ argc = 0;
+ for (argp = cmd->ncmd.args; argp; argp = argp->narg.next) {
+ struct strlist **spp;
+
+ spp = arglist.lastp;
+ expandarg(argp, &arglist, EXP_FULL | EXP_TILDE);
+ for (sp = *spp; sp; sp = sp->next)
+ argc++;
+ }
+
+ /* Reserve one extra spot at the front for shellexec. */
+ nargv = stalloc(sizeof (char *) * (argc + 2));
+ argv = ++nargv;
+ for (sp = arglist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next) {
+ TRACE(("evalcommand arg: %s\n", sp->text));
+ *nargv++ = sp->text;
+ }
+ *nargv = NULL;
+
+ lastarg = NULL;
+ if (iflag && funcline == 0 && argc > 0)
+ lastarg = nargv[-1];
+
+ preverrout.fd = 2;
+ expredir(cmd->ncmd.redirect);
+ redir_stop = pushredir(cmd->ncmd.redirect);
+ status = redirectsafe(cmd->ncmd.redirect, REDIR_PUSH|REDIR_SAVEFD2);
+
+ path = vpath.text;
+ for (argp = cmd->ncmd.assign; argp; argp = argp->narg.next) {
+ struct strlist **spp;
+ char *p;
+
+ spp = varlist.lastp;
+ expandarg(argp, &varlist, EXP_VARTILDE);
+
+ mklocal((*spp)->text);
+
+ /*
+ * Modify the command lookup path, if a PATH= assignment
+ * is present
+ */
+ p = (*spp)->text;
+ if (varequal(p, path))
+ path = p;
+ }
+
+ /* Print the command if xflag is set. */
+ if (xflag) {
+ struct output *out;
+ int sep;
+
+ out = &preverrout;
+ outstr(expandstr(ps4val()), out);
+ sep = 0;
+ sep = eprintlist(out, varlist.list, sep);
+ eprintlist(out, arglist.list, sep);
+ outcslow('\n', out);
+#ifdef FLUSHERR
+ flushout(out);
+#endif
+ }
+
+ execcmd = 0;
+ spclbltin = -1;
+
+ /* Now locate the command. */
+ if (argc) {
+ const char *oldpath;
+ int cmd_flag = DO_ERR;
+
+ path += 5;
+ oldpath = path;
+ for (;;) {
+ find_command(argv[0], &cmdentry, cmd_flag, path);
+ if (cmdentry.cmdtype == CMDUNKNOWN) {
+ status = 127;
+#ifdef FLUSHERR
+ flushout(&errout);
+#endif
+ goto bail;
+ }
+
+ /* implement bltin and command here */
+ if (cmdentry.cmdtype != CMDBUILTIN)
+ break;
+ if (spclbltin < 0)
+ spclbltin =
+ cmdentry.u.cmd->flags &
+ BUILTIN_SPECIAL
+ ;
+ if (cmdentry.u.cmd == EXECCMD)
+ execcmd++;
+ if (cmdentry.u.cmd != COMMANDCMD)
+ break;
+
+ path = oldpath;
+ nargv = parse_command_args(argv, &path);
+ if (!nargv)
+ break;
+ argc -= nargv - argv;
+ argv = nargv;
+ cmd_flag |= DO_NOFUNC;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (status) {
+bail:
+ exitstatus = status;
+
+ /* We have a redirection error. */
+ if (spclbltin > 0)
+ exraise(EXERROR);
+
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ /* Execute the command. */
+ switch (cmdentry.cmdtype) {
+ default:
+ /* Fork off a child process if necessary. */
+ if (!(flags & EV_EXIT) || have_traps()) {
+ INTOFF;
+ jp = makejob(cmd, 1);
+ if (forkshell(jp, cmd, FORK_FG) != 0) {
+ exitstatus = waitforjob(jp);
+ INTON;
+ break;
+ }
+ FORCEINTON;
+ }
+ listsetvar(varlist.list, VEXPORT|VSTACK);
+ shellexec(argv, path, cmdentry.u.index);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+
+ case CMDBUILTIN:
+ if (spclbltin > 0 || argc == 0) {
+ poplocalvars(1);
+ if (execcmd && argc > 1)
+ listsetvar(varlist.list, VEXPORT);
+ }
+ if (evalbltin(cmdentry.u.cmd, argc, argv, flags)) {
+ int status;
+ int i;
+
+ i = exception;
+ if (i == EXEXIT)
+ goto raise;
+
+ status = (i == EXINT) ? SIGINT + 128 : 2;
+ exitstatus = status;
+
+ if (i == EXINT || spclbltin > 0) {
+raise:
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+ }
+ FORCEINTON;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case CMDFUNCTION:
+ poplocalvars(1);
+ if (evalfun(cmdentry.u.func, argc, argv, flags))
+ goto raise;
+ break;
+ }
+
+out:
+ if (cmd->ncmd.redirect)
+ popredir(execcmd);
+ unwindredir(redir_stop);
+ unwindlocalvars(localvar_stop);
+ if (lastarg)
+ /* dsl: I think this is intended to be used to support
+ * '_' in 'vi' command mode during line editing...
+ * However I implemented that within libedit itself.
+ */
+ setvar("_", lastarg, 0);
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+STATIC int
+evalbltin(const struct builtincmd *cmd, int argc, char **argv, int flags)
+{
+ char *volatile savecmdname;
+ struct jmploc *volatile savehandler;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ int status;
+ int i;
+
+ savecmdname = commandname;
+ savehandler = handler;
+ if ((i = setjmp(jmploc.loc)))
+ goto cmddone;
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ commandname = argv[0];
+ argptr = argv + 1;
+ optptr = NULL; /* initialize nextopt */
+ if (cmd == EVALCMD)
+ status = evalcmd(argc, argv, flags);
+ else
+ status = (*cmd->builtin)(argc, argv);
+ flushall();
+ status |= outerr(out1);
+ exitstatus = status;
+cmddone:
+ freestdout();
+ commandname = savecmdname;
+ handler = savehandler;
+
+ return i;
+}
+
+STATIC int
+evalfun(struct funcnode *func, int argc, char **argv, int flags)
+{
+ volatile struct shparam saveparam;
+ struct jmploc *volatile savehandler;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ int e;
+ int savefuncline;
+
+ saveparam = shellparam;
+ savefuncline = funcline;
+ savehandler = handler;
+ if ((e = setjmp(jmploc.loc))) {
+ goto funcdone;
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ shellparam.malloc = 0;
+ func->count++;
+ funcline = func->n.ndefun.linno;
+ INTON;
+ shellparam.nparam = argc - 1;
+ shellparam.p = argv + 1;
+ shellparam.optind = 1;
+ shellparam.optoff = -1;
+ pushlocalvars();
+ evaltree(func->n.ndefun.body, flags & EV_TESTED);
+ poplocalvars(0);
+funcdone:
+ INTOFF;
+ funcline = savefuncline;
+ freefunc(func);
+ freeparam(&shellparam);
+ shellparam = saveparam;
+ handler = savehandler;
+ INTON;
+ evalskip &= ~SKIPFUNC;
+ return e;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Search for a command. This is called before we fork so that the
+ * location of the command will be available in the parent as well as
+ * the child. The check for "goodname" is an overly conservative
+ * check that the name will not be subject to expansion.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+prehash(union node *n)
+{
+ struct cmdentry entry;
+
+ if (n->type == NCMD && n->ncmd.args)
+ if (goodname(n->ncmd.args->narg.text))
+ find_command(n->ncmd.args->narg.text, &entry, 0,
+ pathval());
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Builtin commands. Builtin commands whose functions are closely
+ * tied to evaluation are implemented here.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * No command given.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+bltincmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ /*
+ * Preserve exitstatus of a previous possible redirection
+ * as POSIX mandates
+ */
+ return back_exitstatus;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Handle break and continue commands. Break, continue, and return are
+ * all handled by setting the evalskip flag. The evaluation routines
+ * above all check this flag, and if it is set they start skipping
+ * commands rather than executing them. The variable skipcount is
+ * the number of loops to break/continue, or the number of function
+ * levels to return. (The latter is always 1.) It should probably
+ * be an error to break out of more loops than exist, but it isn't
+ * in the standard shell so we don't make it one here.
+ */
+
+int
+breakcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int n = argc > 1 ? number(argv[1]) : 1;
+
+ if (n <= 0)
+ badnum(argv[1]);
+ if (n > loopnest)
+ n = loopnest;
+ if (n > 0) {
+ evalskip = (**argv == 'c')? SKIPCONT : SKIPBREAK;
+ skipcount = n;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * The return command.
+ */
+
+int
+returncmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ /*
+ * If called outside a function, do what ksh does;
+ * skip the rest of the file.
+ */
+ evalskip = SKIPFUNC;
+ return argv[1] ? number(argv[1]) : exitstatus;
+}
+
+
+int
+falsecmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+int
+truecmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+int
+execcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ iflag = 0; /* exit on error */
+ mflag = 0;
+ optschanged();
+ shellexec(argv + 1, pathval(), 0);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+STATIC int
+eprintlist(struct output *out, struct strlist *sp, int sep)
+{
+ while (sp) {
+ const char *p;
+
+ p = " %s";
+ p += (1 - sep);
+ sep |= 1;
+ outfmt(out, p, sp->text);
+ sp = sp->next;
+ }
+
+ return sep;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/eval.h b/usr/dash/eval.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5ccfa9f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/eval.h
@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)eval.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+extern char *commandname; /* currently executing command */
+extern int exitstatus; /* exit status of last command */
+extern int back_exitstatus; /* exit status of backquoted command */
+
+
+struct backcmd { /* result of evalbackcmd */
+ int fd; /* file descriptor to read from */
+ char *buf; /* buffer */
+ int nleft; /* number of chars in buffer */
+ struct job *jp; /* job structure for command */
+};
+
+int evalstring(char *, int);
+union node; /* BLETCH for ansi C */
+void evaltree(union node *, int);
+void evalbackcmd(union node *, struct backcmd *);
+
+extern int evalskip;
+
+/* reasons for skipping commands (see comment on breakcmd routine) */
+#define SKIPBREAK (1 << 0)
+#define SKIPCONT (1 << 1)
+#define SKIPFUNC (1 << 2)
diff --git a/usr/dash/exec.c b/usr/dash/exec.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..79e2007
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/exec.c
@@ -0,0 +1,859 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_PATHS_H
+#include <paths.h>
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * When commands are first encountered, they are entered in a hash table.
+ * This ensures that a full path search will not have to be done for them
+ * on each invocation.
+ *
+ * We should investigate converting to a linear search, even though that
+ * would make the command name "hash" a misnomer.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "builtins.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "init.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "alias.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+
+#define CMDTABLESIZE 31 /* should be prime */
+#define ARB 1 /* actual size determined at run time */
+
+
+
+struct tblentry {
+ struct tblentry *next; /* next entry in hash chain */
+ union param param; /* definition of builtin function */
+ short cmdtype; /* index identifying command */
+ char rehash; /* if set, cd done since entry created */
+ char cmdname[ARB]; /* name of command */
+};
+
+
+STATIC struct tblentry *cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE];
+STATIC int builtinloc = -1; /* index in path of %builtin, or -1 */
+
+
+STATIC void tryexec(char *, char **, char **);
+STATIC void printentry(struct tblentry *);
+STATIC void clearcmdentry(int);
+STATIC struct tblentry *cmdlookup(const char *, int);
+STATIC void delete_cmd_entry(void);
+STATIC void addcmdentry(char *, struct cmdentry *);
+STATIC int describe_command(struct output *, char *, int);
+
+
+/*
+ * Exec a program. Never returns. If you change this routine, you may
+ * have to change the find_command routine as well.
+ */
+
+void
+shellexec(char **argv, const char *path, int idx)
+{
+ char *cmdname;
+ int e;
+ char **envp;
+ int exerrno;
+
+ envp = environment();
+ if (strchr(argv[0], '/') != NULL) {
+ tryexec(argv[0], argv, envp);
+ e = errno;
+ } else {
+ e = ENOENT;
+ while ((cmdname = padvance(&path, argv[0])) != NULL) {
+ if (--idx < 0 && pathopt == NULL) {
+ tryexec(cmdname, argv, envp);
+ if (errno != ENOENT && errno != ENOTDIR)
+ e = errno;
+ }
+ stunalloc(cmdname);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Map to POSIX errors */
+ switch (e) {
+ case EACCES:
+ exerrno = 126;
+ break;
+ case ENOENT:
+ exerrno = 127;
+ break;
+ default:
+ exerrno = 2;
+ break;
+ }
+ exitstatus = exerrno;
+ TRACE(("shellexec failed for %s, errno %d, suppressint %d\n",
+ argv[0], e, suppressint ));
+ exerror(EXEXIT, "%s: %s", argv[0], errmsg(e, E_EXEC));
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+tryexec(char *cmd, char **argv, char **envp)
+{
+ char *const path_bshell = _PATH_BSHELL;
+
+repeat:
+#ifdef SYSV
+ do {
+ execve(cmd, argv, envp);
+ } while (errno == EINTR);
+#else
+ execve(cmd, argv, envp);
+#endif
+ if (cmd != path_bshell && errno == ENOEXEC) {
+ *argv-- = cmd;
+ *argv = cmd = path_bshell;
+ goto repeat;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Do a path search. The variable path (passed by reference) should be
+ * set to the start of the path before the first call; padvance will update
+ * this value as it proceeds. Successive calls to padvance will return
+ * the possible path expansions in sequence. If an option (indicated by
+ * a percent sign) appears in the path entry then the global variable
+ * pathopt will be set to point to it; otherwise pathopt will be set to
+ * NULL.
+ */
+
+const char *pathopt;
+
+char *
+padvance(const char **path, const char *name)
+{
+ const char *p;
+ char *q;
+ const char *start;
+ size_t len;
+
+ if (*path == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+ start = *path;
+ for (p = start ; *p && *p != ':' && *p != '%' ; p++);
+ len = p - start + strlen(name) + 2; /* "2" is for '/' and '\0' */
+ while (stackblocksize() < len)
+ growstackblock();
+ q = stackblock();
+ if (p != start) {
+ memcpy(q, start, p - start);
+ q += p - start;
+ *q++ = '/';
+ }
+ strcpy(q, name);
+ pathopt = NULL;
+ if (*p == '%') {
+ pathopt = ++p;
+ while (*p && *p != ':') p++;
+ }
+ if (*p == ':')
+ *path = p + 1;
+ else
+ *path = NULL;
+ return stalloc(len);
+}
+
+
+
+/*** Command hashing code ***/
+
+
+int
+hashcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ int c;
+ struct cmdentry entry;
+ char *name;
+
+ while ((c = nextopt("r")) != '\0') {
+ clearcmdentry(0);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if (*argptr == NULL) {
+ for (pp = cmdtable ; pp < &cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE] ; pp++) {
+ for (cmdp = *pp ; cmdp ; cmdp = cmdp->next) {
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL)
+ printentry(cmdp);
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+ c = 0;
+ while ((name = *argptr) != NULL) {
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) != NULL
+ && (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL
+ || (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN && builtinloc >= 0)))
+ delete_cmd_entry();
+ find_command(name, &entry, DO_ERR, pathval());
+ if (entry.cmdtype == CMDUNKNOWN)
+ c = 1;
+ argptr++;
+ }
+ return c;
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+printentry(struct tblentry *cmdp)
+{
+ int idx;
+ const char *path;
+ char *name;
+
+ idx = cmdp->param.index;
+ path = pathval();
+ do {
+ name = padvance(&path, cmdp->cmdname);
+ stunalloc(name);
+ } while (--idx >= 0);
+ out1str(name);
+ out1fmt(snlfmt, cmdp->rehash ? "*" : nullstr);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Resolve a command name. If you change this routine, you may have to
+ * change the shellexec routine as well.
+ */
+
+void
+find_command(char *name, struct cmdentry *entry, int act, const char *path)
+{
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ int idx;
+ int prev;
+ char *fullname;
+ struct stat64 statb;
+ int e;
+ int updatetbl;
+ struct builtincmd *bcmd;
+
+ /* If name contains a slash, don't use PATH or hash table */
+ if (strchr(name, '/') != NULL) {
+ entry->u.index = -1;
+ if (act & DO_ABS) {
+ while (stat64(name, &statb) < 0) {
+#ifdef SYSV
+ if (errno == EINTR)
+ continue;
+#endif
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDUNKNOWN;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDNORMAL;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ updatetbl = (path == pathval());
+ if (!updatetbl) {
+ act |= DO_ALTPATH;
+ if (strstr(path, "%builtin") != NULL)
+ act |= DO_ALTBLTIN;
+ }
+
+ /* If name is in the table, check answer will be ok */
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) != NULL) {
+ int bit;
+
+ switch (cmdp->cmdtype) {
+ default:
+#if DEBUG
+ abort();
+#endif
+ case CMDNORMAL:
+ bit = DO_ALTPATH;
+ break;
+ case CMDFUNCTION:
+ bit = DO_NOFUNC;
+ break;
+ case CMDBUILTIN:
+ bit = DO_ALTBLTIN;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (act & bit) {
+ updatetbl = 0;
+ cmdp = NULL;
+ } else if (cmdp->rehash == 0)
+ /* if not invalidated by cd, we're done */
+ goto success;
+ }
+
+ /* If %builtin not in path, check for builtin next */
+ bcmd = find_builtin(name);
+ if (bcmd && (bcmd->flags & BUILTIN_REGULAR || (
+ act & DO_ALTPATH ? !(act & DO_ALTBLTIN) : builtinloc <= 0
+ )))
+ goto builtin_success;
+
+ /* We have to search path. */
+ prev = -1; /* where to start */
+ if (cmdp && cmdp->rehash) { /* doing a rehash */
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN)
+ prev = builtinloc;
+ else
+ prev = cmdp->param.index;
+ }
+
+ e = ENOENT;
+ idx = -1;
+loop:
+ while ((fullname = padvance(&path, name)) != NULL) {
+ stunalloc(fullname);
+ idx++;
+ if (pathopt) {
+ if (prefix(pathopt, "builtin")) {
+ if (bcmd)
+ goto builtin_success;
+ continue;
+ } else if (!(act & DO_NOFUNC) &&
+ prefix(pathopt, "func")) {
+ /* handled below */
+ } else {
+ /* ignore unimplemented options */
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ /* if rehash, don't redo absolute path names */
+ if (fullname[0] == '/' && idx <= prev) {
+ if (idx < prev)
+ continue;
+ TRACE(("searchexec \"%s\": no change\n", name));
+ goto success;
+ }
+ while (stat64(fullname, &statb) < 0) {
+#ifdef SYSV
+ if (errno == EINTR)
+ continue;
+#endif
+ if (errno != ENOENT && errno != ENOTDIR)
+ e = errno;
+ goto loop;
+ }
+ e = EACCES; /* if we fail, this will be the error */
+ if (!S_ISREG(statb.st_mode))
+ continue;
+ if (pathopt) { /* this is a %func directory */
+ stalloc(strlen(fullname) + 1);
+ readcmdfile(fullname);
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) == NULL ||
+ cmdp->cmdtype != CMDFUNCTION)
+ sh_error("%s not defined in %s", name,
+ fullname);
+ stunalloc(fullname);
+ goto success;
+ }
+#ifdef notdef
+ /* XXX this code stops root executing stuff, and is buggy
+ if you need a group from the group list. */
+ if (statb.st_uid == geteuid()) {
+ if ((statb.st_mode & 0100) == 0)
+ goto loop;
+ } else if (statb.st_gid == getegid()) {
+ if ((statb.st_mode & 010) == 0)
+ goto loop;
+ } else {
+ if ((statb.st_mode & 01) == 0)
+ goto loop;
+ }
+#endif
+ TRACE(("searchexec \"%s\" returns \"%s\"\n", name, fullname));
+ if (!updatetbl) {
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDNORMAL;
+ entry->u.index = idx;
+ return;
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 1);
+ cmdp->cmdtype = CMDNORMAL;
+ cmdp->param.index = idx;
+ INTON;
+ goto success;
+ }
+
+ /* We failed. If there was an entry for this command, delete it */
+ if (cmdp && updatetbl)
+ delete_cmd_entry();
+ if (act & DO_ERR)
+ sh_warnx("%s: %s", name, errmsg(e, E_EXEC));
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDUNKNOWN;
+ return;
+
+builtin_success:
+ if (!updatetbl) {
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDBUILTIN;
+ entry->u.cmd = bcmd;
+ return;
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 1);
+ cmdp->cmdtype = CMDBUILTIN;
+ cmdp->param.cmd = bcmd;
+ INTON;
+success:
+ cmdp->rehash = 0;
+ entry->cmdtype = cmdp->cmdtype;
+ entry->u = cmdp->param;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Search the table of builtin commands.
+ */
+
+struct builtincmd *
+find_builtin(const char *name)
+{
+ struct builtincmd *bp;
+
+ bp = bsearch(
+ &name, builtincmd, NUMBUILTINS, sizeof(struct builtincmd),
+ pstrcmp
+ );
+ return bp;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called when a cd is done. Marks all commands so the next time they
+ * are executed they will be rehashed.
+ */
+
+void
+hashcd(void)
+{
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ for (pp = cmdtable ; pp < &cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE] ; pp++) {
+ for (cmdp = *pp ; cmdp ; cmdp = cmdp->next) {
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL || (
+ cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN &&
+ !(cmdp->param.cmd->flags & BUILTIN_REGULAR) &&
+ builtinloc > 0
+ ))
+ cmdp->rehash = 1;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Fix command hash table when PATH changed.
+ * Called before PATH is changed. The argument is the new value of PATH;
+ * pathval() still returns the old value at this point.
+ * Called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+void
+changepath(const char *newval)
+{
+ const char *old, *new;
+ int idx;
+ int firstchange;
+ int bltin;
+
+ old = pathval();
+ new = newval;
+ firstchange = 9999; /* assume no change */
+ idx = 0;
+ bltin = -1;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*old != *new) {
+ firstchange = idx;
+ if ((*old == '\0' && *new == ':')
+ || (*old == ':' && *new == '\0'))
+ firstchange++;
+ old = new; /* ignore subsequent differences */
+ }
+ if (*new == '\0')
+ break;
+ if (*new == '%' && bltin < 0 && prefix(new + 1, "builtin"))
+ bltin = idx;
+ if (*new == ':') {
+ idx++;
+ }
+ new++, old++;
+ }
+ if (builtinloc < 0 && bltin >= 0)
+ builtinloc = bltin; /* zap builtins */
+ if (builtinloc >= 0 && bltin < 0)
+ firstchange = 0;
+ clearcmdentry(firstchange);
+ builtinloc = bltin;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Clear out command entries. The argument specifies the first entry in
+ * PATH which has changed.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+clearcmdentry(int firstchange)
+{
+ struct tblentry **tblp;
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (tblp = cmdtable ; tblp < &cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE] ; tblp++) {
+ pp = tblp;
+ while ((cmdp = *pp) != NULL) {
+ if ((cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL &&
+ cmdp->param.index >= firstchange)
+ || (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN &&
+ builtinloc >= firstchange)) {
+ *pp = cmdp->next;
+ ckfree(cmdp);
+ } else {
+ pp = &cmdp->next;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Locate a command in the command hash table. If "add" is nonzero,
+ * add the command to the table if it is not already present. The
+ * variable "lastcmdentry" is set to point to the address of the link
+ * pointing to the entry, so that delete_cmd_entry can delete the
+ * entry.
+ *
+ * Interrupts must be off if called with add != 0.
+ */
+
+struct tblentry **lastcmdentry;
+
+
+STATIC struct tblentry *
+cmdlookup(const char *name, int add)
+{
+ unsigned int hashval;
+ const char *p;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+
+ p = name;
+ hashval = (unsigned char)*p << 4;
+ while (*p)
+ hashval += (unsigned char)*p++;
+ hashval &= 0x7FFF;
+ pp = &cmdtable[hashval % CMDTABLESIZE];
+ for (cmdp = *pp ; cmdp ; cmdp = cmdp->next) {
+ if (equal(cmdp->cmdname, name))
+ break;
+ pp = &cmdp->next;
+ }
+ if (add && cmdp == NULL) {
+ cmdp = *pp = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct tblentry) - ARB
+ + strlen(name) + 1);
+ cmdp->next = NULL;
+ cmdp->cmdtype = CMDUNKNOWN;
+ strcpy(cmdp->cmdname, name);
+ }
+ lastcmdentry = pp;
+ return cmdp;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Delete the command entry returned on the last lookup.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+delete_cmd_entry(void)
+{
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = *lastcmdentry;
+ *lastcmdentry = cmdp->next;
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION)
+ freefunc(cmdp->param.func);
+ ckfree(cmdp);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+#ifdef notdef
+void
+getcmdentry(char *name, struct cmdentry *entry)
+{
+ struct tblentry *cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0);
+
+ if (cmdp) {
+ entry->u = cmdp->param;
+ entry->cmdtype = cmdp->cmdtype;
+ } else {
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDUNKNOWN;
+ entry->u.index = 0;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Add a new command entry, replacing any existing command entry for
+ * the same name - except special builtins.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+addcmdentry(char *name, struct cmdentry *entry)
+{
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 1);
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION) {
+ freefunc(cmdp->param.func);
+ }
+ cmdp->cmdtype = entry->cmdtype;
+ cmdp->param = entry->u;
+ cmdp->rehash = 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Define a shell function.
+ */
+
+void
+defun(union node *func)
+{
+ struct cmdentry entry;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ entry.cmdtype = CMDFUNCTION;
+ entry.u.func = copyfunc(func);
+ addcmdentry(func->ndefun.text, &entry);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Delete a function if it exists.
+ */
+
+void
+unsetfunc(const char *name)
+{
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) != NULL &&
+ cmdp->cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION)
+ delete_cmd_entry();
+}
+
+/*
+ * Locate and print what a word is...
+ */
+
+int
+typecmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int i;
+ int err = 0;
+
+ for (i = 1; i < argc; i++) {
+ err |= describe_command(out1, argv[i], 1);
+ }
+ return err;
+}
+
+STATIC int
+describe_command(out, command, verbose)
+ struct output *out;
+ char *command;
+ int verbose;
+{
+ struct cmdentry entry;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ const struct alias *ap;
+ const char *path = pathval();
+
+ if (verbose) {
+ outstr(command, out);
+ }
+
+ /* First look at the keywords */
+ if (findkwd(command)) {
+ outstr(verbose ? " is a shell keyword" : command, out);
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ /* Then look at the aliases */
+ if ((ap = lookupalias(command, 0)) != NULL) {
+ if (verbose) {
+ outfmt(out, " is an alias for %s", ap->val);
+ } else {
+ outstr("alias ", out);
+ printalias(ap);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ /* Then check if it is a tracked alias */
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(command, 0)) != NULL) {
+ entry.cmdtype = cmdp->cmdtype;
+ entry.u = cmdp->param;
+ } else {
+ /* Finally use brute force */
+ find_command(command, &entry, DO_ABS, path);
+ }
+
+ switch (entry.cmdtype) {
+ case CMDNORMAL: {
+ int j = entry.u.index;
+ char *p;
+ if (j == -1) {
+ p = command;
+ } else {
+ do {
+ p = padvance(&path, command);
+ stunalloc(p);
+ } while (--j >= 0);
+ }
+ if (verbose) {
+ outfmt(
+ out, " is%s %s",
+ cmdp ? " a tracked alias for" : nullstr, p
+ );
+ } else {
+ outstr(p, out);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case CMDFUNCTION:
+ if (verbose) {
+ outstr(" is a shell function", out);
+ } else {
+ outstr(command, out);
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case CMDBUILTIN:
+ if (verbose) {
+ outfmt(
+ out, " is a %sshell builtin",
+ entry.u.cmd->flags & BUILTIN_SPECIAL ?
+ "special " : nullstr
+ );
+ } else {
+ outstr(command, out);
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ if (verbose) {
+ outstr(": not found\n", out);
+ }
+ return 127;
+ }
+
+out:
+ outc('\n', out);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+commandcmd(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *cmd;
+ int c;
+ enum {
+ VERIFY_BRIEF = 1,
+ VERIFY_VERBOSE = 2,
+ } verify = 0;
+
+ while ((c = nextopt("pvV")) != '\0')
+ if (c == 'V')
+ verify |= VERIFY_VERBOSE;
+ else if (c == 'v')
+ verify |= VERIFY_BRIEF;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ else if (c != 'p')
+ abort();
+#endif
+
+ cmd = *argptr;
+ if (verify && cmd)
+ return describe_command(out1, cmd, verify - VERIFY_BRIEF);
+
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/exec.h b/usr/dash/exec.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9ccb305
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/exec.h
@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)exec.h 8.3 (Berkeley) 6/8/95
+ */
+
+/* values of cmdtype */
+#define CMDUNKNOWN -1 /* no entry in table for command */
+#define CMDNORMAL 0 /* command is an executable program */
+#define CMDFUNCTION 1 /* command is a shell function */
+#define CMDBUILTIN 2 /* command is a shell builtin */
+
+
+struct cmdentry {
+ int cmdtype;
+ union param {
+ int index;
+ const struct builtincmd *cmd;
+ struct funcnode *func;
+ } u;
+};
+
+
+/* action to find_command() */
+#define DO_ERR 0x01 /* prints errors */
+#define DO_ABS 0x02 /* checks absolute paths */
+#define DO_NOFUNC 0x04 /* don't return shell functions, for command */
+#define DO_ALTPATH 0x08 /* using alternate path */
+#define DO_ALTBLTIN 0x20 /* %builtin in alt. path */
+
+extern const char *pathopt; /* set by padvance */
+
+void shellexec(char **, const char *, int)
+ __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+char *padvance(const char **, const char *);
+int hashcmd(int, char **);
+void find_command(char *, struct cmdentry *, int, const char *);
+struct builtincmd *find_builtin(const char *);
+void hashcd(void);
+void changepath(const char *);
+#ifdef notdef
+void getcmdentry(char *, struct cmdentry *);
+#endif
+void defun(union node *);
+void unsetfunc(const char *);
+int typecmd(int, char **);
+int commandcmd(int, char **);
diff --git a/usr/dash/expand.c b/usr/dash/expand.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..355e924
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/expand.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1728 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <dirent.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_GETPWNAM
+#include <pwd.h>
+#endif
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <fnmatch.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_GLOB
+#include <glob.h>
+#endif
+#include <ctype.h>
+
+/*
+ * Routines to expand arguments to commands. We have to deal with
+ * backquotes, shell variables, and file metacharacters.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+/*
+ * _rmescape() flags
+ */
+#define RMESCAPE_ALLOC 0x1 /* Allocate a new string */
+#define RMESCAPE_GLOB 0x2 /* Add backslashes for glob */
+#define RMESCAPE_GROW 0x8 /* Grow strings instead of stalloc */
+#define RMESCAPE_HEAP 0x10 /* Malloc strings instead of stalloc */
+
+/* Add CTLESC when necessary. */
+#define QUOTES_ESC (EXP_FULL | EXP_CASE | EXP_QPAT)
+/* Do not skip NUL characters. */
+#define QUOTES_KEEPNUL EXP_TILDE
+
+/*
+ * Structure specifying which parts of the string should be searched
+ * for IFS characters.
+ */
+
+struct ifsregion {
+ struct ifsregion *next; /* next region in list */
+ int begoff; /* offset of start of region */
+ int endoff; /* offset of end of region */
+ int nulonly; /* search for nul bytes only */
+};
+
+/* output of current string */
+static char *expdest;
+/* list of back quote expressions */
+static struct nodelist *argbackq;
+/* first struct in list of ifs regions */
+static struct ifsregion ifsfirst;
+/* last struct in list */
+static struct ifsregion *ifslastp;
+/* holds expanded arg list */
+static struct arglist exparg;
+
+STATIC void argstr(char *, int);
+STATIC char *exptilde(char *, char *, int);
+STATIC void expbackq(union node *, int);
+STATIC const char *subevalvar(char *, char *, int, int, int, int, int);
+STATIC char *evalvar(char *, int);
+STATIC size_t strtodest(const char *, const char *, int);
+STATIC void memtodest(const char *, size_t, const char *, int);
+STATIC ssize_t varvalue(char *, int, int);
+STATIC void expandmeta(struct strlist *, int);
+#ifdef HAVE_GLOB
+STATIC void addglob(const glob_t *);
+#else
+STATIC void expmeta(char *, char *);
+STATIC struct strlist *expsort(struct strlist *);
+STATIC struct strlist *msort(struct strlist *, int);
+#endif
+STATIC void addfname(char *);
+STATIC int patmatch(char *, const char *);
+#ifndef HAVE_FNMATCH
+STATIC int pmatch(const char *, const char *);
+#else
+#define pmatch(a, b) !fnmatch((a), (b), 0)
+#endif
+STATIC int cvtnum(intmax_t);
+STATIC size_t esclen(const char *, const char *);
+STATIC char *scanleft(char *, char *, char *, char *, int, int);
+STATIC char *scanright(char *, char *, char *, char *, int, int);
+STATIC void varunset(const char *, const char *, const char *, int)
+ __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+
+
+/*
+ * Prepare a pattern for a glob(3) call.
+ *
+ * Returns an stalloced string.
+ */
+
+STATIC inline char *
+preglob(const char *pattern, int flag) {
+ flag |= RMESCAPE_GLOB;
+ return _rmescapes((char *)pattern, flag);
+}
+
+
+STATIC size_t
+esclen(const char *start, const char *p) {
+ size_t esc = 0;
+
+ while (p > start && *--p == (char)CTLESC) {
+ esc++;
+ }
+ return esc;
+}
+
+
+static inline const char *getpwhome(const char *name)
+{
+#ifdef HAVE_GETPWNAM
+ struct passwd *pw = getpwnam(name);
+ return pw ? pw->pw_dir : 0;
+#else
+ return 0;
+#endif
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Perform variable substitution and command substitution on an argument,
+ * placing the resulting list of arguments in arglist. If EXP_FULL is true,
+ * perform splitting and file name expansion. When arglist is NULL, perform
+ * here document expansion.
+ */
+
+void
+expandarg(union node *arg, struct arglist *arglist, int flag)
+{
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ char *p;
+
+ argbackq = arg->narg.backquote;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(expdest);
+ argstr(arg->narg.text, flag);
+ p = _STPUTC('\0', expdest);
+ expdest = p - 1;
+ if (arglist == NULL) {
+ /* here document expanded */
+ goto out;
+ }
+ p = grabstackstr(p);
+ exparg.lastp = &exparg.list;
+ /*
+ * TODO - EXP_REDIR
+ */
+ if (flag & EXP_FULL) {
+ ifsbreakup(p, &exparg);
+ *exparg.lastp = NULL;
+ exparg.lastp = &exparg.list;
+ expandmeta(exparg.list, flag);
+ } else {
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct strlist));
+ sp->text = p;
+ *exparg.lastp = sp;
+ exparg.lastp = &sp->next;
+ }
+ *exparg.lastp = NULL;
+ if (exparg.list) {
+ *arglist->lastp = exparg.list;
+ arglist->lastp = exparg.lastp;
+ }
+
+out:
+ ifsfree();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Perform variable and command substitution. If EXP_FULL is set, output CTLESC
+ * characters to allow for further processing. Otherwise treat
+ * $@ like $* since no splitting will be performed.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+argstr(char *p, int flag)
+{
+ static const char spclchars[] = {
+ '=',
+ ':',
+ CTLQUOTEMARK,
+ CTLENDVAR,
+ CTLESC,
+ CTLVAR,
+ CTLBACKQ,
+ CTLENDARI,
+ 0
+ };
+ const char *reject = spclchars;
+ int c;
+ int breakall = (flag & (EXP_WORD | EXP_QUOTED)) == EXP_WORD;
+ int inquotes;
+ size_t length;
+ int startloc;
+
+ if (!(flag & EXP_VARTILDE)) {
+ reject += 2;
+ } else if (flag & EXP_VARTILDE2) {
+ reject++;
+ }
+ inquotes = 0;
+ length = 0;
+ if (flag & EXP_TILDE) {
+ char *q;
+
+ flag &= ~EXP_TILDE;
+tilde:
+ q = p;
+ if (*q == '~')
+ p = exptilde(p, q, flag);
+ }
+start:
+ startloc = expdest - (char *)stackblock();
+ for (;;) {
+ length += strcspn(p + length, reject);
+ c = (signed char)p[length];
+ if (c && (!(c & 0x80) || c == CTLENDARI)) {
+ /* c == '=' || c == ':' || c == CTLENDARI */
+ length++;
+ }
+ if (length > 0) {
+ int newloc;
+ expdest = stnputs(p, length, expdest);
+ newloc = expdest - (char *)stackblock();
+ if (breakall && !inquotes && newloc > startloc) {
+ recordregion(startloc, newloc, 0);
+ }
+ startloc = newloc;
+ }
+ p += length + 1;
+ length = 0;
+
+ switch (c) {
+ case '\0':
+ goto breakloop;
+ case '=':
+ if (flag & EXP_VARTILDE2) {
+ p--;
+ continue;
+ }
+ flag |= EXP_VARTILDE2;
+ reject++;
+ /* fall through */
+ case ':':
+ /*
+ * sort of a hack - expand tildes in variable
+ * assignments (after the first '=' and after ':'s).
+ */
+ if (*--p == '~') {
+ goto tilde;
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ switch (c) {
+ case CTLENDVAR: /* ??? */
+ goto breakloop;
+ case CTLQUOTEMARK:
+ inquotes ^= EXP_QUOTED;
+ /* "$@" syntax adherence hack */
+ if (inquotes && !memcmp(p, dolatstr + 1,
+ DOLATSTRLEN - 1)) {
+ p = evalvar(p + 1, flag | inquotes) + 1;
+ goto start;
+ }
+addquote:
+ if (flag & QUOTES_ESC) {
+ p--;
+ length++;
+ startloc++;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CTLESC:
+ startloc++;
+ length++;
+
+ /*
+ * Quoted parameter expansion pattern: remove quote
+ * unless inside inner quotes or we have a literal
+ * backslash.
+ */
+ if (((flag | inquotes) & (EXP_QPAT | EXP_QUOTED)) ==
+ EXP_QPAT && *p != '\\')
+ break;
+
+ goto addquote;
+ case CTLVAR:
+ p = evalvar(p, flag | inquotes);
+ goto start;
+ case CTLBACKQ:
+ expbackq(argbackq->n, flag | inquotes);
+ argbackq = argbackq->next;
+ goto start;
+ case CTLENDARI:
+ p--;
+ expari(flag | inquotes);
+ goto start;
+ }
+ }
+breakloop:
+ ;
+}
+
+STATIC char *
+exptilde(char *startp, char *p, int flag)
+{
+ signed char c;
+ char *name;
+ const char *home;
+ int quotes = flag & QUOTES_ESC;
+
+ name = p + 1;
+
+ while ((c = *++p) != '\0') {
+ switch(c) {
+ case CTLESC:
+ return (startp);
+ case CTLQUOTEMARK:
+ return (startp);
+ case ':':
+ if (flag & EXP_VARTILDE)
+ goto done;
+ break;
+ case '/':
+ case CTLENDVAR:
+ goto done;
+ }
+ }
+done:
+ *p = '\0';
+ if (*name == '\0') {
+ home = lookupvar(homestr);
+ } else {
+ home = getpwhome(name);
+ }
+ if (!home || !*home)
+ goto lose;
+ *p = c;
+ strtodest(home, SQSYNTAX, quotes);
+ return (p);
+lose:
+ *p = c;
+ return (startp);
+}
+
+
+void
+removerecordregions(int endoff)
+{
+ if (ifslastp == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ if (ifsfirst.endoff > endoff) {
+ while (ifsfirst.next != NULL) {
+ struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+ INTOFF;
+ ifsp = ifsfirst.next->next;
+ ckfree(ifsfirst.next);
+ ifsfirst.next = ifsp;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ if (ifsfirst.begoff > endoff)
+ ifslastp = NULL;
+ else {
+ ifslastp = &ifsfirst;
+ ifsfirst.endoff = endoff;
+ }
+ return;
+ }
+
+ ifslastp = &ifsfirst;
+ while (ifslastp->next && ifslastp->next->begoff < endoff)
+ ifslastp=ifslastp->next;
+ while (ifslastp->next != NULL) {
+ struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+ INTOFF;
+ ifsp = ifslastp->next->next;
+ ckfree(ifslastp->next);
+ ifslastp->next = ifsp;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ if (ifslastp->endoff > endoff)
+ ifslastp->endoff = endoff;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand arithmetic expression. Backup to start of expression,
+ * evaluate, place result in (backed up) result, adjust string position.
+ */
+void
+expari(int flag)
+{
+ struct stackmark sm;
+ char *p, *start;
+ int begoff;
+ int len;
+ intmax_t result;
+
+ /* ifsfree(); */
+
+ /*
+ * This routine is slightly over-complicated for
+ * efficiency. Next we scan backwards looking for the
+ * start of arithmetic.
+ */
+ start = stackblock();
+ p = expdest;
+ pushstackmark(&sm, p - start);
+ *--p = '\0';
+ p--;
+ do {
+ int esc;
+
+ while (*p != (char)CTLARI) {
+ p--;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (p < start) {
+ sh_error("missing CTLARI (shouldn't happen)");
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+
+ esc = esclen(start, p);
+ if (!(esc % 2)) {
+ break;
+ }
+
+ p -= esc + 1;
+ } while (1);
+
+ begoff = p - start;
+
+ removerecordregions(begoff);
+
+ expdest = p;
+
+ if (likely(flag & QUOTES_ESC))
+ rmescapes(p + 1);
+
+ result = arith(p + 1);
+ popstackmark(&sm);
+
+ len = cvtnum(result);
+
+ if (likely(!(flag & EXP_QUOTED)))
+ recordregion(begoff, begoff + len, 0);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand stuff in backwards quotes.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+expbackq(union node *cmd, int flag)
+{
+ struct backcmd in;
+ int i;
+ char buf[128];
+ char *p;
+ char *dest;
+ int startloc;
+ char const *syntax = flag & EXP_QUOTED ? DQSYNTAX : BASESYNTAX;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ startloc = expdest - (char *)stackblock();
+ pushstackmark(&smark, startloc);
+ evalbackcmd(cmd, (struct backcmd *) &in);
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+
+ p = in.buf;
+ i = in.nleft;
+ if (i == 0)
+ goto read;
+ for (;;) {
+ memtodest(p, i, syntax, flag & QUOTES_ESC);
+read:
+ if (in.fd < 0)
+ break;
+ do {
+ i = read(in.fd, buf, sizeof buf);
+ } while (i < 0 && errno == EINTR);
+ TRACE(("expbackq: read returns %d\n", i));
+ if (i <= 0)
+ break;
+ p = buf;
+ }
+
+ if (in.buf)
+ ckfree(in.buf);
+ if (in.fd >= 0) {
+ close(in.fd);
+ back_exitstatus = waitforjob(in.jp);
+ }
+ INTON;
+
+ /* Eat all trailing newlines */
+ dest = expdest;
+ for (; dest > (char *)stackblock() && dest[-1] == '\n';)
+ STUNPUTC(dest);
+ expdest = dest;
+
+ if (!(flag & EXP_QUOTED))
+ recordregion(startloc, dest - (char *)stackblock(), 0);
+ TRACE(("evalbackq: size=%d: \"%.*s\"\n",
+ (dest - (char *)stackblock()) - startloc,
+ (dest - (char *)stackblock()) - startloc,
+ stackblock() + startloc));
+}
+
+
+STATIC char *
+scanleft(
+ char *startp, char *rmesc, char *rmescend, char *str, int quotes,
+ int zero
+) {
+ char *loc;
+ char *loc2;
+ char c;
+
+ loc = startp;
+ loc2 = rmesc;
+ do {
+ int match;
+ const char *s = loc2;
+ c = *loc2;
+ if (zero) {
+ *loc2 = '\0';
+ s = rmesc;
+ }
+ match = pmatch(str, s);
+ *loc2 = c;
+ if (match)
+ return loc;
+ if (quotes && *loc == (char)CTLESC)
+ loc++;
+ loc++;
+ loc2++;
+ } while (c);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+STATIC char *
+scanright(
+ char *startp, char *rmesc, char *rmescend, char *str, int quotes,
+ int zero
+) {
+ int esc = 0;
+ char *loc;
+ char *loc2;
+
+ for (loc = str - 1, loc2 = rmescend; loc >= startp; loc2--) {
+ int match;
+ char c = *loc2;
+ const char *s = loc2;
+ if (zero) {
+ *loc2 = '\0';
+ s = rmesc;
+ }
+ match = pmatch(str, s);
+ *loc2 = c;
+ if (match)
+ return loc;
+ loc--;
+ if (quotes) {
+ if (--esc < 0) {
+ esc = esclen(startp, loc);
+ }
+ if (esc % 2) {
+ esc--;
+ loc--;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+STATIC const char *
+subevalvar(char *p, char *str, int strloc, int subtype, int startloc, int varflags, int flag)
+{
+ int quotes = flag & QUOTES_ESC;
+ char *startp;
+ char *loc;
+ struct nodelist *saveargbackq = argbackq;
+ int amount;
+ char *rmesc, *rmescend;
+ int zero;
+ char *(*scan)(char *, char *, char *, char *, int , int);
+
+ argstr(p, EXP_TILDE | (subtype != VSASSIGN && subtype != VSQUESTION ?
+ (flag & EXP_QUOTED ? EXP_QPAT : EXP_CASE) : 0));
+ STPUTC('\0', expdest);
+ argbackq = saveargbackq;
+ startp = stackblock() + startloc;
+
+ switch (subtype) {
+ case VSASSIGN:
+ setvar(str, startp, 0);
+ amount = startp - expdest;
+ STADJUST(amount, expdest);
+ return startp;
+
+ case VSQUESTION:
+ varunset(p, str, startp, varflags);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+
+ subtype -= VSTRIMRIGHT;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (subtype < 0 || subtype > 3)
+ abort();
+#endif
+
+ rmesc = startp;
+ rmescend = stackblock() + strloc;
+ if (quotes) {
+ rmesc = _rmescapes(startp, RMESCAPE_ALLOC | RMESCAPE_GROW);
+ if (rmesc != startp) {
+ rmescend = expdest;
+ startp = stackblock() + startloc;
+ }
+ }
+ rmescend--;
+ str = stackblock() + strloc;
+ preglob(str, 0);
+
+ /* zero = subtype == VSTRIMLEFT || subtype == VSTRIMLEFTMAX */
+ zero = subtype >> 1;
+ /* VSTRIMLEFT/VSTRIMRIGHTMAX -> scanleft */
+ scan = (subtype & 1) ^ zero ? scanleft : scanright;
+
+ loc = scan(startp, rmesc, rmescend, str, quotes, zero);
+ if (loc) {
+ if (zero) {
+ memmove(startp, loc, str - loc);
+ loc = startp + (str - loc) - 1;
+ }
+ *loc = '\0';
+ amount = loc - expdest;
+ STADJUST(amount, expdest);
+ }
+ return loc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand a variable, and return a pointer to the next character in the
+ * input string.
+ */
+STATIC char *
+evalvar(char *p, int flag)
+{
+ int subtype;
+ int varflags;
+ char *var;
+ int patloc;
+ int c;
+ int startloc;
+ ssize_t varlen;
+ int easy;
+ int quoted;
+
+ varflags = *p++;
+ subtype = varflags & VSTYPE;
+
+ if (!subtype)
+ sh_error("Bad substitution");
+
+ quoted = flag & EXP_QUOTED;
+ var = p;
+ easy = (!quoted || (*var == '@' && shellparam.nparam));
+ startloc = expdest - (char *)stackblock();
+ p = strchr(p, '=') + 1;
+
+again:
+ varlen = varvalue(var, varflags, flag);
+ if (varflags & VSNUL)
+ varlen--;
+
+ if (subtype == VSPLUS) {
+ varlen = -1 - varlen;
+ goto vsplus;
+ }
+
+ if (subtype == VSMINUS) {
+vsplus:
+ if (varlen < 0) {
+ argstr(p, flag | EXP_TILDE | EXP_WORD);
+ goto end;
+ }
+ if (easy)
+ goto record;
+ goto end;
+ }
+
+ if (subtype == VSASSIGN || subtype == VSQUESTION) {
+ if (varlen < 0) {
+ if (subevalvar(p, var, 0, subtype, startloc,
+ varflags, flag & ~QUOTES_ESC)) {
+ varflags &= ~VSNUL;
+ /*
+ * Remove any recorded regions beyond
+ * start of variable
+ */
+ removerecordregions(startloc);
+ goto again;
+ }
+ goto end;
+ }
+ if (easy)
+ goto record;
+ goto end;
+ }
+
+ if (varlen < 0 && uflag)
+ varunset(p, var, 0, 0);
+
+ if (subtype == VSLENGTH) {
+ cvtnum(varlen > 0 ? varlen : 0);
+ goto record;
+ }
+
+ if (subtype == VSNORMAL) {
+ if (!easy)
+ goto end;
+record:
+ recordregion(startloc, expdest - (char *)stackblock(), quoted);
+ goto end;
+ }
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ switch (subtype) {
+ case VSTRIMLEFT:
+ case VSTRIMLEFTMAX:
+ case VSTRIMRIGHT:
+ case VSTRIMRIGHTMAX:
+ break;
+ default:
+ abort();
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if (varlen >= 0) {
+ /*
+ * Terminate the string and start recording the pattern
+ * right after it
+ */
+ STPUTC('\0', expdest);
+ patloc = expdest - (char *)stackblock();
+ if (subevalvar(p, NULL, patloc, subtype,
+ startloc, varflags, flag) == 0) {
+ int amount = expdest - (
+ (char *)stackblock() + patloc - 1
+ );
+ STADJUST(-amount, expdest);
+ }
+ /* Remove any recorded regions beyond start of variable */
+ removerecordregions(startloc);
+ goto record;
+ }
+
+end:
+ if (subtype != VSNORMAL) { /* skip to end of alternative */
+ int nesting = 1;
+ for (;;) {
+ if ((c = (signed char)*p++) == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ else if (c == CTLBACKQ) {
+ if (varlen >= 0)
+ argbackq = argbackq->next;
+ } else if (c == CTLVAR) {
+ if ((*p++ & VSTYPE) != VSNORMAL)
+ nesting++;
+ } else if (c == CTLENDVAR) {
+ if (--nesting == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Put a string on the stack.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+memtodest(const char *p, size_t len, const char *syntax, int quotes) {
+ char *q;
+
+ if (unlikely(!len))
+ return;
+
+ q = makestrspace(len * 2, expdest);
+
+ do {
+ int c = (signed char)*p++;
+ if (c) {
+ if ((quotes & QUOTES_ESC) &&
+ ((syntax[c] == CCTL) ||
+ (((quotes & EXP_FULL) || syntax != BASESYNTAX) &&
+ syntax[c] == CBACK)))
+ USTPUTC(CTLESC, q);
+ } else if (!(quotes & QUOTES_KEEPNUL))
+ continue;
+ USTPUTC(c, q);
+ } while (--len);
+
+ expdest = q;
+}
+
+
+STATIC size_t
+strtodest(p, syntax, quotes)
+ const char *p;
+ const char *syntax;
+ int quotes;
+{
+ size_t len = strlen(p);
+ memtodest(p, len, syntax, quotes);
+ return len;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Add the value of a specialized variable to the stack string.
+ */
+
+STATIC ssize_t
+varvalue(char *name, int varflags, int flags)
+{
+ int num;
+ char *p;
+ int i;
+ int sep;
+ char sepc;
+ char **ap;
+ char const *syntax;
+ int quoted = flags & EXP_QUOTED;
+ int subtype = varflags & VSTYPE;
+ int discard = subtype == VSPLUS || subtype == VSLENGTH;
+ int quotes = (discard ? 0 : (flags & QUOTES_ESC)) | QUOTES_KEEPNUL;
+ ssize_t len = 0;
+
+ sep = quoted ? ((flags & EXP_FULL) << CHAR_BIT) : 0;
+ syntax = quoted ? DQSYNTAX : BASESYNTAX;
+
+ switch (*name) {
+ case '$':
+ num = rootpid;
+ goto numvar;
+ case '?':
+ num = exitstatus;
+ goto numvar;
+ case '#':
+ num = shellparam.nparam;
+ goto numvar;
+ case '!':
+ num = backgndpid;
+ if (num == 0)
+ return -1;
+numvar:
+ len = cvtnum(num);
+ break;
+ case '-':
+ p = makestrspace(NOPTS, expdest);
+ for (i = NOPTS - 1; i >= 0; i--) {
+ if (optlist[i]) {
+ USTPUTC(optletters[i], p);
+ len++;
+ }
+ }
+ expdest = p;
+ break;
+ case '@':
+ if (sep)
+ goto param;
+ /* fall through */
+ case '*':
+ sep = ifsset() ? ifsval()[0] : ' ';
+param:
+ if (!(ap = shellparam.p))
+ return -1;
+ sepc = sep;
+ while ((p = *ap++)) {
+ len += strtodest(p, syntax, quotes);
+
+ if (*ap && sep) {
+ len++;
+ memtodest(&sepc, 1, syntax, quotes);
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ case '0':
+ case '1':
+ case '2':
+ case '3':
+ case '4':
+ case '5':
+ case '6':
+ case '7':
+ case '8':
+ case '9':
+ num = atoi(name);
+ if (num < 0 || num > shellparam.nparam)
+ return -1;
+ p = num ? shellparam.p[num - 1] : arg0;
+ goto value;
+ default:
+ p = lookupvar(name);
+value:
+ if (!p)
+ return -1;
+
+ len = strtodest(p, syntax, quotes);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (discard)
+ STADJUST(-len, expdest);
+ return len;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Record the fact that we have to scan this region of the
+ * string for IFS characters.
+ */
+
+void
+recordregion(int start, int end, int nulonly)
+{
+ struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+
+ if (ifslastp == NULL) {
+ ifsp = &ifsfirst;
+ } else {
+ INTOFF;
+ ifsp = (struct ifsregion *)ckmalloc(sizeof (struct ifsregion));
+ ifsp->next = NULL;
+ ifslastp->next = ifsp;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ ifslastp = ifsp;
+ ifslastp->begoff = start;
+ ifslastp->endoff = end;
+ ifslastp->nulonly = nulonly;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Break the argument string into pieces based upon IFS and add the
+ * strings to the argument list. The regions of the string to be
+ * searched for IFS characters have been stored by recordregion.
+ */
+void
+ifsbreakup(char *string, struct arglist *arglist)
+{
+ struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ char *start;
+ char *p;
+ char *q;
+ const char *ifs, *realifs;
+ int ifsspc;
+ int nulonly;
+
+
+ start = string;
+ if (ifslastp != NULL) {
+ ifsspc = 0;
+ nulonly = 0;
+ realifs = ifsset() ? ifsval() : defifs;
+ ifsp = &ifsfirst;
+ do {
+ p = string + ifsp->begoff;
+ nulonly = ifsp->nulonly;
+ ifs = nulonly ? nullstr : realifs;
+ ifsspc = 0;
+ while (p < string + ifsp->endoff) {
+ q = p;
+ if (*p == (char)CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ if (strchr(ifs, *p)) {
+ if (!nulonly)
+ ifsspc = (strchr(defifs, *p) != NULL);
+ /* Ignore IFS whitespace at start */
+ if (q == start && ifsspc) {
+ p++;
+ start = p;
+ continue;
+ }
+ *q = '\0';
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof *sp);
+ sp->text = start;
+ *arglist->lastp = sp;
+ arglist->lastp = &sp->next;
+ p++;
+ if (!nulonly) {
+ for (;;) {
+ if (p >= string + ifsp->endoff) {
+ break;
+ }
+ q = p;
+ if (*p == (char)CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ if (strchr(ifs, *p) == NULL ) {
+ p = q;
+ break;
+ } else if (strchr(defifs, *p) == NULL) {
+ if (ifsspc) {
+ p++;
+ ifsspc = 0;
+ } else {
+ p = q;
+ break;
+ }
+ } else
+ p++;
+ }
+ }
+ start = p;
+ } else
+ p++;
+ }
+ } while ((ifsp = ifsp->next) != NULL);
+ if (nulonly)
+ goto add;
+ }
+
+ if (!*start)
+ return;
+
+add:
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof *sp);
+ sp->text = start;
+ *arglist->lastp = sp;
+ arglist->lastp = &sp->next;
+}
+
+void ifsfree(void)
+{
+ struct ifsregion *p = ifsfirst.next;
+
+ if (!p)
+ goto out;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ do {
+ struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+ ifsp = p->next;
+ ckfree(p);
+ p = ifsp;
+ } while (p);
+ ifsfirst.next = NULL;
+ INTON;
+
+out:
+ ifslastp = NULL;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand shell metacharacters. At this point, the only control characters
+ * should be escapes. The results are stored in the list exparg.
+ */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_GLOB
+STATIC void
+expandmeta(str, flag)
+ struct strlist *str;
+ int flag;
+{
+ /* TODO - EXP_REDIR */
+
+ while (str) {
+ const char *p;
+ glob_t pglob;
+ int i;
+
+ if (fflag)
+ goto nometa;
+ INTOFF;
+ p = preglob(str->text, RMESCAPE_ALLOC | RMESCAPE_HEAP);
+ i = glob(p, GLOB_NOMAGIC, 0, &pglob);
+ if (p != str->text)
+ ckfree(p);
+ switch (i) {
+ case 0:
+ if (!(pglob.gl_flags & GLOB_MAGCHAR))
+ goto nometa2;
+ addglob(&pglob);
+ globfree(&pglob);
+ INTON;
+ break;
+ case GLOB_NOMATCH:
+nometa2:
+ globfree(&pglob);
+ INTON;
+nometa:
+ *exparg.lastp = str;
+ rmescapes(str->text);
+ exparg.lastp = &str->next;
+ break;
+ default: /* GLOB_NOSPACE */
+ sh_error("Out of space");
+ }
+ str = str->next;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Add the result of glob(3) to the list.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+addglob(pglob)
+ const glob_t *pglob;
+{
+ char **p = pglob->gl_pathv;
+
+ do {
+ addfname(*p);
+ } while (*++p);
+}
+
+
+#else /* HAVE_GLOB */
+STATIC char *expdir;
+
+
+STATIC void
+expandmeta(struct strlist *str, int flag)
+{
+ static const char metachars[] = {
+ '*', '?', '[', 0
+ };
+ /* TODO - EXP_REDIR */
+
+ while (str) {
+ struct strlist **savelastp;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ char *p;
+
+ if (fflag)
+ goto nometa;
+ if (!strpbrk(str->text, metachars))
+ goto nometa;
+ savelastp = exparg.lastp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ p = preglob(str->text, RMESCAPE_ALLOC | RMESCAPE_HEAP);
+ {
+ int i = strlen(str->text);
+ expdir = ckmalloc(i < 2048 ? 2048 : i); /* XXX */
+ }
+
+ expmeta(expdir, p);
+ ckfree(expdir);
+ if (p != str->text)
+ ckfree(p);
+ INTON;
+ if (exparg.lastp == savelastp) {
+ /*
+ * no matches
+ */
+nometa:
+ *exparg.lastp = str;
+ rmescapes(str->text);
+ exparg.lastp = &str->next;
+ } else {
+ *exparg.lastp = NULL;
+ *savelastp = sp = expsort(*savelastp);
+ while (sp->next != NULL)
+ sp = sp->next;
+ exparg.lastp = &sp->next;
+ }
+ str = str->next;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Do metacharacter (i.e. *, ?, [...]) expansion.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+expmeta(char *enddir, char *name)
+{
+ char *p;
+ const char *cp;
+ char *start;
+ char *endname;
+ int metaflag;
+ struct stat64 statb;
+ DIR *dirp;
+ struct dirent *dp;
+ int atend;
+ int matchdot;
+ int esc;
+
+ metaflag = 0;
+ start = name;
+ for (p = name; esc = 0, *p; p += esc + 1) {
+ if (*p == '*' || *p == '?')
+ metaflag = 1;
+ else if (*p == '[') {
+ char *q = p + 1;
+ if (*q == '!')
+ q++;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*q == '\\')
+ q++;
+ if (*q == '/' || *q == '\0')
+ break;
+ if (*++q == ']') {
+ metaflag = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ } else {
+ if (*p == '\\')
+ esc++;
+ if (p[esc] == '/') {
+ if (metaflag)
+ break;
+ start = p + esc + 1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if (metaflag == 0) { /* we've reached the end of the file name */
+ if (enddir != expdir)
+ metaflag++;
+ p = name;
+ do {
+ if (*p == '\\')
+ p++;
+ *enddir++ = *p;
+ } while (*p++);
+ if (metaflag == 0 || lstat64(expdir, &statb) >= 0)
+ addfname(expdir);
+ return;
+ }
+ endname = p;
+ if (name < start) {
+ p = name;
+ do {
+ if (*p == '\\')
+ p++;
+ *enddir++ = *p++;
+ } while (p < start);
+ }
+ if (enddir == expdir) {
+ cp = ".";
+ } else if (enddir == expdir + 1 && *expdir == '/') {
+ cp = "/";
+ } else {
+ cp = expdir;
+ enddir[-1] = '\0';
+ }
+ if ((dirp = opendir(cp)) == NULL)
+ return;
+ if (enddir != expdir)
+ enddir[-1] = '/';
+ if (*endname == 0) {
+ atend = 1;
+ } else {
+ atend = 0;
+ *endname = '\0';
+ endname += esc + 1;
+ }
+ matchdot = 0;
+ p = start;
+ if (*p == '\\')
+ p++;
+ if (*p == '.')
+ matchdot++;
+ while (! int_pending() && (dp = readdir(dirp)) != NULL) {
+ if (dp->d_name[0] == '.' && ! matchdot)
+ continue;
+ if (pmatch(start, dp->d_name)) {
+ if (atend) {
+ scopy(dp->d_name, enddir);
+ addfname(expdir);
+ } else {
+ for (p = enddir, cp = dp->d_name;
+ (*p++ = *cp++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ p[-1] = '/';
+ expmeta(p, endname);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ closedir(dirp);
+ if (! atend)
+ endname[-esc - 1] = esc ? '\\' : '/';
+}
+#endif /* HAVE_GLOB */
+
+
+/*
+ * Add a file name to the list.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+addfname(char *name)
+{
+ struct strlist *sp;
+
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof *sp);
+ sp->text = sstrdup(name);
+ *exparg.lastp = sp;
+ exparg.lastp = &sp->next;
+}
+
+
+#ifndef HAVE_GLOB
+/*
+ * Sort the results of file name expansion. It calculates the number of
+ * strings to sort and then calls msort (short for merge sort) to do the
+ * work.
+ */
+
+STATIC struct strlist *
+expsort(struct strlist *str)
+{
+ int len;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+
+ len = 0;
+ for (sp = str ; sp ; sp = sp->next)
+ len++;
+ return msort(str, len);
+}
+
+
+STATIC struct strlist *
+msort(struct strlist *list, int len)
+{
+ struct strlist *p, *q = NULL;
+ struct strlist **lpp;
+ int half;
+ int n;
+
+ if (len <= 1)
+ return list;
+ half = len >> 1;
+ p = list;
+ for (n = half ; --n >= 0 ; ) {
+ q = p;
+ p = p->next;
+ }
+ q->next = NULL; /* terminate first half of list */
+ q = msort(list, half); /* sort first half of list */
+ p = msort(p, len - half); /* sort second half */
+ lpp = &list;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (strcmp(p->text, q->text) < 0) {
+ *lpp = p;
+ lpp = &p->next;
+ if ((p = *lpp) == NULL) {
+ *lpp = q;
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ *lpp = q;
+ lpp = &q->next;
+ if ((q = *lpp) == NULL) {
+ *lpp = p;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return list;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Returns true if the pattern matches the string.
+ */
+
+STATIC inline int
+patmatch(char *pattern, const char *string)
+{
+ return pmatch(preglob(pattern, 0), string);
+}
+
+
+#ifndef HAVE_FNMATCH
+STATIC int ccmatch(const char *p, int chr, const char **r)
+{
+ static const struct class {
+ char name[10];
+ int (*fn)(int);
+ } classes[] = {
+ { .name = ":alnum:]", .fn = isalnum },
+ { .name = ":cntrl:]", .fn = iscntrl },
+ { .name = ":lower:]", .fn = islower },
+ { .name = ":space:]", .fn = isspace },
+ { .name = ":alpha:]", .fn = isalpha },
+ { .name = ":digit:]", .fn = isdigit },
+ { .name = ":print:]", .fn = isprint },
+ { .name = ":upper:]", .fn = isupper },
+ { .name = ":blank:]", .fn = isblank },
+ { .name = ":graph:]", .fn = isgraph },
+ { .name = ":punct:]", .fn = ispunct },
+ { .name = ":xdigit:]", .fn = isxdigit },
+ };
+ const struct class *class, *end;
+
+ end = classes + sizeof(classes) / sizeof(classes[0]);
+ for (class = classes; class < end; class++) {
+ const char *q;
+
+ q = prefix(p, class->name);
+ if (!q)
+ continue;
+ *r = q;
+ return class->fn(chr);
+ }
+
+ *r = 0;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+STATIC int
+pmatch(const char *pattern, const char *string)
+{
+ const char *p, *q;
+ char c;
+
+ p = pattern;
+ q = string;
+ for (;;) {
+ switch (c = *p++) {
+ case '\0':
+ goto breakloop;
+ case '\\':
+ if (*p) {
+ c = *p++;
+ }
+ goto dft;
+ case '?':
+ if (*q++ == '\0')
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ case '*':
+ c = *p;
+ while (c == '*')
+ c = *++p;
+ if (c != '\\' && c != '?' && c != '*' && c != '[') {
+ while (*q != c) {
+ if (*q == '\0')
+ return 0;
+ q++;
+ }
+ }
+ do {
+ if (pmatch(p, q))
+ return 1;
+ } while (*q++ != '\0');
+ return 0;
+ case '[': {
+ const char *startp;
+ int invert, found;
+ char chr;
+
+ startp = p;
+ invert = 0;
+ if (*p == '!') {
+ invert++;
+ p++;
+ }
+ found = 0;
+ chr = *q++;
+ if (chr == '\0')
+ return 0;
+ c = *p++;
+ do {
+ if (!c) {
+ p = startp;
+ c = *p;
+ goto dft;
+ }
+ if (c == '[') {
+ const char *r;
+
+ found |= !!ccmatch(p, chr, &r);
+ if (r) {
+ p = r;
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else if (c == '\\')
+ c = *p++;
+ if (*p == '-' && p[1] != ']') {
+ p++;
+ if (*p == '\\')
+ p++;
+ if (chr >= c && chr <= *p)
+ found = 1;
+ p++;
+ } else {
+ if (chr == c)
+ found = 1;
+ }
+ } while ((c = *p++) != ']');
+ if (found == invert)
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ }
+dft: default:
+ if (*q++ != c)
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+breakloop:
+ if (*q != '\0')
+ return 0;
+ return 1;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Remove any CTLESC characters from a string.
+ */
+
+char *
+_rmescapes(char *str, int flag)
+{
+ char *p, *q, *r;
+ unsigned inquotes;
+ int notescaped;
+ int globbing;
+
+ p = strpbrk(str, qchars);
+ if (!p) {
+ return str;
+ }
+ q = p;
+ r = str;
+ if (flag & RMESCAPE_ALLOC) {
+ size_t len = p - str;
+ size_t fulllen = len + strlen(p) + 1;
+
+ if (flag & RMESCAPE_GROW) {
+ int strloc = str - (char *)stackblock();
+
+ r = makestrspace(fulllen, expdest);
+ str = (char *)stackblock() + strloc;
+ p = str + len;
+ } else if (flag & RMESCAPE_HEAP) {
+ r = ckmalloc(fulllen);
+ } else {
+ r = stalloc(fulllen);
+ }
+ q = r;
+ if (len > 0) {
+ q = mempcpy(q, str, len);
+ }
+ }
+ inquotes = 0;
+ globbing = flag & RMESCAPE_GLOB;
+ notescaped = globbing;
+ while (*p) {
+ if (*p == (char)CTLQUOTEMARK) {
+ inquotes = ~inquotes;
+ p++;
+ notescaped = globbing;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (*p == (char)CTLESC) {
+ p++;
+ if (notescaped)
+ *q++ = '\\';
+ } else if (*p == '\\' && !inquotes) {
+ /* naked back slash */
+ notescaped = 0;
+ goto copy;
+ }
+ notescaped = globbing;
+copy:
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ }
+ *q = '\0';
+ if (flag & RMESCAPE_GROW) {
+ expdest = r;
+ STADJUST(q - r + 1, expdest);
+ }
+ return r;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * See if a pattern matches in a case statement.
+ */
+
+int
+casematch(union node *pattern, char *val)
+{
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ int result;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ argbackq = pattern->narg.backquote;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(expdest);
+ argstr(pattern->narg.text, EXP_TILDE | EXP_CASE);
+ STACKSTRNUL(expdest);
+ ifsfree();
+ result = patmatch(stackblock(), val);
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ return result;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Our own itoa().
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+cvtnum(intmax_t num)
+{
+ int len = max_int_length(sizeof(num));
+
+ expdest = makestrspace(len, expdest);
+ len = fmtstr(expdest, len, "%" PRIdMAX, num);
+ STADJUST(len, expdest);
+ return len;
+}
+
+STATIC void
+varunset(const char *end, const char *var, const char *umsg, int varflags)
+{
+ const char *msg;
+ const char *tail;
+
+ tail = nullstr;
+ msg = "parameter not set";
+ if (umsg) {
+ if (*end == (char)CTLENDVAR) {
+ if (varflags & VSNUL)
+ tail = " or null";
+ } else
+ msg = umsg;
+ }
+ sh_error("%.*s: %s%s", end - var - 1, var, msg, tail);
+}
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+
+INCLUDE "expand.h"
+
+RESET {
+ ifsfree();
+}
+
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/expand.h b/usr/dash/expand.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9cf1276
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/expand.h
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)expand.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#ifndef DASH_STRLIST_H
+#define DASH_STRLIST_H
+
+#include <inttypes.h>
+
+struct strlist {
+ struct strlist *next;
+ char *text;
+};
+
+
+struct arglist {
+ struct strlist *list;
+ struct strlist **lastp;
+};
+
+/*
+ * expandarg() flags
+ */
+#define EXP_FULL 0x1 /* perform word splitting & file globbing */
+#define EXP_TILDE 0x2 /* do normal tilde expansion */
+#define EXP_VARTILDE 0x4 /* expand tildes in an assignment */
+#define EXP_REDIR 0x8 /* file glob for a redirection (1 match only) */
+#define EXP_CASE 0x10 /* keeps quotes around for CASE pattern */
+#define EXP_QPAT 0x20 /* pattern in quoted parameter expansion */
+#define EXP_VARTILDE2 0x40 /* expand tildes after colons only */
+#define EXP_WORD 0x80 /* expand word in parameter expansion */
+#define EXP_QUOTED 0x100 /* expand word in double quotes */
+
+
+union node;
+void expandarg(union node *, struct arglist *, int);
+void expari(int);
+#define rmescapes(p) _rmescapes((p), 0)
+char *_rmescapes(char *, int);
+int casematch(union node *, char *);
+void recordregion(int, int, int);
+void removerecordregions(int);
+void ifsbreakup(char *, struct arglist *);
+void ifsfree(void);
+
+/* From arith.y */
+intmax_t arith(const char *);
+int expcmd(int , char **);
+#ifdef USE_LEX
+void arith_lex_reset(void);
+#else
+#define arith_lex_reset()
+#endif
+int yylex(void);
+
+#endif /* DASH_STRLIST_H */
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/cmv b/usr/dash/funcs/cmv
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..91a67c5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/cmv
@@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)cmv 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+# Conditional move--don't replace an existing file.
+
+cmv() {
+ if test $# != 2
+ then echo "cmv: arg count"
+ return 2
+ fi
+ if test -f "$2" -o -w "$2"
+ then echo "$2 exists"
+ return 2
+ fi
+ /bin/mv "$1" "$2"
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/dirs b/usr/dash/funcs/dirs
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7d840eb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/dirs
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)dirs 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+# pushd, popd, and dirs --- written by Chris Bertin
+# Pixel Computer Inc. ...!wjh12!pixel!pixutl!chris
+# as modified by Patrick Elam of GTRI and Kenneth Almquist at UW
+
+pushd () {
+ SAVE=`pwd`
+ if [ "$1" = "" ]
+ then if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "pushd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1 || return
+ shift 1
+ DSTACK="$*"
+ else cd $1 > /dev/null || return
+ fi
+ DSTACK="$SAVE $DSTACK"
+ dirs
+}
+
+popd () {
+ if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "popd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1
+ shift
+ DSTACK=$*
+ dirs
+}
+
+dirs () {
+ echo "`pwd` $DSTACK"
+ return 0
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/kill b/usr/dash/funcs/kill
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c5df95f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/kill
@@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)kill 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+# Convert job names to process ids and then run /bin/kill.
+
+kill() {
+ local args x
+ args=
+ for x in "$@"
+ do case $x in
+ %*) x=`jobid "$x"` ;;
+ esac
+ args="$args $x"
+ done
+ /bin/kill $args
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/login b/usr/dash/funcs/login
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..215e535
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/login
@@ -0,0 +1,36 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)login 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+# replaces the login builtin in the BSD shell
+login () exec login "$@"
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/newgrp b/usr/dash/funcs/newgrp
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ec0e7e5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/newgrp
@@ -0,0 +1,35 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)newgrp 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+newgrp() exec newgrp "$@"
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/popd b/usr/dash/funcs/popd
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3b1ab46
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/popd
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)popd 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+# pushd, popd, and dirs --- written by Chris Bertin
+# Pixel Computer Inc. ...!wjh12!pixel!pixutl!chris
+# as modified by Patrick Elam of GTRI and Kenneth Almquist at UW
+
+pushd () {
+ SAVE=`pwd`
+ if [ "$1" = "" ]
+ then if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "pushd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1 || return
+ shift 1
+ DSTACK="$*"
+ else cd $1 > /dev/null || return
+ fi
+ DSTACK="$SAVE $DSTACK"
+ dirs
+}
+
+popd () {
+ if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "popd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1
+ shift
+ DSTACK=$*
+ dirs
+}
+
+dirs () {
+ echo "`pwd` $DSTACK"
+ return 0
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/pushd b/usr/dash/funcs/pushd
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..483d358
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/pushd
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)pushd 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+# pushd, popd, and dirs --- written by Chris Bertin
+# Pixel Computer Inc. ...!wjh12!pixel!pixutl!chris
+# as modified by Patrick Elam of GTRI and Kenneth Almquist at UW
+
+pushd () {
+ SAVE=`pwd`
+ if [ "$1" = "" ]
+ then if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "pushd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1 || return
+ shift 1
+ DSTACK="$*"
+ else cd $1 > /dev/null || return
+ fi
+ DSTACK="$SAVE $DSTACK"
+ dirs
+}
+
+popd () {
+ if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "popd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1
+ shift
+ DSTACK=$*
+ dirs
+}
+
+dirs () {
+ echo "`pwd` $DSTACK"
+ return 0
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/funcs/suspend b/usr/dash/funcs/suspend
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4484467
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/funcs/suspend
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)suspend 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+suspend() {
+ local -
+ set +j
+ kill -TSTP 0
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/gendeps.pl b/usr/dash/gendeps.pl
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..e6797de
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/gendeps.pl
@@ -0,0 +1,38 @@
+#!/usr/bin/perl
+#
+# Generate dependencies for *generated* header files. Generated
+# header files have to use #include "foo.h" syntax.
+#
+
+($src, $obj, @build_headers) = @ARGV;
+%build_headers = map { $_ => 1 } @build_headers;
+
+open(GENDEPS, "> $obj/.gendeps\0")
+ or die "$0: Cannot create $obj/.gendeps: $!\n";
+
+opendir(DIR, $src) or die "$0: Cannot opendir $src: $!\n";
+while ( defined($file = readdir(DIR)) ) {
+ if ( $file =~ /^(.*)\.c$/ ) {
+ $basename = $1;
+ @hdrs = ();
+ open(FILE, "< $src/$file\0")
+ or die "$0: Cannot open $src/$file: $!\n";
+ while ( defined($line = <FILE>) ) {
+ if ( $line =~ /^\s*\#\s*include\s+\"(.*)\"/ ) {
+ $header = $1;
+
+ if ( $build_headers{$header} ) {
+ push(@hdrs, "\$(obj)/$header");
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ close(FILE);
+
+ if (scalar(@hdrs)) {
+ print GENDEPS "\$(obj)/$basename.o: ", join(' ', @hdrs), "\n";
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+closedir(DIR);
+close(GENDEPS);
diff --git a/usr/dash/hetio.c b/usr/dash/hetio.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f7d175f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/hetio.c
@@ -0,0 +1,397 @@
+/*
+ * Termios command line History and Editting for NetBSD sh (ash)
+ * Copyright (c) 1999
+ * Main code: Adam Rogoyski <rogoyski@cs.utexas.edu>
+ * Etc: Dave Cinege <dcinege@psychosis.com>
+ *
+ * You may use this code as you wish, so long as the original author(s)
+ * are attributed in any redistributions of the source code.
+ * This code is 'as is' with no warranty.
+ * This code may safely be consumed by a BSD or GPL license.
+ *
+ * v 0.5 19990328 Initial release
+ *
+ * Future plans: Simple file and path name completion. (like BASH)
+ *
+ */
+
+/*
+Usage and Known bugs:
+ Terminal key codes are not extensive, and more will probably
+ need to be added. This version was created on Debian GNU/Linux 2.x.
+ Delete, Backspace, Home, End, and the arrow keys were tested
+ to work in an Xterm and console. Ctrl-A also works as Home.
+ Ctrl-E also works as End. Ctrl-D and Ctrl-U perform their respective
+ functions. The binary size increase is <3K.
+
+ Editting will not display correctly for lines greater then the
+ terminal width. (more then one line.) However, history will.
+*/
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <termios.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+
+#include "hetio.h"
+
+
+#define MAX_HISTORY 15 /* Maximum length of the linked list for the command line history */
+
+#define ESC 27
+#define DEL 127
+
+static struct history *his_front = NULL; /* First element in command line list */
+static struct history *his_end = NULL; /* Last element in command line list */
+static struct termios old_term, new_term; /* Current termio and the previous termio before starting ash */
+
+static int history_counter = 0; /* Number of commands in history list */
+static int reset_term = 0; /* Set to true if the terminal needs to be reset upon exit */
+static int hetio_inter = 0;
+
+struct history
+{
+ char *s;
+ struct history *p;
+ struct history *n;
+};
+
+
+void input_delete (int);
+void input_home (int *);
+void input_end (int *, int);
+void input_backspace (int *, int *);
+
+
+
+void hetio_init(void)
+{
+ hetio_inter = 1;
+}
+
+
+void hetio_reset_term(void)
+{
+ if (reset_term)
+ tcsetattr(1, TCSANOW, &old_term);
+}
+
+
+void setIO(struct termios *new, struct termios *old) /* Set terminal IO to canonical mode, and save old term settings. */
+{
+ tcgetattr(0, old);
+ memcpy(new, old, sizeof(*new));
+ new->c_cc[VMIN] = 1;
+ new->c_cc[VTIME] = 0;
+ new->c_lflag &= ~ICANON; /* unbuffered input */
+ new->c_lflag &= ~ECHO;
+ tcsetattr(0, TCSANOW, new);
+}
+
+void input_home(int *cursor) /* Command line input routines */
+{
+ while (*cursor > 0) {
+ out1c('\b');
+ --*cursor;
+ }
+ flushout(out1);
+}
+
+
+void input_delete(int cursor)
+{
+ int j = 0;
+
+ memmove(parsenextc + cursor, parsenextc + cursor + 1,
+ BUFSIZ - cursor - 1);
+ for (j = cursor; j < (BUFSIZ - 1); j++) {
+ if (!*(parsenextc + j))
+ break;
+ else
+ out1c(*(parsenextc + j));
+ }
+
+ out1str(" \b");
+
+ while (j-- > cursor)
+ out1c('\b');
+ flushout(out1);
+}
+
+
+void input_end(int *cursor, int len)
+{
+ while (*cursor < len) {
+ out1str("\033[C");
+ ++*cursor;
+ }
+ flushout(out1);
+}
+
+
+void
+input_backspace(int *cursor, int *len)
+{
+ int j = 0;
+
+ if (*cursor > 0) {
+ out1str("\b \b");
+ --*cursor;
+ memmove(parsenextc + *cursor, parsenextc + *cursor + 1,
+ BUFSIZ - *cursor + 1);
+
+ for (j = *cursor; j < (BUFSIZ - 1); j++) {
+ if (!*(parsenextc + j))
+ break;
+ else
+ out1c(*(parsenextc + j));
+ }
+
+ out1str(" \b");
+
+ while (j-- > *cursor)
+ out1c('\b');
+
+ --*len;
+ flushout(out1);
+ }
+}
+
+int hetio_read_input(int fd)
+{
+ int nr = 0;
+
+ /* Are we an interactive shell? */
+ if (!hetio_inter || fd) {
+ return -255;
+ } else {
+ int len = 0;
+ int j = 0;
+ int cursor = 0;
+ int break_out = 0;
+ int ret = 0;
+ char c = 0;
+ struct history *hp = his_end;
+
+ if (!reset_term) {
+ setIO(&new_term, &old_term);
+ reset_term = 1;
+ } else {
+ tcsetattr(0, TCSANOW, &new_term);
+ }
+
+ memset(parsenextc, 0, BUFSIZ);
+
+ while (1) {
+ if ((ret = read(fd, &c, 1)) < 1)
+ return ret;
+
+ switch (c) {
+ case 1: /* Control-A Beginning of line */
+ input_home(&cursor);
+ break;
+ case 5: /* Control-E EOL */
+ input_end(&cursor, len);
+ break;
+ case 4: /* Control-D */
+ if (!len)
+ exitshell(0);
+ break;
+ case 21: /* Control-U */
+ /* Return to begining of line. */
+ for (; cursor > 0; cursor--)
+ out1c('\b');
+ /* Erase old command. */
+ for (j = 0; j < len; j++) {
+ /*
+ * Clear buffer while we're at
+ * it.
+ */
+ parsenextc[j] = 0;
+ out1c(' ');
+ }
+ /* return to begining of line */
+ for (; len > 0; len--)
+ out1c('\b');
+ flushout(out1);
+ break;
+ case '\b': /* Backspace */
+ case DEL:
+ input_backspace(&cursor, &len);
+ break;
+ case '\n': /* Enter */
+ *(parsenextc + len++ + 1) = c;
+ out1c(c);
+ flushout(out1);
+ break_out = 1;
+ break;
+ case ESC: /* escape sequence follows */
+ if ((ret = read(fd, &c, 1)) < 1)
+ return ret;
+
+ if (c == '[' ) { /* 91 */
+ if ((ret = read(fd, &c, 1)) < 1)
+ return ret;
+
+ switch (c) {
+ case 'A':
+ if (hp && hp->p) { /* Up */
+ hp = hp->p;
+ goto hop;
+ }
+ break;
+ case 'B':
+ if (hp && hp->n && hp->n->s) { /* Down */
+ hp = hp->n;
+ goto hop;
+ }
+ break;
+
+hop: /* hop */
+ len = strlen(parsenextc);
+
+ for (; cursor > 0; cursor--) /* return to begining of line */
+ out1c('\b');
+
+ for (j = 0; j < len; j++) /* erase old command */
+ out1c(' ');
+
+ for (; j > 0; j--) /* return to begining of line */
+ out1c('\b');
+
+ strcpy (parsenextc, hp->s); /* write new command */
+ len = strlen (hp->s);
+ out1str(parsenextc);
+ flushout(out1);
+ cursor = len;
+ break;
+ case 'C': /* Right */
+ if (cursor < len) {
+ out1str("\033[C");
+ cursor++;
+ flushout(out1);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 'D': /* Left */
+ if (cursor > 0) {
+ out1str("\033[D");
+ cursor--;
+ flushout(out1);
+ }
+ break;
+ case '3': /* Delete */
+ if (cursor != len) {
+ input_delete(cursor);
+ len--;
+ }
+ break;
+ case '1': /* Home (Ctrl-A) */
+ input_home(&cursor);
+ break;
+ case '4': /* End (Ctrl-E) */
+ input_end(&cursor, len);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c == '1' || c == '3' || c == '4')
+ if ((ret = read(fd, &c, 1)) < 1)
+ return ret; /* read 126 (~) */
+ }
+
+ if (c == 'O') { /* 79 */
+ if ((ret = read(fd, &c, 1)) < 1)
+ return ret;
+ switch (c) {
+ case 'H': /* Home (xterm) */
+ input_home(&cursor);
+ break;
+ case 'F': /* End (xterm_ */
+ input_end(&cursor, len);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ c = 0;
+ break;
+
+ default: /* If it's regular input, do the normal thing */
+ if (!isprint(c)) /* Skip non-printable characters */
+ break;
+
+ if (len >= (BUFSIZ - 2)) /* Need to leave space for enter */
+ break;
+
+ len++;
+
+ if (cursor == (len - 1)) { /* Append if at the end of the line */
+ *(parsenextc + cursor) = c;
+ } else { /* Insert otherwise */
+ memmove(parsenextc + cursor + 1, parsenextc + cursor,
+ len - cursor - 1);
+
+ *(parsenextc + cursor) = c;
+
+ for (j = cursor; j < len; j++)
+ out1c(*(parsenextc + j));
+ for (; j > cursor; j--)
+ out1str("\033[D");
+ }
+
+ cursor++;
+ out1c(c);
+ flushout(out1);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (break_out) /* Enter is the command terminator, no more input. */
+ break;
+ }
+
+ nr = len + 1;
+ tcsetattr(0, TCSANOW, &old_term);
+
+ if (*(parsenextc)) { /* Handle command history log */
+ struct history *h = his_end;
+
+ if (!h) { /* No previous history */
+ h = his_front = malloc(sizeof (struct history));
+ h->n = malloc(sizeof (struct history));
+ h->p = NULL;
+ h->s = strdup(parsenextc);
+
+ h->n->p = h;
+ h->n->n = NULL;
+ h->n->s = NULL;
+ his_end = h->n;
+ history_counter++;
+ } else { /* Add a new history command */
+
+ h->n = malloc(sizeof (struct history));
+
+ h->n->p = h;
+ h->n->n = NULL;
+ h->n->s = NULL;
+ h->s = strdup(parsenextc);
+ his_end = h->n;
+
+ if (history_counter >= MAX_HISTORY) { /* After max history, remove the last known command */
+ struct history *p = his_front->n;
+
+ p->p = NULL;
+ free(his_front->s);
+ free(his_front);
+ his_front = p;
+ } else {
+ history_counter++;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ return nr;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/hetio.h b/usr/dash/hetio.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5f49713
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/hetio.h
@@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
+/*
+ * Termios command line History and Editting for NetBSD sh (ash)
+ * Copyright (c) 1999
+ * Main code: Adam Rogoyski <rogoyski@cs.utexas.edu>
+ * Etc: Dave Cinege <dcinege@psychosis.com>
+ *
+ * You may use this code as you wish, so long as the original author(s)
+ * are attributed in any redistributions of the source code.
+ * This code is 'as is' with no warranty.
+ * This code may safely be consumed by a BSD or GPL license.
+ *
+ * v 0.5 19990328 Initial release
+ *
+ * Future plans: Simple file and path name completion. (like BASH)
+ *
+ */
+
+void hetio_init(void);
+int hetio_read_input(int fd);
+void hetio_reset_term(void);
+
+extern int hetio_inter;
diff --git a/usr/dash/histedit.c b/usr/dash/histedit.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b27d629
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/histedit.c
@@ -0,0 +1,494 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_PATHS_H
+#include <paths.h>
+#endif
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+/*
+ * Editline and history functions (and glue).
+ */
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#ifndef SMALL
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+
+#define MAXHISTLOOPS 4 /* max recursions through fc */
+#define DEFEDITOR "ed" /* default editor *should* be $EDITOR */
+
+History *hist; /* history cookie */
+EditLine *el; /* editline cookie */
+int displayhist;
+static FILE *el_in, *el_out;
+
+STATIC const char *fc_replace(const char *, char *, char *);
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+extern FILE *tracefile;
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Set history and editing status. Called whenever the status may
+ * have changed (figures out what to do).
+ */
+void
+histedit(void)
+{
+ FILE *el_err;
+
+#define editing (Eflag || Vflag)
+
+ if (iflag) {
+ if (!hist) {
+ /*
+ * turn history on
+ */
+ INTOFF;
+ hist = history_init();
+ INTON;
+
+ if (hist != NULL)
+ sethistsize(histsizeval());
+ else
+ out2str("sh: can't initialize history\n");
+ }
+ if (editing && !el && isatty(0)) { /* && isatty(2) ??? */
+ /*
+ * turn editing on
+ */
+ INTOFF;
+ if (el_in == NULL)
+ el_in = fdopen(0, "r");
+ if (el_out == NULL)
+ el_out = fdopen(2, "w");
+ if (el_in == NULL || el_out == NULL)
+ goto bad;
+ el_err = el_out;
+#if DEBUG
+ if (tracefile)
+ el_err = tracefile;
+#endif
+ el = el_init(arg0, el_in, el_out, el_err);
+ if (el != NULL) {
+ if (hist)
+ el_set(el, EL_HIST, history, hist);
+ el_set(el, EL_PROMPT, getprompt);
+ } else {
+bad:
+ out2str("sh: can't initialize editing\n");
+ }
+ INTON;
+ } else if (!editing && el) {
+ INTOFF;
+ el_end(el);
+ el = NULL;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ if (el) {
+ if (Vflag)
+ el_set(el, EL_EDITOR, "vi");
+ else if (Eflag)
+ el_set(el, EL_EDITOR, "emacs");
+ el_source(el, NULL);
+ }
+ } else {
+ INTOFF;
+ if (el) { /* no editing if not interactive */
+ el_end(el);
+ el = NULL;
+ }
+ if (hist) {
+ history_end(hist);
+ hist = NULL;
+ }
+ INTON;
+ }
+}
+
+
+void
+sethistsize(const char *hs)
+{
+ int histsize;
+ HistEvent he;
+
+ if (hist != NULL) {
+ if (hs == NULL || *hs == '\0' ||
+ (histsize = atoi(hs)) < 0)
+ histsize = 100;
+ history(hist, &he, H_SETSIZE, histsize);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+setterm(const char *term)
+{
+ if (el != NULL && term != NULL)
+ if (el_set(el, EL_TERMINAL, term) != 0) {
+ outfmt(out2, "sh: Can't set terminal type %s\n", term);
+ outfmt(out2, "sh: Using dumb terminal settings.\n");
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * This command is provided since POSIX decided to standardize
+ * the Korn shell fc command. Oh well...
+ */
+int
+histcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int ch;
+ const char *editor = NULL;
+ HistEvent he;
+ int lflg = 0, nflg = 0, rflg = 0, sflg = 0;
+ int i, retval;
+ const char *firststr, *laststr;
+ int first, last, direction;
+ char *pat = NULL, *repl; /* ksh "fc old=new" crap */
+ static int active = 0;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ struct jmploc *volatile savehandler;
+ char editfile[MAXPATHLEN + 1];
+ FILE *efp;
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+ /* Avoid longjmp clobbering */
+ (void) &editor;
+ (void) &lflg;
+ (void) &nflg;
+ (void) &rflg;
+ (void) &sflg;
+ (void) &firststr;
+ (void) &laststr;
+ (void) &pat;
+ (void) &repl;
+ (void) &efp;
+ (void) &argc;
+ (void) &argv;
+#endif
+
+ if (hist == NULL)
+ sh_error("history not active");
+
+ if (argc == 1)
+ sh_error("missing history argument");
+
+#ifdef __GLIBC__
+ optind = 0;
+#else
+ optreset = 1; optind = 1; /* initialize getopt */
+#endif
+ while (not_fcnumber(argv[optind]) &&
+ (ch = getopt(argc, argv, ":e:lnrs")) != -1)
+ switch ((char)ch) {
+ case 'e':
+ editor = optionarg;
+ break;
+ case 'l':
+ lflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ nflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ rflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ sflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case ':':
+ sh_error("option -%c expects argument", optopt);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ sh_error("unknown option: -%c", optopt);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+ argc -= optind, argv += optind;
+
+ /*
+ * If executing...
+ */
+ if (lflg == 0 || editor || sflg) {
+ lflg = 0; /* ignore */
+ editfile[0] = '\0';
+ /*
+ * Catch interrupts to reset active counter and
+ * cleanup temp files.
+ */
+ if (setjmp(jmploc.loc)) {
+ active = 0;
+ if (*editfile)
+ unlink(editfile);
+ handler = savehandler;
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+ }
+ savehandler = handler;
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ if (++active > MAXHISTLOOPS) {
+ active = 0;
+ displayhist = 0;
+ sh_error("called recursively too many times");
+ }
+ /*
+ * Set editor.
+ */
+ if (sflg == 0) {
+ if (editor == NULL &&
+ (editor = bltinlookup("FCEDIT")) == NULL &&
+ (editor = bltinlookup("EDITOR")) == NULL)
+ editor = DEFEDITOR;
+ if (editor[0] == '-' && editor[1] == '\0') {
+ sflg = 1; /* no edit */
+ editor = NULL;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If executing, parse [old=new] now
+ */
+ if (lflg == 0 && argc > 0 &&
+ ((repl = strchr(argv[0], '=')) != NULL)) {
+ pat = argv[0];
+ *repl++ = '\0';
+ argc--, argv++;
+ }
+ /*
+ * determine [first] and [last]
+ */
+ switch (argc) {
+ case 0:
+ firststr = lflg ? "-16" : "-1";
+ laststr = "-1";
+ break;
+ case 1:
+ firststr = argv[0];
+ laststr = lflg ? "-1" : argv[0];
+ break;
+ case 2:
+ firststr = argv[0];
+ laststr = argv[1];
+ break;
+ default:
+ sh_error("too many args");
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+ /*
+ * Turn into event numbers.
+ */
+ first = str_to_event(firststr, 0);
+ last = str_to_event(laststr, 1);
+
+ if (rflg) {
+ i = last;
+ last = first;
+ first = i;
+ }
+ /*
+ * XXX - this should not depend on the event numbers
+ * always increasing. Add sequence numbers or offset
+ * to the history element in next (diskbased) release.
+ */
+ direction = first < last ? H_PREV : H_NEXT;
+
+ /*
+ * If editing, grab a temp file.
+ */
+ if (editor) {
+ int fd;
+ INTOFF; /* easier */
+ sprintf(editfile, "%s_shXXXXXX", _PATH_TMP);
+ if ((fd = mkstemp(editfile)) < 0)
+ sh_error("can't create temporary file %s", editfile);
+ if ((efp = fdopen(fd, "w")) == NULL) {
+ close(fd);
+ sh_error("can't allocate stdio buffer for temp");
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Loop through selected history events. If listing or executing,
+ * do it now. Otherwise, put into temp file and call the editor
+ * after.
+ *
+ * The history interface needs rethinking, as the following
+ * convolutions will demonstrate.
+ */
+ history(hist, &he, H_FIRST);
+ retval = history(hist, &he, H_NEXT_EVENT, first);
+ for (;retval != -1; retval = history(hist, &he, direction)) {
+ if (lflg) {
+ if (!nflg)
+ out1fmt("%5d ", he.num);
+ out1str(he.str);
+ } else {
+ const char *s = pat ?
+ fc_replace(he.str, pat, repl) : he.str;
+
+ if (sflg) {
+ if (displayhist) {
+ out2str(s);
+ }
+
+ evalstring(strcpy(stalloc(strlen(s) + 1), s),
+ 0);
+ if (displayhist && hist) {
+ /*
+ * XXX what about recursive and
+ * relative histnums.
+ */
+ history(hist, &he, H_ENTER, s);
+ }
+ } else
+ fputs(s, efp);
+ }
+ /*
+ * At end? (if we were to lose last, we'd sure be
+ * messed up).
+ */
+ if (he.num == last)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (editor) {
+ char *editcmd;
+
+ fclose(efp);
+ editcmd = stalloc(strlen(editor) + strlen(editfile) + 2);
+ sprintf(editcmd, "%s %s", editor, editfile);
+ /* XXX - should use no JC command */
+ evalstring(editcmd, 0);
+ INTON;
+ readcmdfile(editfile); /* XXX - should read back - quick tst */
+ unlink(editfile);
+ }
+
+ if (lflg == 0 && active > 0)
+ --active;
+ if (displayhist)
+ displayhist = 0;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+STATIC const char *
+fc_replace(const char *s, char *p, char *r)
+{
+ char *dest;
+ int plen = strlen(p);
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(dest);
+ while (*s) {
+ if (*s == *p && strncmp(s, p, plen) == 0) {
+ while (*r)
+ STPUTC(*r++, dest);
+ s += plen;
+ *p = '\0'; /* so no more matches */
+ } else
+ STPUTC(*s++, dest);
+ }
+ STACKSTRNUL(dest);
+ dest = grabstackstr(dest);
+
+ return (dest);
+}
+
+int
+not_fcnumber(char *s)
+{
+ if (s == NULL)
+ return 0;
+ if (*s == '-')
+ s++;
+ return (!is_number(s));
+}
+
+int
+str_to_event(const char *str, int last)
+{
+ HistEvent he;
+ const char *s = str;
+ int relative = 0;
+ int i, retval;
+
+ retval = history(hist, &he, H_FIRST);
+ switch (*s) {
+ case '-':
+ relative = 1;
+ /*FALLTHROUGH*/
+ case '+':
+ s++;
+ }
+ if (is_number(s)) {
+ i = atoi(s);
+ if (relative) {
+ while (retval != -1 && i--) {
+ retval = history(hist, &he, H_NEXT);
+ }
+ if (retval == -1)
+ retval = history(hist, &he, H_LAST);
+ } else {
+ retval = history(hist, &he, H_NEXT_EVENT, i);
+ if (retval == -1) {
+ /*
+ * the notion of first and last is
+ * backwards to that of the history package
+ */
+ retval = history(hist, &he,
+ last ? H_FIRST : H_LAST);
+ }
+ }
+ if (retval == -1)
+ sh_error("history number %s not found (internal error)",
+ str);
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * pattern
+ */
+ retval = history(hist, &he, H_PREV_STR, str);
+ if (retval == -1)
+ sh_error("history pattern not found: %s", str);
+ }
+ return (he.num);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/init.h b/usr/dash/init.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e026e86
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/init.h
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)init.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+void init(void);
+void reset(void);
+void initshellproc(void);
diff --git a/usr/dash/input.c b/usr/dash/input.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d31c45b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/input.c
@@ -0,0 +1,532 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h> /* defines BUFSIZ */
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+/*
+ * This file implements the input routines used by the parser.
+ */
+
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "alias.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#ifndef SMALL
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HETIO
+#include "hetio.h"
+#endif
+
+#define EOF_NLEFT -99 /* value of parsenleft when EOF pushed back */
+#define IBUFSIZ (BUFSIZ + 1)
+
+MKINIT
+struct strpush {
+ struct strpush *prev; /* preceding string on stack */
+ char *prevstring;
+ int prevnleft;
+ struct alias *ap; /* if push was associated with an alias */
+ char *string; /* remember the string since it may change */
+};
+
+/*
+ * The parsefile structure pointed to by the global variable parsefile
+ * contains information about the current file being read.
+ */
+
+MKINIT
+struct parsefile {
+ struct parsefile *prev; /* preceding file on stack */
+ int linno; /* current line */
+ int fd; /* file descriptor (or -1 if string) */
+ int nleft; /* number of chars left in this line */
+ int lleft; /* number of chars left in this buffer */
+ char *nextc; /* next char in buffer */
+ char *buf; /* input buffer */
+ struct strpush *strpush; /* for pushing strings at this level */
+ struct strpush basestrpush; /* so pushing one is fast */
+};
+
+
+int plinno = 1; /* input line number */
+int parsenleft; /* copy of parsefile->nleft */
+MKINIT int parselleft; /* copy of parsefile->lleft */
+char *parsenextc; /* copy of parsefile->nextc */
+MKINIT struct parsefile basepf; /* top level input file */
+MKINIT char basebuf[IBUFSIZ]; /* buffer for top level input file */
+struct parsefile *parsefile = &basepf; /* current input file */
+int whichprompt; /* 1 == PS1, 2 == PS2 */
+
+#ifndef SMALL
+EditLine *el; /* cookie for editline package */
+#endif
+
+STATIC void pushfile(void);
+static int preadfd(void);
+static void setinputfd(int fd, int push);
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE <stdio.h>
+INCLUDE "input.h"
+INCLUDE "error.h"
+
+INIT {
+ basepf.nextc = basepf.buf = basebuf;
+}
+
+RESET {
+ parselleft = parsenleft = 0; /* clear input buffer */
+ popallfiles();
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Read a character from the script, returning PEOF on end of file.
+ * Nul characters in the input are silently discarded.
+ */
+
+int
+pgetc(void)
+{
+ return pgetc_macro();
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Same as pgetc(), but ignores PEOA.
+ */
+
+int
+pgetc2()
+{
+ int c;
+ do {
+ c = pgetc_macro();
+ } while (c == PEOA);
+ return c;
+}
+
+
+static int
+preadfd(void)
+{
+ int nr;
+ char *buf = parsefile->buf;
+ parsenextc = buf;
+
+retry:
+#ifndef SMALL
+ if (parsefile->fd == 0 && el) {
+ static const char *rl_cp;
+ static int el_len;
+
+ if (rl_cp == NULL)
+ rl_cp = el_gets(el, &el_len);
+ if (rl_cp == NULL)
+ nr = 0;
+ else {
+ nr = el_len;
+ if (nr > IBUFSIZ - 1)
+ nr = IBUFSIZ - 1;
+ memcpy(buf, rl_cp, nr);
+ if (nr != el_len) {
+ el_len -= nr;
+ rl_cp += nr;
+ } else
+ rl_cp = 0;
+ }
+
+ } else
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HETIO
+ nr = hetio_read_input(parsefile->fd);
+ if (nr == -255)
+#endif
+ nr = read(parsefile->fd, buf, IBUFSIZ - 1);
+
+
+ if (nr < 0) {
+ if (errno == EINTR)
+ goto retry;
+ if (parsefile->fd == 0 && errno == EWOULDBLOCK) {
+ int flags = fcntl(0, F_GETFL, 0);
+ if (flags >= 0 && flags & O_NONBLOCK) {
+ flags &=~ O_NONBLOCK;
+ if (fcntl(0, F_SETFL, flags) >= 0) {
+ out2str("sh: turning off NDELAY mode\n");
+ goto retry;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return nr;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Refill the input buffer and return the next input character:
+ *
+ * 1) If a string was pushed back on the input, pop it;
+ * 2) If an EOF was pushed back (parsenleft == EOF_NLEFT) or we are reading
+ * from a string so we can't refill the buffer, return EOF.
+ * 3) If the is more stuff in this buffer, use it else call read to fill it.
+ * 4) Process input up to the next newline, deleting nul characters.
+ */
+
+int
+preadbuffer(void)
+{
+ char *q;
+ int more;
+#ifndef SMALL
+ int something;
+#endif
+ char savec;
+
+ while (unlikely(parsefile->strpush)) {
+ if (
+ parsenleft == -1 && parsefile->strpush->ap &&
+ parsenextc[-1] != ' ' && parsenextc[-1] != '\t'
+ ) {
+ return PEOA;
+ }
+ popstring();
+ if (--parsenleft >= 0)
+ return (signed char)*parsenextc++;
+ }
+ if (unlikely(parsenleft == EOF_NLEFT || parsefile->buf == NULL))
+ return PEOF;
+ flushout(&output);
+#ifdef FLUSHERR
+ flushout(&errout);
+#endif
+
+ more = parselleft;
+ if (more <= 0) {
+again:
+ if ((more = preadfd()) <= 0) {
+ parselleft = parsenleft = EOF_NLEFT;
+ return PEOF;
+ }
+ }
+
+ q = parsenextc;
+
+ /* delete nul characters */
+#ifndef SMALL
+ something = 0;
+#endif
+ for (;;) {
+ int c;
+
+ more--;
+ c = *q;
+
+ if (!c)
+ memmove(q, q + 1, more);
+ else {
+ q++;
+
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ parsenleft = q - parsenextc - 1;
+ break;
+ }
+
+#ifndef SMALL
+ switch (c) {
+ default:
+ something = 1;
+ /* fall through */
+ case '\t':
+ case ' ':
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+
+ if (more <= 0) {
+ parsenleft = q - parsenextc - 1;
+ if (parsenleft < 0)
+ goto again;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ parselleft = more;
+
+ savec = *q;
+ *q = '\0';
+
+#ifndef SMALL
+ if (parsefile->fd == 0 && hist && something) {
+ HistEvent he;
+ INTOFF;
+ history(hist, &he, whichprompt == 1? H_ENTER : H_APPEND,
+ parsenextc);
+ INTON;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if (vflag) {
+ out2str(parsenextc);
+#ifdef FLUSHERR
+ flushout(out2);
+#endif
+ }
+
+ *q = savec;
+
+ return (signed char)*parsenextc++;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Undo the last call to pgetc. Only one character may be pushed back.
+ * PEOF may be pushed back.
+ */
+
+void
+pungetc(void)
+{
+ parsenleft++;
+ parsenextc--;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Push a string back onto the input at this current parsefile level.
+ * We handle aliases this way.
+ */
+void
+pushstring(char *s, void *ap)
+{
+ struct strpush *sp;
+ size_t len;
+
+ len = strlen(s);
+ INTOFF;
+/*dprintf("*** calling pushstring: %s, %d\n", s, len);*/
+ if (parsefile->strpush) {
+ sp = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct strpush));
+ sp->prev = parsefile->strpush;
+ parsefile->strpush = sp;
+ } else
+ sp = parsefile->strpush = &(parsefile->basestrpush);
+ sp->prevstring = parsenextc;
+ sp->prevnleft = parsenleft;
+ sp->ap = (struct alias *)ap;
+ if (ap) {
+ ((struct alias *)ap)->flag |= ALIASINUSE;
+ sp->string = s;
+ }
+ parsenextc = s;
+ parsenleft = len;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+void
+popstring(void)
+{
+ struct strpush *sp = parsefile->strpush;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if (sp->ap) {
+ if (parsenextc[-1] == ' ' || parsenextc[-1] == '\t') {
+ checkkwd |= CHKALIAS;
+ }
+ if (sp->string != sp->ap->val) {
+ ckfree(sp->string);
+ }
+ sp->ap->flag &= ~ALIASINUSE;
+ if (sp->ap->flag & ALIASDEAD) {
+ unalias(sp->ap->name);
+ }
+ }
+ parsenextc = sp->prevstring;
+ parsenleft = sp->prevnleft;
+/*dprintf("*** calling popstring: restoring to '%s'\n", parsenextc);*/
+ parsefile->strpush = sp->prev;
+ if (sp != &(parsefile->basestrpush))
+ ckfree(sp);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Set the input to take input from a file. If push is set, push the
+ * old input onto the stack first.
+ */
+
+int
+setinputfile(const char *fname, int flags)
+{
+ int fd;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if ((fd = open(fname, O_RDONLY)) < 0) {
+ if (flags & INPUT_NOFILE_OK)
+ goto out;
+ exitstatus = 127;
+ exerror(EXERROR, "Can't open %s", fname);
+ }
+ if (fd < 10)
+ fd = savefd(fd, fd);
+ setinputfd(fd, flags & INPUT_PUSH_FILE);
+out:
+ INTON;
+ return fd;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Like setinputfile, but takes an open file descriptor. Call this with
+ * interrupts off.
+ */
+
+static void
+setinputfd(int fd, int push)
+{
+ if (push) {
+ pushfile();
+ parsefile->buf = 0;
+ }
+ parsefile->fd = fd;
+ if (parsefile->buf == NULL)
+ parsefile->buf = ckmalloc(IBUFSIZ);
+ parselleft = parsenleft = 0;
+ plinno = 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Like setinputfile, but takes input from a string.
+ */
+
+void
+setinputstring(char *string)
+{
+ INTOFF;
+ pushfile();
+ parsenextc = string;
+ parsenleft = strlen(string);
+ parsefile->buf = NULL;
+ plinno = 1;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * To handle the "." command, a stack of input files is used. Pushfile
+ * adds a new entry to the stack and popfile restores the previous level.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+pushfile(void)
+{
+ struct parsefile *pf;
+
+ parsefile->nleft = parsenleft;
+ parsefile->lleft = parselleft;
+ parsefile->nextc = parsenextc;
+ parsefile->linno = plinno;
+ pf = (struct parsefile *)ckmalloc(sizeof (struct parsefile));
+ pf->prev = parsefile;
+ pf->fd = -1;
+ pf->strpush = NULL;
+ pf->basestrpush.prev = NULL;
+ parsefile = pf;
+}
+
+
+void
+popfile(void)
+{
+ struct parsefile *pf = parsefile;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if (pf->fd >= 0)
+ close(pf->fd);
+ if (pf->buf)
+ ckfree(pf->buf);
+ while (pf->strpush)
+ popstring();
+ parsefile = pf->prev;
+ ckfree(pf);
+ parsenleft = parsefile->nleft;
+ parselleft = parsefile->lleft;
+ parsenextc = parsefile->nextc;
+ plinno = parsefile->linno;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Return to top level.
+ */
+
+void
+popallfiles(void)
+{
+ while (parsefile != &basepf)
+ popfile();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Close the file(s) that the shell is reading commands from. Called
+ * after a fork is done.
+ */
+
+void
+closescript(void)
+{
+ popallfiles();
+ if (parsefile->fd > 0) {
+ close(parsefile->fd);
+ parsefile->fd = 0;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/input.h b/usr/dash/input.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..50a7797
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/input.h
@@ -0,0 +1,66 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)input.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+/* PEOF (the end of file marker) is defined in syntax.h */
+
+enum {
+ INPUT_PUSH_FILE = 1,
+ INPUT_NOFILE_OK = 2,
+};
+
+/*
+ * The input line number. Input.c just defines this variable, and saves
+ * and restores it when files are pushed and popped. The user of this
+ * package must set its value.
+ */
+extern int plinno;
+extern int parsenleft; /* number of characters left in input buffer */
+extern char *parsenextc; /* next character in input buffer */
+
+int pgetc(void);
+int pgetc2(void);
+int preadbuffer(void);
+void pungetc(void);
+void pushstring(char *, void *);
+void popstring(void);
+int setinputfile(const char *, int);
+void setinputstring(char *);
+void popfile(void);
+void popallfiles(void);
+void closescript(void);
+
+#define pgetc_macro() \
+ (--parsenleft >= 0 ? (signed char)*parsenextc++ : preadbuffer())
diff --git a/usr/dash/jobs.c b/usr/dash/jobs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f027cc1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/jobs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1504 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_PATHS_H
+#include <paths.h>
+#endif
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#ifdef BSD
+#include <sys/wait.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#endif
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#if JOBS
+#include <termios.h>
+#undef CEOF /* syntax.h redefines this */
+#endif
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+/* mode flags for set_curjob */
+#define CUR_DELETE 2
+#define CUR_RUNNING 1
+#define CUR_STOPPED 0
+
+/* mode flags for dowait */
+#define DOWAIT_NORMAL 0
+#define DOWAIT_BLOCK 1
+#define DOWAIT_WAITCMD 2
+
+/* array of jobs */
+static struct job *jobtab;
+/* size of array */
+static unsigned njobs;
+/* pid of last background process */
+pid_t backgndpid;
+
+#if JOBS
+/* pgrp of shell on invocation */
+static int initialpgrp;
+/* control terminal */
+static int ttyfd = -1;
+#endif
+
+/* current job */
+static struct job *curjob;
+/* number of presumed living untracked jobs */
+static int jobless;
+
+STATIC void set_curjob(struct job *, unsigned);
+STATIC int jobno(const struct job *);
+STATIC int sprint_status(char *, int, int);
+STATIC void freejob(struct job *);
+STATIC struct job *getjob(const char *, int);
+STATIC struct job *growjobtab(void);
+STATIC void forkchild(struct job *, union node *, int);
+STATIC void forkparent(struct job *, union node *, int, pid_t);
+STATIC int dowait(int, struct job *);
+#ifdef SYSV
+STATIC int onsigchild(void);
+#endif
+STATIC int waitproc(int, int *);
+STATIC char *commandtext(union node *);
+STATIC void cmdtxt(union node *);
+STATIC void cmdlist(union node *, int);
+STATIC void cmdputs(const char *);
+STATIC void showpipe(struct job *, struct output *);
+STATIC int getstatus(struct job *);
+
+#if JOBS
+static int restartjob(struct job *, int);
+static void xtcsetpgrp(int, pid_t);
+#endif
+
+STATIC void
+set_curjob(struct job *jp, unsigned mode)
+{
+ struct job *jp1;
+ struct job **jpp, **curp;
+
+ /* first remove from list */
+ jpp = curp = &curjob;
+ do {
+ jp1 = *jpp;
+ if (jp1 == jp)
+ break;
+ jpp = &jp1->prev_job;
+ } while (1);
+ *jpp = jp1->prev_job;
+
+ /* Then re-insert in correct position */
+ jpp = curp;
+ switch (mode) {
+ default:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ abort();
+#endif
+ case CUR_DELETE:
+ /* job being deleted */
+ break;
+ case CUR_RUNNING:
+ /* newly created job or backgrounded job,
+ put after all stopped jobs. */
+ do {
+ jp1 = *jpp;
+ if (!JOBS || !jp1 || jp1->state != JOBSTOPPED)
+ break;
+ jpp = &jp1->prev_job;
+ } while (1);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+#if JOBS
+ case CUR_STOPPED:
+#endif
+ /* newly stopped job - becomes curjob */
+ jp->prev_job = *jpp;
+ *jpp = jp;
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+#if JOBS
+/*
+ * Turn job control on and off.
+ *
+ * Note: This code assumes that the third arg to ioctl is a character
+ * pointer, which is true on Berkeley systems but not System V. Since
+ * System V doesn't have job control yet, this isn't a problem now.
+ *
+ * Called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+int jobctl;
+
+void
+setjobctl(int on)
+{
+ int fd;
+ int pgrp;
+
+ if (on == jobctl || rootshell == 0)
+ return;
+ if (on) {
+ int ofd;
+ ofd = fd = open(_PATH_TTY, O_RDWR);
+ if (fd < 0) {
+ fd += 3;
+ while (!isatty(fd))
+ if (--fd < 0)
+ goto out;
+ }
+ fd = savefd(fd, ofd);
+ do { /* while we are in the background */
+ if ((pgrp = tcgetpgrp(fd)) < 0) {
+out:
+ sh_warnx("can't access tty; job control turned off");
+ mflag = on = 0;
+ goto close;
+ }
+ if (pgrp == getpgrp())
+ break;
+ killpg(0, SIGTTIN);
+ } while (1);
+ initialpgrp = pgrp;
+
+ setsignal(SIGTSTP);
+ setsignal(SIGTTOU);
+ setsignal(SIGTTIN);
+ pgrp = rootpid;
+ setpgid(0, pgrp);
+ xtcsetpgrp(fd, pgrp);
+ } else {
+ /* turning job control off */
+ fd = ttyfd;
+ pgrp = initialpgrp;
+ xtcsetpgrp(fd, pgrp);
+ setpgid(0, pgrp);
+ setsignal(SIGTSTP);
+ setsignal(SIGTTOU);
+ setsignal(SIGTTIN);
+close:
+ close(fd);
+ fd = -1;
+ }
+ ttyfd = fd;
+ jobctl = on;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+int
+killcmd(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ int signo = -1;
+ int list = 0;
+ int i;
+ pid_t pid;
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ if (argc <= 1) {
+usage:
+ sh_error(
+"Usage: kill [-s sigspec | -signum | -sigspec] [pid | job]... or\n"
+"kill -l [exitstatus]"
+ );
+ }
+
+ if (**++argv == '-') {
+ signo = decode_signal(*argv + 1, 1);
+ if (signo < 0) {
+ int c;
+
+ while ((c = nextopt("ls:")) != '\0')
+ switch (c) {
+ default:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ abort();
+#endif
+ case 'l':
+ list = 1;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ signo = decode_signal(optionarg, 1);
+ if (signo < 0) {
+ sh_error(
+ "invalid signal number or name: %s",
+ optionarg
+ );
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ argv = argptr;
+ } else
+ argv++;
+ }
+
+ if (!list && signo < 0)
+ signo = SIGTERM;
+
+ if ((signo < 0 || !*argv) ^ list) {
+ goto usage;
+ }
+
+ if (list) {
+ struct output *out;
+
+ out = out1;
+ if (!*argv) {
+ outstr("0\n", out);
+ for (i = 1; i < NSIG; i++) {
+ outfmt(out, snlfmt, signal_name(i));
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+ signo = number(*argv);
+ if (signo > 128)
+ signo -= 128;
+ if (0 < signo && signo < NSIG)
+ outfmt(out, snlfmt, signal_name(signo));
+ else
+ sh_error("invalid signal number or exit status: %s",
+ *argv);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ i = 0;
+ do {
+ if (**argv == '%') {
+ jp = getjob(*argv, 0);
+ pid = -jp->ps[0].pid;
+ } else
+ pid = **argv == '-' ?
+ -number(*argv + 1) : number(*argv);
+ if (kill(pid, signo) != 0) {
+ sh_warnx("%s\n", strerror(errno));
+ i = 1;
+ }
+ } while (*++argv);
+
+ return i;
+}
+
+STATIC int
+jobno(const struct job *jp)
+{
+ return jp - jobtab + 1;
+}
+
+#if JOBS
+int
+fgcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct output *out;
+ int mode;
+ int retval;
+
+ mode = (**argv == 'f') ? FORK_FG : FORK_BG;
+ nextopt(nullstr);
+ argv = argptr;
+ out = out1;
+ do {
+ jp = getjob(*argv, 1);
+ if (mode == FORK_BG) {
+ set_curjob(jp, CUR_RUNNING);
+ outfmt(out, "[%d] ", jobno(jp));
+ }
+ outstr(jp->ps->cmd, out);
+ showpipe(jp, out);
+ retval = restartjob(jp, mode);
+ } while (*argv && *++argv);
+ return retval;
+}
+
+int bgcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+#ifdef HAVE_ALIAS_ATTRIBUTE
+ __attribute__((__alias__("fgcmd")));
+#else
+{
+ return fgcmd(argc, argv);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+STATIC int
+restartjob(struct job *jp, int mode)
+{
+ struct procstat *ps;
+ int i;
+ int status;
+ pid_t pgid;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if (jp->state == JOBDONE)
+ goto out;
+ jp->state = JOBRUNNING;
+ pgid = jp->ps->pid;
+ if (mode == FORK_FG)
+ xtcsetpgrp(ttyfd, pgid);
+ killpg(pgid, SIGCONT);
+ ps = jp->ps;
+ i = jp->nprocs;
+ do {
+ if (WIFSTOPPED(ps->status)) {
+ ps->status = -1;
+ }
+ } while (ps++, --i);
+out:
+ status = (mode == FORK_FG) ? waitforjob(jp) : 0;
+ INTON;
+ return status;
+}
+#endif
+
+STATIC int
+sprint_status(char *s, int status, int sigonly)
+{
+ int col;
+ int st;
+
+ col = 0;
+ st = WEXITSTATUS(status);
+ if (!WIFEXITED(status)) {
+#if JOBS
+ st = WSTOPSIG(status);
+ if (!WIFSTOPPED(status))
+#endif
+ st = WTERMSIG(status);
+ if (sigonly) {
+ if (st == SIGINT || st == SIGPIPE)
+ goto out;
+#if JOBS
+ if (WIFSTOPPED(status))
+ goto out;
+#endif
+ }
+ col = fmtstr(s, 32, "%s", strsignal(st));
+#ifdef WCOREDUMP
+ if (WCOREDUMP(status)) {
+ col += fmtstr(s + col, 16, " (core dumped)");
+ }
+#endif
+ } else if (!sigonly) {
+ if (st)
+ col = fmtstr(s, 16, "Done(%d)", st);
+ else
+ col = fmtstr(s, 16, "Done");
+ }
+
+out:
+ return col;
+}
+
+static void
+showjob(struct output *out, struct job *jp, int mode)
+{
+ struct procstat *ps;
+ struct procstat *psend;
+ int col;
+ int indent;
+ char s[80];
+
+ ps = jp->ps;
+
+ if (mode & SHOW_PGID) {
+ /* just output process (group) id of pipeline */
+ outfmt(out, "%d\n", ps->pid);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ col = fmtstr(s, 16, "[%d] ", jobno(jp));
+ indent = col;
+
+ if (jp == curjob)
+ s[col - 2] = '+';
+ else if (curjob && jp == curjob->prev_job)
+ s[col - 2] = '-';
+
+ if (mode & SHOW_PID)
+ col += fmtstr(s + col, 16, "%d ", ps->pid);
+
+ psend = ps + jp->nprocs;
+
+ if (jp->state == JOBRUNNING) {
+ scopy("Running", s + col);
+ col += strlen("Running");
+ } else {
+ int status = psend[-1].status;
+#if JOBS
+ if (jp->state == JOBSTOPPED)
+ status = jp->stopstatus;
+#endif
+ col += sprint_status(s + col, status, 0);
+ }
+
+ goto start;
+
+ do {
+ /* for each process */
+ col = fmtstr(s, 48, " |\n%*c%d ", indent, ' ', ps->pid) - 3;
+
+start:
+ outfmt(
+ out, "%s%*c%s",
+ s, 33 - col >= 0 ? 33 - col : 0, ' ', ps->cmd
+ );
+ if (!(mode & SHOW_PID)) {
+ showpipe(jp, out);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (++ps == psend) {
+ outcslow('\n', out);
+ break;
+ }
+ } while (1);
+
+ jp->changed = 0;
+
+ if (jp->state == JOBDONE) {
+ TRACE(("showjob: freeing job %d\n", jobno(jp)));
+ freejob(jp);
+ }
+}
+
+
+int
+jobscmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int mode, m;
+ struct output *out;
+
+ mode = 0;
+ while ((m = nextopt("lp")))
+ if (m == 'l')
+ mode = SHOW_PID;
+ else
+ mode = SHOW_PGID;
+
+ out = out1;
+ argv = argptr;
+ if (*argv)
+ do
+ showjob(out, getjob(*argv,0), mode);
+ while (*++argv);
+ else
+ showjobs(out, mode);
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Print a list of jobs. If "change" is nonzero, only print jobs whose
+ * statuses have changed since the last call to showjobs.
+ */
+
+void
+showjobs(struct output *out, int mode)
+{
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ TRACE(("showjobs(%x) called\n", mode));
+
+ /* If not even one one job changed, there is nothing to do */
+ while (dowait(DOWAIT_NORMAL, NULL) > 0)
+ continue;
+
+ for (jp = curjob; jp; jp = jp->prev_job) {
+ if (!(mode & SHOW_CHANGED) || jp->changed)
+ showjob(out, jp, mode);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Mark a job structure as unused.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+freejob(struct job *jp)
+{
+ struct procstat *ps;
+ int i;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (i = jp->nprocs, ps = jp->ps ; --i >= 0 ; ps++) {
+ if (ps->cmd != nullstr)
+ ckfree(ps->cmd);
+ }
+ if (jp->ps != &jp->ps0)
+ ckfree(jp->ps);
+ jp->used = 0;
+ set_curjob(jp, CUR_DELETE);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+int
+waitcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ struct job *job;
+ int retval;
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ nextopt(nullstr);
+ retval = 0;
+
+ argv = argptr;
+ if (!*argv) {
+ /* wait for all jobs */
+ for (;;) {
+ jp = curjob;
+ while (1) {
+ if (!jp) {
+ /* no running procs */
+ goto out;
+ }
+ if (jp->state == JOBRUNNING)
+ break;
+ jp->waited = 1;
+ jp = jp->prev_job;
+ }
+ if (dowait(DOWAIT_WAITCMD, 0) <= 0)
+ goto sigout;
+ }
+ }
+
+ retval = 127;
+ do {
+ if (**argv != '%') {
+ pid_t pid = number(*argv);
+ job = curjob;
+ goto start;
+ do {
+ if (job->ps[job->nprocs - 1].pid == pid)
+ break;
+ job = job->prev_job;
+start:
+ if (!job)
+ goto repeat;
+ } while (1);
+ } else
+ job = getjob(*argv, 0);
+ /* loop until process terminated or stopped */
+ while (job->state == JOBRUNNING)
+ if (dowait(DOWAIT_WAITCMD, 0) <= 0)
+ goto sigout;
+ job->waited = 1;
+ retval = getstatus(job);
+repeat:
+ ;
+ } while (*++argv);
+
+out:
+ return retval;
+
+sigout:
+ retval = 128 + pendingsigs;
+ goto out;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Convert a job name to a job structure.
+ */
+
+STATIC struct job *
+getjob(const char *name, int getctl)
+{
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct job *found;
+ const char *err_msg = "No such job: %s";
+ unsigned num;
+ int c;
+ const char *p;
+ char *(*match)(const char *, const char *);
+
+ jp = curjob;
+ p = name;
+ if (!p)
+ goto currentjob;
+
+ if (*p != '%')
+ goto err;
+
+ c = *++p;
+ if (!c)
+ goto currentjob;
+
+ if (!p[1]) {
+ if (c == '+' || c == '%') {
+currentjob:
+ err_msg = "No current job";
+ goto check;
+ } else if (c == '-') {
+ if (jp)
+ jp = jp->prev_job;
+ err_msg = "No previous job";
+check:
+ if (!jp)
+ goto err;
+ goto gotit;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (is_number(p)) {
+ num = atoi(p);
+ if (num < njobs) {
+ jp = jobtab + num - 1;
+ if (jp->used)
+ goto gotit;
+ goto err;
+ }
+ }
+
+ match = prefix;
+ if (*p == '?') {
+ match = strstr;
+ p++;
+ }
+
+ found = 0;
+ while (1) {
+ if (!jp)
+ goto err;
+ if (match(jp->ps[0].cmd, p)) {
+ if (found)
+ goto err;
+ found = jp;
+ err_msg = "%s: ambiguous";
+ }
+ jp = jp->prev_job;
+ }
+
+gotit:
+#if JOBS
+ err_msg = "job %s not created under job control";
+ if (getctl && jp->jobctl == 0)
+ goto err;
+#endif
+ return jp;
+err:
+ sh_error(err_msg, name);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Return a new job structure.
+ * Called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+struct job *
+makejob(union node *node, int nprocs)
+{
+ int i;
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ for (i = njobs, jp = jobtab ; ; jp++) {
+ if (--i < 0) {
+ jp = growjobtab();
+ break;
+ }
+ if (jp->used == 0)
+ break;
+ if (jp->state != JOBDONE || !jp->waited)
+ continue;
+ if (jobctl)
+ continue;
+ freejob(jp);
+ break;
+ }
+ memset(jp, 0, sizeof(*jp));
+#if JOBS
+ if (jobctl)
+ jp->jobctl = 1;
+#endif
+ jp->prev_job = curjob;
+ curjob = jp;
+ jp->used = 1;
+ jp->ps = &jp->ps0;
+ if (nprocs > 1) {
+ jp->ps = ckmalloc(nprocs * sizeof (struct procstat));
+ }
+ TRACE(("makejob(0x%lx, %d) returns %%%d\n", (long)node, nprocs,
+ jobno(jp)));
+ return jp;
+}
+
+STATIC struct job *
+growjobtab(void)
+{
+ size_t len;
+ ptrdiff_t offset;
+ struct job *jp, *jq;
+
+ len = njobs * sizeof(*jp);
+ jq = jobtab;
+ jp = ckrealloc(jq, len + 4 * sizeof(*jp));
+
+ offset = (char *)jp - (char *)jq;
+ if (offset) {
+ /* Relocate pointers */
+ size_t l = len;
+
+ jq = (struct job *)((char *)jq + l);
+ while (l) {
+ l -= sizeof(*jp);
+ jq--;
+#define joff(p) ((struct job *)((char *)(p) + l))
+#define jmove(p) (p) = (void *)((char *)(p) + offset)
+ if (likely(joff(jp)->ps == &jq->ps0))
+ jmove(joff(jp)->ps);
+ if (joff(jp)->prev_job)
+ jmove(joff(jp)->prev_job);
+ }
+ if (curjob)
+ jmove(curjob);
+#undef joff
+#undef jmove
+ }
+
+ njobs += 4;
+ jobtab = jp;
+ jp = (struct job *)((char *)jp + len);
+ jq = jp + 3;
+ do {
+ jq->used = 0;
+ } while (--jq >= jp);
+ return jp;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Fork off a subshell. If we are doing job control, give the subshell its
+ * own process group. Jp is a job structure that the job is to be added to.
+ * N is the command that will be evaluated by the child. Both jp and n may
+ * be NULL. The mode parameter can be one of the following:
+ * FORK_FG - Fork off a foreground process.
+ * FORK_BG - Fork off a background process.
+ * FORK_NOJOB - Like FORK_FG, but don't give the process its own
+ * process group even if job control is on.
+ *
+ * When job control is turned off, background processes have their standard
+ * input redirected to /dev/null (except for the second and later processes
+ * in a pipeline).
+ *
+ * Called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+STATIC inline void
+forkchild(struct job *jp, union node *n, int mode)
+{
+ int oldlvl;
+
+ TRACE(("Child shell %d\n", getpid()));
+ oldlvl = shlvl;
+ shlvl++;
+
+ closescript();
+ clear_traps();
+#if JOBS
+ /* do job control only in root shell */
+ jobctl = 0;
+ if (mode != FORK_NOJOB && jp->jobctl && !oldlvl) {
+ pid_t pgrp;
+
+ if (jp->nprocs == 0)
+ pgrp = getpid();
+ else
+ pgrp = jp->ps[0].pid;
+ /* This can fail because we are doing it in the parent also */
+ (void)setpgid(0, pgrp);
+ if (mode == FORK_FG)
+ xtcsetpgrp(ttyfd, pgrp);
+ setsignal(SIGTSTP);
+ setsignal(SIGTTOU);
+ } else
+#endif
+ if (mode == FORK_BG) {
+ ignoresig(SIGINT);
+ ignoresig(SIGQUIT);
+ if (jp->nprocs == 0) {
+ close(0);
+ if (open(_PATH_DEVNULL, O_RDONLY) != 0)
+ sh_error("Can't open %s", _PATH_DEVNULL);
+ }
+ }
+ if (!oldlvl && iflag) {
+ setsignal(SIGINT);
+ setsignal(SIGQUIT);
+ setsignal(SIGTERM);
+ }
+ for (jp = curjob; jp; jp = jp->prev_job)
+ freejob(jp);
+ jobless = 0;
+}
+
+STATIC inline void
+forkparent(struct job *jp, union node *n, int mode, pid_t pid)
+{
+ TRACE(("In parent shell: child = %d\n", pid));
+ if (!jp) {
+ while (jobless && dowait(DOWAIT_NORMAL, 0) > 0);
+ jobless++;
+ return;
+ }
+#if JOBS
+ if (mode != FORK_NOJOB && jp->jobctl) {
+ int pgrp;
+
+ if (jp->nprocs == 0)
+ pgrp = pid;
+ else
+ pgrp = jp->ps[0].pid;
+ /* This can fail because we are doing it in the child also */
+ (void)setpgid(pid, pgrp);
+ }
+#endif
+ if (mode == FORK_BG) {
+ backgndpid = pid; /* set $! */
+ set_curjob(jp, CUR_RUNNING);
+ }
+ if (jp) {
+ struct procstat *ps = &jp->ps[jp->nprocs++];
+ ps->pid = pid;
+ ps->status = -1;
+ ps->cmd = nullstr;
+ if (jobctl && n)
+ ps->cmd = commandtext(n);
+ }
+}
+
+int
+forkshell(struct job *jp, union node *n, int mode)
+{
+ int pid;
+
+ TRACE(("forkshell(%%%d, %p, %d) called\n", jobno(jp), n, mode));
+ pid = fork();
+ if (pid < 0) {
+ TRACE(("Fork failed, errno=%d", errno));
+ if (jp)
+ freejob(jp);
+ sh_error("Cannot fork");
+ }
+ if (pid == 0)
+ forkchild(jp, n, mode);
+ else
+ forkparent(jp, n, mode, pid);
+ return pid;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Wait for job to finish.
+ *
+ * Under job control we have the problem that while a child process is
+ * running interrupts generated by the user are sent to the child but not
+ * to the shell. This means that an infinite loop started by an inter-
+ * active user may be hard to kill. With job control turned off, an
+ * interactive user may place an interactive program inside a loop. If
+ * the interactive program catches interrupts, the user doesn't want
+ * these interrupts to also abort the loop. The approach we take here
+ * is to have the shell ignore interrupt signals while waiting for a
+ * forground process to terminate, and then send itself an interrupt
+ * signal if the child process was terminated by an interrupt signal.
+ * Unfortunately, some programs want to do a bit of cleanup and then
+ * exit on interrupt; unless these processes terminate themselves by
+ * sending a signal to themselves (instead of calling exit) they will
+ * confuse this approach.
+ *
+ * Called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+int
+waitforjob(struct job *jp)
+{
+ int st;
+
+ TRACE(("waitforjob(%%%d) called\n", jobno(jp)));
+ while (jp->state == JOBRUNNING) {
+ dowait(DOWAIT_BLOCK, jp);
+ }
+ st = getstatus(jp);
+#if JOBS
+ if (jp->jobctl) {
+ xtcsetpgrp(ttyfd, rootpid);
+ /*
+ * This is truly gross.
+ * If we're doing job control, then we did a TIOCSPGRP which
+ * caused us (the shell) to no longer be in the controlling
+ * session -- so we wouldn't have seen any ^C/SIGINT. So, we
+ * intuit from the subprocess exit status whether a SIGINT
+ * occurred, and if so interrupt ourselves. Yuck. - mycroft
+ */
+ if (jp->sigint)
+ raise(SIGINT);
+ }
+#endif
+ if (! JOBS || jp->state == JOBDONE)
+ freejob(jp);
+ return st;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Wait for a process to terminate.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+dowait(int block, struct job *job)
+{
+ int pid;
+ int status;
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct job *thisjob = NULL;
+ int state;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ TRACE(("dowait(%d) called\n", block));
+ pid = waitproc(block, &status);
+ TRACE(("wait returns pid %d, status=%d\n", pid, status));
+ if (pid <= 0)
+ goto out;
+
+ for (jp = curjob; jp; jp = jp->prev_job) {
+ struct procstat *sp;
+ struct procstat *spend;
+ if (jp->state == JOBDONE)
+ continue;
+ state = JOBDONE;
+ spend = jp->ps + jp->nprocs;
+ sp = jp->ps;
+ do {
+ if (sp->pid == pid) {
+ TRACE(("Job %d: changing status of proc %d from 0x%x to 0x%x\n", jobno(jp), pid, sp->status, status));
+ sp->status = status;
+ thisjob = jp;
+ }
+ if (sp->status == -1)
+ state = JOBRUNNING;
+#if JOBS
+ if (state == JOBRUNNING)
+ continue;
+ if (WIFSTOPPED(sp->status)) {
+ jp->stopstatus = sp->status;
+ state = JOBSTOPPED;
+ }
+#endif
+ } while (++sp < spend);
+ if (thisjob)
+ goto gotjob;
+ }
+ if (!JOBS || !WIFSTOPPED(status))
+ jobless--;
+ goto out;
+
+gotjob:
+ if (state != JOBRUNNING) {
+ thisjob->changed = 1;
+
+ if (thisjob->state != state) {
+ TRACE(("Job %d: changing state from %d to %d\n", jobno(thisjob), thisjob->state, state));
+ thisjob->state = state;
+#if JOBS
+ if (state == JOBSTOPPED) {
+ set_curjob(thisjob, CUR_STOPPED);
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+
+out:
+ INTON;
+
+ if (thisjob && thisjob == job) {
+ char s[48 + 1];
+ int len;
+
+ len = sprint_status(s, status, 1);
+ if (len) {
+ s[len] = '\n';
+ s[len + 1] = 0;
+ outstr(s, out2);
+ }
+ }
+ return pid;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Do a wait system call. If job control is compiled in, we accept
+ * stopped processes. If block is zero, we return a value of zero
+ * rather than blocking.
+ *
+ * System V doesn't have a non-blocking wait system call. It does
+ * have a SIGCLD signal that is sent to a process when one of it's
+ * children dies. The obvious way to use SIGCLD would be to install
+ * a handler for SIGCLD which simply bumped a counter when a SIGCLD
+ * was received, and have waitproc bump another counter when it got
+ * the status of a process. Waitproc would then know that a wait
+ * system call would not block if the two counters were different.
+ * This approach doesn't work because if a process has children that
+ * have not been waited for, System V will send it a SIGCLD when it
+ * installs a signal handler for SIGCLD. What this means is that when
+ * a child exits, the shell will be sent SIGCLD signals continuously
+ * until is runs out of stack space, unless it does a wait call before
+ * restoring the signal handler. The code below takes advantage of
+ * this (mis)feature by installing a signal handler for SIGCLD and
+ * then checking to see whether it was called. If there are any
+ * children to be waited for, it will be.
+ *
+ * If neither SYSV nor BSD is defined, we don't implement nonblocking
+ * waits at all. In this case, the user will not be informed when
+ * a background process until the next time she runs a real program
+ * (as opposed to running a builtin command or just typing return),
+ * and the jobs command may give out of date information.
+ */
+
+#ifdef SYSV
+STATIC int gotsigchild;
+
+STATIC int onsigchild() {
+ gotsigchild = 1;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+STATIC int
+waitproc(int block, int *status)
+{
+ sigset_t mask, oldmask;
+ int flags = block == DOWAIT_BLOCK ? 0 : WNOHANG;
+ int err;
+
+#if JOBS
+ if (jobctl)
+ flags |= WUNTRACED;
+#endif
+
+ do {
+ gotsigchld = 0;
+ err = wait3(status, flags, NULL);
+ if (err || !block)
+ break;
+
+ block = 0;
+
+ sigfillset(&mask);
+ sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &mask, &oldmask);
+
+ while (!gotsigchld && !pendingsigs)
+ sigsuspend(&oldmask);
+
+ sigclearmask();
+ } while (gotsigchld);
+
+ return err;
+}
+
+/*
+ * return 1 if there are stopped jobs, otherwise 0
+ */
+int job_warning;
+int
+stoppedjobs(void)
+{
+ struct job *jp;
+ int retval;
+
+ retval = 0;
+ if (job_warning)
+ goto out;
+ jp = curjob;
+ if (jp && jp->state == JOBSTOPPED) {
+ out2str("You have stopped jobs.\n");
+ job_warning = 2;
+ retval++;
+ }
+
+out:
+ return retval;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Return a string identifying a command (to be printed by the
+ * jobs command).
+ */
+
+STATIC char *cmdnextc;
+
+STATIC char *
+commandtext(union node *n)
+{
+ char *name;
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(cmdnextc);
+ cmdtxt(n);
+ name = stackblock();
+ TRACE(("commandtext: name %p, end %p\n", name, cmdnextc));
+ return savestr(name);
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+cmdtxt(union node *n)
+{
+ union node *np;
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ const char *p;
+ char s[2];
+
+ if (!n)
+ return;
+ switch (n->type) {
+ default:
+#if DEBUG
+ abort();
+#endif
+ case NPIPE:
+ lp = n->npipe.cmdlist;
+ for (;;) {
+ cmdtxt(lp->n);
+ lp = lp->next;
+ if (!lp)
+ break;
+ cmdputs(" | ");
+ }
+ break;
+ case NSEMI:
+ p = "; ";
+ goto binop;
+ case NAND:
+ p = " && ";
+ goto binop;
+ case NOR:
+ p = " || ";
+binop:
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch1);
+ cmdputs(p);
+ n = n->nbinary.ch2;
+ goto donode;
+ case NREDIR:
+ case NBACKGND:
+ n = n->nredir.n;
+ goto donode;
+ case NNOT:
+ cmdputs("!");
+ n = n->nnot.com;
+donode:
+ cmdtxt(n);
+ break;
+ case NIF:
+ cmdputs("if ");
+ cmdtxt(n->nif.test);
+ cmdputs("; then ");
+ if (n->nif.elsepart) {
+ cmdtxt(n->nif.ifpart);
+ cmdputs("; else ");
+ n = n->nif.elsepart;
+ } else {
+ n = n->nif.ifpart;
+ }
+ p = "; fi";
+ goto dotail;
+ case NSUBSHELL:
+ cmdputs("(");
+ n = n->nredir.n;
+ p = ")";
+ goto dotail;
+ case NWHILE:
+ p = "while ";
+ goto until;
+ case NUNTIL:
+ p = "until ";
+until:
+ cmdputs(p);
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch1);
+ n = n->nbinary.ch2;
+ p = "; done";
+dodo:
+ cmdputs("; do ");
+dotail:
+ cmdtxt(n);
+ goto dotail2;
+ case NFOR:
+ cmdputs("for ");
+ cmdputs(n->nfor.var);
+ cmdputs(" in ");
+ cmdlist(n->nfor.args, 1);
+ n = n->nfor.body;
+ p = "; done";
+ goto dodo;
+ case NDEFUN:
+ cmdputs(n->ndefun.text);
+ p = "() { ... }";
+ goto dotail2;
+ case NCMD:
+ cmdlist(n->ncmd.args, 1);
+ cmdlist(n->ncmd.redirect, 0);
+ break;
+ case NARG:
+ p = n->narg.text;
+dotail2:
+ cmdputs(p);
+ break;
+ case NHERE:
+ case NXHERE:
+ p = "<<...";
+ goto dotail2;
+ case NCASE:
+ cmdputs("case ");
+ cmdputs(n->ncase.expr->narg.text);
+ cmdputs(" in ");
+ for (np = n->ncase.cases; np; np = np->nclist.next) {
+ cmdtxt(np->nclist.pattern);
+ cmdputs(") ");
+ cmdtxt(np->nclist.body);
+ cmdputs(";; ");
+ }
+ p = "esac";
+ goto dotail2;
+ case NTO:
+ p = ">";
+ goto redir;
+ case NCLOBBER:
+ p = ">|";
+ goto redir;
+ case NAPPEND:
+ p = ">>";
+ goto redir;
+ case NTOFD:
+ p = ">&";
+ goto redir;
+ case NFROM:
+ p = "<";
+ goto redir;
+ case NFROMFD:
+ p = "<&";
+ goto redir;
+ case NFROMTO:
+ p = "<>";
+redir:
+ s[0] = n->nfile.fd + '0';
+ s[1] = '\0';
+ cmdputs(s);
+ cmdputs(p);
+ if (n->type == NTOFD || n->type == NFROMFD) {
+ s[0] = n->ndup.dupfd + '0';
+ p = s;
+ goto dotail2;
+ } else {
+ n = n->nfile.fname;
+ goto donode;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC void
+cmdlist(union node *np, int sep)
+{
+ for (; np; np = np->narg.next) {
+ if (!sep)
+ cmdputs(spcstr);
+ cmdtxt(np);
+ if (sep && np->narg.next)
+ cmdputs(spcstr);
+ }
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+cmdputs(const char *s)
+{
+ const char *p, *str;
+ char cc[2] = " ";
+ char *nextc;
+ signed char c;
+ int subtype = 0;
+ int quoted = 0;
+ static const char vstype[VSTYPE + 1][4] = {
+ "", "}", "-", "+", "?", "=",
+ "%", "%%", "#", "##",
+ };
+
+ nextc = makestrspace((strlen(s) + 1) * 8, cmdnextc);
+ p = s;
+ while ((c = *p++) != 0) {
+ str = 0;
+ switch (c) {
+ case CTLESC:
+ c = *p++;
+ break;
+ case CTLVAR:
+ subtype = *p++;
+ if ((subtype & VSTYPE) == VSLENGTH)
+ str = "${#";
+ else
+ str = "${";
+ goto dostr;
+ case CTLENDVAR:
+ str = "\"}";
+ str += !(quoted & 1);
+ quoted >>= 1;
+ subtype = 0;
+ goto dostr;
+ case CTLBACKQ:
+ str = "$(...)";
+ goto dostr;
+ case CTLARI:
+ str = "$((";
+ goto dostr;
+ case CTLENDARI:
+ str = "))";
+ goto dostr;
+ case CTLQUOTEMARK:
+ quoted ^= 1;
+ c = '"';
+ break;
+ case '=':
+ if (subtype == 0)
+ break;
+ if ((subtype & VSTYPE) != VSNORMAL)
+ quoted <<= 1;
+ str = vstype[subtype & VSTYPE];
+ if (subtype & VSNUL)
+ c = ':';
+ else
+ goto checkstr;
+ break;
+ case '\'':
+ case '\\':
+ case '"':
+ case '$':
+ /* These can only happen inside quotes */
+ cc[0] = c;
+ str = cc;
+ c = '\\';
+ break;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ USTPUTC(c, nextc);
+checkstr:
+ if (!str)
+ continue;
+dostr:
+ while ((c = *str++)) {
+ USTPUTC(c, nextc);
+ }
+ }
+ if (quoted & 1) {
+ USTPUTC('"', nextc);
+ }
+ *nextc = 0;
+ cmdnextc = nextc;
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+showpipe(struct job *jp, struct output *out)
+{
+ struct procstat *sp;
+ struct procstat *spend;
+
+ spend = jp->ps + jp->nprocs;
+ for (sp = jp->ps + 1; sp < spend; sp++)
+ outfmt(out, " | %s", sp->cmd);
+ outcslow('\n', out);
+ flushall();
+}
+
+
+#if JOBS
+STATIC void
+xtcsetpgrp(int fd, pid_t pgrp)
+{
+ if (tcsetpgrp(fd, pgrp))
+ sh_error("Cannot set tty process group (%s)", strerror(errno));
+}
+#endif
+
+
+STATIC int
+getstatus(struct job *job) {
+ int status;
+ int retval;
+
+ status = job->ps[job->nprocs - 1].status;
+ retval = WEXITSTATUS(status);
+ if (!WIFEXITED(status)) {
+#if JOBS
+ retval = WSTOPSIG(status);
+ if (!WIFSTOPPED(status))
+#endif
+ {
+ /* XXX: limits number of signals */
+ retval = WTERMSIG(status);
+#if JOBS
+ if (retval == SIGINT)
+ job->sigint = 1;
+#endif
+ }
+ retval += 128;
+ }
+ TRACE(("getstatus: job %d, nproc %d, status %x, retval %x\n",
+ jobno(job), job->nprocs, status, retval));
+ return retval;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/jobs.h b/usr/dash/jobs.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..953ee87
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/jobs.h
@@ -0,0 +1,109 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)jobs.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+/* Mode argument to forkshell. Don't change FORK_FG or FORK_BG. */
+#define FORK_FG 0
+#define FORK_BG 1
+#define FORK_NOJOB 2
+
+/* mode flags for showjob(s) */
+#define SHOW_PGID 0x01 /* only show pgid - for jobs -p */
+#define SHOW_PID 0x04 /* include process pid */
+#define SHOW_CHANGED 0x08 /* only jobs whose state has changed */
+
+
+/*
+ * A job structure contains information about a job. A job is either a
+ * single process or a set of processes contained in a pipeline. In the
+ * latter case, pidlist will be non-NULL, and will point to a -1 terminated
+ * array of pids.
+ */
+
+struct procstat {
+ pid_t pid; /* process id */
+ int status; /* last process status from wait() */
+ char *cmd; /* text of command being run */
+};
+
+struct job {
+ struct procstat ps0; /* status of process */
+ struct procstat *ps; /* status or processes when more than one */
+#if JOBS
+ int stopstatus; /* status of a stopped job */
+#endif
+ uint32_t
+ nprocs: 16, /* number of processes */
+ state: 8,
+#define JOBRUNNING 0 /* at least one proc running */
+#define JOBSTOPPED 1 /* all procs are stopped */
+#define JOBDONE 2 /* all procs are completed */
+#if JOBS
+ sigint: 1, /* job was killed by SIGINT */
+ jobctl: 1, /* job running under job control */
+#endif
+ waited: 1, /* true if this entry has been waited for */
+ used: 1, /* true if this entry is in used */
+ changed: 1; /* true if status has changed */
+ struct job *prev_job; /* previous job */
+};
+
+extern pid_t backgndpid; /* pid of last background process */
+extern int job_warning; /* user was warned about stopped jobs */
+#if JOBS
+extern int jobctl; /* true if doing job control */
+#else
+#define jobctl 0
+#endif
+
+void setjobctl(int);
+int killcmd(int, char **);
+int fgcmd(int, char **);
+int bgcmd(int, char **);
+int jobscmd(int, char **);
+struct output;
+void showjobs(struct output *, int);
+int waitcmd(int, char **);
+struct job *makejob(union node *, int);
+int forkshell(struct job *, union node *, int);
+int waitforjob(struct job *);
+int stoppedjobs(void);
+
+#if ! JOBS
+#define setjobctl(on) ((void)(on)) /* do nothing */
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/machdep.h b/usr/dash/machdep.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b1ca07a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/machdep.h
@@ -0,0 +1,53 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)machdep.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include "config.h"
+
+/*
+ * Most machines require the value returned from malloc to be aligned
+ * in some way. The following macro will get this right on many machines.
+ */
+#ifdef HAVE_STRTOD
+# define SHELL_SIZE (sizeof(union {int i; char *cp; double d; }) - 1)
+#else
+# define SHELL_SIZE (sizeof(union {int i; char *cp;}) - 1)
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * It appears that grabstackstr() will barf with such alignments
+ * because stalloc() will return a string allocated in a new stackblock.
+ */
+#define SHELL_ALIGN(nbytes) (((nbytes) + SHELL_SIZE) & ~SHELL_SIZE)
diff --git a/usr/dash/mail.c b/usr/dash/mail.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..02e07f7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mail.c
@@ -0,0 +1,112 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Routines to check for mail. (Perhaps make part of main.c?)
+ */
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "exec.h" /* defines padvance() */
+#include "var.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mail.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+
+#define MAXMBOXES 10
+
+/* times of mailboxes */
+static time_t mailtime[MAXMBOXES];
+/* Set if MAIL or MAILPATH is changed. */
+static int changed;
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Print appropriate message(s) if mail has arrived. If changed is set,
+ * then the value of MAIL has changed, so we just update the values.
+ */
+
+void
+chkmail(void)
+{
+ const char *mpath;
+ char *p;
+ char *q;
+ time_t *mtp;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ struct stat64 statb;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ mpath = mpathset() ? mpathval() : mailval();
+ for (mtp = mailtime; mtp < mailtime + MAXMBOXES; mtp++) {
+ p = padvance(&mpath, nullstr);
+ if (p == NULL)
+ break;
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ continue;
+ for (q = p ; *q ; q++);
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (q[-1] != '/')
+ abort();
+#endif
+ q[-1] = '\0'; /* delete trailing '/' */
+ if (stat64(p, &statb) < 0) {
+ *mtp = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (!changed && statb.st_mtime != *mtp) {
+ outfmt(
+ &errout, snlfmt,
+ pathopt ? pathopt : "you have mail"
+ );
+ }
+ *mtp = statb.st_mtime;
+ }
+ changed = 0;
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+
+void
+changemail(const char *val)
+{
+ changed++;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/mail.h b/usr/dash/mail.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3c6b21d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mail.h
@@ -0,0 +1,38 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)mail.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+void chkmail(void);
+void changemail(const char *);
diff --git a/usr/dash/main.c b/usr/dash/main.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7df3c44
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/main.c
@@ -0,0 +1,346 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "mail.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "init.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "cd.h"
+
+#ifdef HETIO
+#include "hetio.h"
+#endif
+
+#define PROFILE 0
+
+int rootpid;
+int shlvl;
+#ifdef __GLIBC__
+int *dash_errno;
+#endif
+#if PROFILE
+short profile_buf[16384];
+extern int etext();
+#endif
+
+STATIC void read_profile(const char *);
+STATIC char *find_dot_file(char *);
+static int cmdloop(int);
+int main(int, char **);
+
+/*
+ * Main routine. We initialize things, parse the arguments, execute
+ * profiles if we're a login shell, and then call cmdloop to execute
+ * commands. The setjmp call sets up the location to jump to when an
+ * exception occurs. When an exception occurs the variable "state"
+ * is used to figure out how far we had gotten.
+ */
+
+int
+main(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char *shinit;
+ volatile int state;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ int login;
+
+#ifdef __GLIBC__
+ dash_errno = __errno_location();
+#endif
+
+#if PROFILE
+ monitor(4, etext, profile_buf, sizeof profile_buf, 50);
+#endif
+ state = 0;
+ if (unlikely(setjmp(jmploc.loc))) {
+ int e;
+ int s;
+
+ reset();
+
+ e = exception;
+
+ s = state;
+ if (e == EXEXIT || s == 0 || iflag == 0 || shlvl)
+ exitshell();
+
+ if (e == EXINT
+#if ATTY
+ && (! attyset() || equal(termval(), "emacs"))
+#endif
+ ) {
+ out2c('\n');
+#ifdef FLUSHERR
+ flushout(out2);
+#endif
+ }
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ FORCEINTON; /* enable interrupts */
+ if (s == 1)
+ goto state1;
+ else if (s == 2)
+ goto state2;
+ else if (s == 3)
+ goto state3;
+ else
+ goto state4;
+ }
+ handler = &jmploc;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ opentrace();
+ trputs("Shell args: "); trargs(argv);
+#endif
+ rootpid = getpid();
+ init();
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ login = procargs(argc, argv);
+ if (login) {
+ state = 1;
+ read_profile("/etc/profile");
+state1:
+ state = 2;
+ read_profile("$HOME/.profile");
+ }
+state2:
+ state = 3;
+ if (
+#ifndef linux
+ getuid() == geteuid() && getgid() == getegid() &&
+#endif
+ iflag
+ ) {
+ if ((shinit = lookupvar("ENV")) != NULL && *shinit != '\0') {
+ read_profile(shinit);
+ }
+ }
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+state3:
+ state = 4;
+ if (minusc)
+ evalstring(minusc, 0);
+
+ if (sflag || minusc == NULL) {
+state4: /* XXX ??? - why isn't this before the "if" statement */
+ cmdloop(1);
+ }
+#if PROFILE
+ monitor(0);
+#endif
+#if GPROF
+ {
+ extern void _mcleanup(void);
+ _mcleanup();
+ }
+#endif
+ exitshell();
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Read and execute commands. "Top" is nonzero for the top level command
+ * loop; it turns on prompting if the shell is interactive.
+ */
+
+static int
+cmdloop(int top)
+{
+ union node *n;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ int inter;
+ int status = 0;
+ int numeof = 0;
+
+ TRACE(("cmdloop(%d) called\n", top));
+#ifdef HETIO
+ if(iflag && top)
+ hetio_init();
+#endif
+ for (;;) {
+ int skip;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ if (jobctl)
+ showjobs(out2, SHOW_CHANGED);
+ inter = 0;
+ if (iflag && top) {
+ inter++;
+ chkmail();
+ }
+ n = parsecmd(inter);
+ /* showtree(n); DEBUG */
+ if (n == NEOF) {
+ if (!top || numeof >= 50)
+ break;
+ if (!stoppedjobs()) {
+ if (!Iflag)
+ break;
+ out2str("\nUse \"exit\" to leave shell.\n");
+ }
+ numeof++;
+ } else if (nflag == 0) {
+ job_warning = (job_warning == 2) ? 1 : 0;
+ numeof = 0;
+ evaltree(n, 0);
+ status = exitstatus;
+ }
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+
+ skip = evalskip;
+ if (skip) {
+ evalskip &= ~SKIPFUNC;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return status;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Read /etc/profile or .profile. Return on error.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+read_profile(const char *name)
+{
+ name = expandstr(name);
+ if (setinputfile(name, INPUT_PUSH_FILE | INPUT_NOFILE_OK) < 0)
+ return;
+
+ cmdloop(0);
+ popfile();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Read a file containing shell functions.
+ */
+
+void
+readcmdfile(char *name)
+{
+ setinputfile(name, INPUT_PUSH_FILE);
+ cmdloop(0);
+ popfile();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Take commands from a file. To be compatible we should do a path
+ * search for the file, which is necessary to find sub-commands.
+ */
+
+
+STATIC char *
+find_dot_file(char *basename)
+{
+ char *fullname;
+ const char *path = pathval();
+ struct stat statb;
+
+ /* don't try this for absolute or relative paths */
+ if (strchr(basename, '/'))
+ return basename;
+
+ while ((fullname = padvance(&path, basename)) != NULL) {
+ if ((stat(fullname, &statb) == 0) && S_ISREG(statb.st_mode)) {
+ /*
+ * Don't bother freeing here, since it will
+ * be freed by the caller.
+ */
+ return fullname;
+ }
+ stunalloc(fullname);
+ }
+
+ /* not found in the PATH */
+ sh_error("%s: not found", basename);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+int
+dotcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int status = 0;
+
+ if (argc >= 2) { /* That's what SVR2 does */
+ char *fullname;
+
+ fullname = find_dot_file(argv[1]);
+ setinputfile(fullname, INPUT_PUSH_FILE);
+ commandname = fullname;
+ status = cmdloop(0);
+ popfile();
+ }
+ return status;
+}
+
+
+int
+exitcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ if (stoppedjobs())
+ return 0;
+ if (argc > 1)
+ exitstatus = number(argv[1]);
+ exraise(EXEXIT);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/main.h b/usr/dash/main.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..19e4983
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/main.h
@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)main.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <errno.h>
+
+/* pid of main shell */
+extern int rootpid;
+/* shell level: 0 for the main shell, 1 for its children, and so on */
+extern int shlvl;
+#define rootshell (!shlvl)
+
+#ifdef __GLIBC__
+/* glibc sucks */
+extern int *dash_errno;
+#undef errno
+#define errno (*dash_errno)
+#endif
+
+void readcmdfile(char *);
+int dotcmd(int, char **);
+int exitcmd(int, char **);
diff --git a/usr/dash/memalloc.c b/usr/dash/memalloc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d8e4413
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/memalloc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,302 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "machdep.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+/*
+ * Like malloc, but returns an error when out of space.
+ */
+
+pointer
+ckmalloc(size_t nbytes)
+{
+ pointer p;
+
+ p = malloc(nbytes);
+ if (p == NULL)
+ sh_error("Out of space");
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Same for realloc.
+ */
+
+pointer
+ckrealloc(pointer p, size_t nbytes)
+{
+ p = realloc(p, nbytes);
+ if (p == NULL)
+ sh_error("Out of space");
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Make a copy of a string in safe storage.
+ */
+
+char *
+savestr(const char *s)
+{
+ char *p = strdup(s);
+ if (!p)
+ sh_error("Out of space");
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse trees for commands are allocated in lifo order, so we use a stack
+ * to make this more efficient, and also to avoid all sorts of exception
+ * handling code to handle interrupts in the middle of a parse.
+ *
+ * The size 504 was chosen because the Ultrix malloc handles that size
+ * well.
+ */
+
+/* minimum size of a block */
+#define MINSIZE SHELL_ALIGN(504)
+
+struct stack_block {
+ struct stack_block *prev;
+ char space[MINSIZE];
+};
+
+struct stack_block stackbase;
+struct stack_block *stackp = &stackbase;
+char *stacknxt = stackbase.space;
+size_t stacknleft = MINSIZE;
+char *sstrend = stackbase.space + MINSIZE;
+
+pointer
+stalloc(size_t nbytes)
+{
+ char *p;
+ size_t aligned;
+
+ aligned = SHELL_ALIGN(nbytes);
+ if (aligned > stacknleft) {
+ size_t len;
+ size_t blocksize;
+ struct stack_block *sp;
+
+ blocksize = aligned;
+ if (blocksize < MINSIZE)
+ blocksize = MINSIZE;
+ len = sizeof(struct stack_block) - MINSIZE + blocksize;
+ if (len < blocksize)
+ sh_error("Out of space");
+ INTOFF;
+ sp = ckmalloc(len);
+ sp->prev = stackp;
+ stacknxt = sp->space;
+ stacknleft = blocksize;
+ sstrend = stacknxt + blocksize;
+ stackp = sp;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ p = stacknxt;
+ stacknxt += aligned;
+ stacknleft -= aligned;
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+void
+stunalloc(pointer p)
+{
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (!p || (stacknxt < (char *)p) || ((char *)p < stackp->space)) {
+ write(2, "stunalloc\n", 10);
+ abort();
+ }
+#endif
+ stacknleft += stacknxt - (char *)p;
+ stacknxt = p;
+}
+
+
+
+void pushstackmark(struct stackmark *mark, size_t len)
+{
+ mark->stackp = stackp;
+ mark->stacknxt = stacknxt;
+ mark->stacknleft = stacknleft;
+ grabstackblock(len);
+}
+
+void setstackmark(struct stackmark *mark)
+{
+ pushstackmark(mark, stacknxt == stackp->space && stackp != &stackbase);
+}
+
+
+void
+popstackmark(struct stackmark *mark)
+{
+ struct stack_block *sp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ while (stackp != mark->stackp) {
+ sp = stackp;
+ stackp = sp->prev;
+ ckfree(sp);
+ }
+ stacknxt = mark->stacknxt;
+ stacknleft = mark->stacknleft;
+ sstrend = mark->stacknxt + mark->stacknleft;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * When the parser reads in a string, it wants to stick the string on the
+ * stack and only adjust the stack pointer when it knows how big the
+ * string is. Stackblock (defined in stack.h) returns a pointer to a block
+ * of space on top of the stack and stackblocklen returns the length of
+ * this block. Growstackblock will grow this space by at least one byte,
+ * possibly moving it (like realloc). Grabstackblock actually allocates the
+ * part of the block that has been used.
+ */
+
+void
+growstackblock(void)
+{
+ size_t newlen;
+
+ newlen = stacknleft * 2;
+ if (newlen < stacknleft)
+ sh_error("Out of space");
+ if (newlen < 128)
+ newlen += 128;
+
+ if (stacknxt == stackp->space && stackp != &stackbase) {
+ struct stack_block *sp;
+ struct stack_block *prevstackp;
+ size_t grosslen;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ sp = stackp;
+ prevstackp = sp->prev;
+ grosslen = newlen + sizeof(struct stack_block) - MINSIZE;
+ sp = ckrealloc((pointer)sp, grosslen);
+ sp->prev = prevstackp;
+ stackp = sp;
+ stacknxt = sp->space;
+ stacknleft = newlen;
+ sstrend = sp->space + newlen;
+ INTON;
+ } else {
+ char *oldspace = stacknxt;
+ int oldlen = stacknleft;
+ char *p = stalloc(newlen);
+
+ /* free the space we just allocated */
+ stacknxt = memcpy(p, oldspace, oldlen);
+ stacknleft += newlen;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * The following routines are somewhat easier to use than the above.
+ * The user declares a variable of type STACKSTR, which may be declared
+ * to be a register. The macro STARTSTACKSTR initializes things. Then
+ * the user uses the macro STPUTC to add characters to the string. In
+ * effect, STPUTC(c, p) is the same as *p++ = c except that the stack is
+ * grown as necessary. When the user is done, she can just leave the
+ * string there and refer to it using stackblock(). Or she can allocate
+ * the space for it using grabstackstr(). If it is necessary to allow
+ * someone else to use the stack temporarily and then continue to grow
+ * the string, the user should use grabstack to allocate the space, and
+ * then call ungrabstr(p) to return to the previous mode of operation.
+ *
+ * USTPUTC is like STPUTC except that it doesn't check for overflow.
+ * CHECKSTACKSPACE can be called before USTPUTC to ensure that there
+ * is space for at least one character.
+ */
+
+void *
+growstackstr(void)
+{
+ size_t len = stackblocksize();
+ growstackblock();
+ return stackblock() + len;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Called from CHECKSTRSPACE.
+ */
+
+char *
+makestrspace(size_t newlen, char *p)
+{
+ size_t len = p - stacknxt;
+ size_t size;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ size_t nleft;
+
+ size = stackblocksize();
+ nleft = size - len;
+ if (nleft >= newlen)
+ break;
+ growstackblock();
+ }
+ return stackblock() + len;
+}
+
+char *
+stnputs(const char *s, size_t n, char *p)
+{
+ p = makestrspace(n, p);
+ p = mempcpy(p, s, n);
+ return p;
+}
+
+char *
+stputs(const char *s, char *p)
+{
+ return stnputs(s, strlen(s), p);
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/memalloc.h b/usr/dash/memalloc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4b5be46
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/memalloc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)memalloc.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+
+struct stackmark {
+ struct stack_block *stackp;
+ char *stacknxt;
+ size_t stacknleft;
+};
+
+
+extern char *stacknxt;
+extern size_t stacknleft;
+extern char *sstrend;
+
+pointer ckmalloc(size_t);
+pointer ckrealloc(pointer, size_t);
+char *savestr(const char *);
+pointer stalloc(size_t);
+void stunalloc(pointer);
+void pushstackmark(struct stackmark *mark, size_t len);
+void setstackmark(struct stackmark *);
+void popstackmark(struct stackmark *);
+void growstackblock(void);
+void *growstackstr(void);
+char *makestrspace(size_t, char *);
+char *stnputs(const char *, size_t, char *);
+char *stputs(const char *, char *);
+
+
+static inline void grabstackblock(size_t len)
+{
+ stalloc(len);
+}
+
+static inline char *_STPUTC(int c, char *p) {
+ if (p == sstrend)
+ p = growstackstr();
+ *p++ = c;
+ return p;
+}
+
+#define stackblock() ((void *)stacknxt)
+#define stackblocksize() stacknleft
+#define STARTSTACKSTR(p) ((p) = stackblock())
+#define STPUTC(c, p) ((p) = _STPUTC((c), (p)))
+#define CHECKSTRSPACE(n, p) \
+ ({ \
+ char *q = (p); \
+ size_t l = (n); \
+ size_t m = sstrend - q; \
+ if (l > m) \
+ (p) = makestrspace(l, q); \
+ 0; \
+ })
+#define USTPUTC(c, p) (*p++ = (c))
+#define STACKSTRNUL(p) ((p) == sstrend? (p = growstackstr(), *p = '\0') : (*p = '\0'))
+#define STUNPUTC(p) (--p)
+#define STTOPC(p) p[-1]
+#define STADJUST(amount, p) (p += (amount))
+
+#define grabstackstr(p) stalloc((char *)(p) - (char *)stackblock())
+#define ungrabstackstr(s, p) stunalloc((s))
+#define stackstrend() ((void *)sstrend)
+
+#define ckfree(p) free((pointer)(p))
diff --git a/usr/dash/miscbltin.c b/usr/dash/miscbltin.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..09282be
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/miscbltin.c
@@ -0,0 +1,583 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Miscelaneous builtins.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/types.h> /* quad_t */
+#include <sys/param.h> /* BSD4_4 */
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <time.h> /* strtotimeval() */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "miscbltin.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+
+#undef rflag
+
+
+/** handle one line of the read command.
+ * more fields than variables -> remainder shall be part of last variable.
+ * less fields than variables -> remaining variables unset.
+ *
+ * @param line complete line of input
+ * @param ap argument (variable) list
+ * @param len length of line including trailing '\0'
+ */
+static void
+readcmd_handle_line(char *s, char **ap)
+{
+ struct arglist arglist;
+ struct strlist *sl;
+ char *backup;
+ char *line;
+
+ /* ifsbreakup will fiddle with stack region... */
+ line = stackblock();
+ s = grabstackstr(s);
+
+ /* need a copy, so that delimiters aren't lost
+ * in case there are more fields than variables */
+ backup = sstrdup(line);
+
+ arglist.lastp = &arglist.list;
+
+ ifsbreakup(s, &arglist);
+ *arglist.lastp = NULL;
+ ifsfree();
+
+ sl = arglist.list;
+
+ do {
+ if (!sl) {
+ /* nullify remaining arguments */
+ do {
+ setvar(*ap, nullstr, 0);
+ } while (*++ap);
+
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* remaining fields present, but no variables left. */
+ if (!ap[1] && sl->next) {
+ size_t offset;
+ char *remainder;
+
+ /* FIXME little bit hacky, assuming that ifsbreakup
+ * will not modify the length of the string */
+ offset = sl->text - s;
+ remainder = backup + offset;
+ rmescapes(remainder);
+ setvar(*ap, remainder, 0);
+
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* set variable to field */
+ rmescapes(sl->text);
+ setvar(*ap, sl->text, 0);
+ sl = sl->next;
+ } while (*++ap);
+}
+
+/*
+ * The read builtin. The -e option causes backslashes to escape the
+ * following character. The -p option followed by an argument prompts
+ * with the argument.
+ *
+ * This uses unbuffered input, which may be avoidable in some cases.
+ */
+
+int
+readcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char **ap;
+ char c;
+ int rflag;
+ char *prompt;
+ char *p;
+ int startloc;
+ int newloc;
+ int status;
+ int timeout;
+ int i;
+ fd_set set;
+ struct timeval ts, t0, t1, to;
+
+ ts.tv_sec = ts.tv_usec = 0;
+
+ rflag = 0;
+ timeout = 0;
+ prompt = NULL;
+ while ((i = nextopt("p:rt:")) != '\0') {
+ switch(i) {
+ case 'p':
+ prompt = optionarg;
+ break;
+ case 't':
+ p = strtotimeval(optionarg, &ts);
+ if (*p || (!ts.tv_sec && !ts.tv_usec))
+ sh_error("invalid timeout");
+ timeout = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ rflag = 1;
+ break;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (prompt && isatty(0)) {
+ out2str(prompt);
+#ifdef FLUSHERR
+ flushall();
+#endif
+ }
+ if (*(ap = argptr) == NULL)
+ sh_error("arg count");
+
+ status = 0;
+ if (timeout) {
+ gettimeofday(&t0, NULL);
+
+ /* ts += t0; */
+ ts.tv_usec += t0.tv_usec;
+ while (ts.tv_usec >= 1000000) {
+ ts.tv_sec++;
+ ts.tv_usec -= 1000000;
+ }
+ ts.tv_sec += t0.tv_sec;
+ }
+ STARTSTACKSTR(p);
+
+ goto start;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ if (timeout) {
+ gettimeofday(&t1, NULL);
+ if (t1.tv_sec > ts.tv_sec ||
+ (t1.tv_sec == ts.tv_sec &&
+ t1.tv_usec >= ts.tv_usec)) {
+ status = 1;
+ break; /* Timeout! */
+ }
+
+ /* to = ts - t1; */
+ if (ts.tv_usec >= t1.tv_usec) {
+ to.tv_usec = ts.tv_usec - t1.tv_usec;
+ to.tv_sec = ts.tv_sec - t1.tv_sec;
+ } else {
+ to.tv_usec = ts.tv_usec - t1.tv_usec + 1000000;
+ to.tv_sec = ts.tv_sec - t1.tv_sec - 1;
+ }
+
+ FD_ZERO(&set);
+ FD_SET(0, &set);
+ if (select(1, &set, NULL, NULL, &to) != 1) {
+ status = 1;
+ break; /* Timeout! */
+ }
+ }
+ switch (read(0, &c, 1)) {
+ case 1:
+ break;
+ default:
+ if (errno == EINTR && !pendingsigs)
+ continue;
+ /* fall through */
+ case 0:
+ status = 1;
+ goto out;
+ }
+ if (c == '\0')
+ continue;
+ if (newloc >= startloc) {
+ if (c == '\n')
+ goto resetbs;
+ goto put;
+ }
+ if (!rflag && c == '\\') {
+ newloc = p - (char *)stackblock();
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (c == '\n')
+ break;
+put:
+ CHECKSTRSPACE(2, p);
+ if (strchr(qchars, c))
+ USTPUTC(CTLESC, p);
+ USTPUTC(c, p);
+
+ if (newloc >= startloc) {
+resetbs:
+ recordregion(startloc, newloc, 0);
+start:
+ startloc = p - (char *)stackblock();
+ newloc = startloc - 1;
+ }
+ }
+out:
+ recordregion(startloc, p - (char *)stackblock(), 0);
+ STACKSTRNUL(p);
+ readcmd_handle_line(p + 1, ap);
+ return status;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * umask builtin
+ *
+ * This code was ripped from pdksh 5.2.14 and hacked for use with
+ * dash by Herbert Xu.
+ *
+ * Public domain.
+ */
+
+int
+umaskcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char *ap;
+ int mask;
+ int i;
+ int symbolic_mode = 0;
+
+ while ((i = nextopt("S")) != '\0') {
+ symbolic_mode = 1;
+ }
+
+ INTOFF;
+ mask = umask(0);
+ umask(mask);
+ INTON;
+
+ if ((ap = *argptr) == NULL) {
+ if (symbolic_mode) {
+ char buf[18];
+ int j;
+
+ mask = ~mask;
+ ap = buf;
+ for (i = 0; i < 3; i++) {
+ *ap++ = "ugo"[i];
+ *ap++ = '=';
+ for (j = 0; j < 3; j++)
+ if (mask & (1 << (8 - (3*i + j))))
+ *ap++ = "rwx"[j];
+ *ap++ = ',';
+ }
+ ap[-1] = '\0';
+ out1fmt("%s\n", buf);
+ } else {
+ out1fmt("%.4o\n", mask);
+ }
+ } else {
+ int new_mask;
+
+ if (isdigit((unsigned char) *ap)) {
+ new_mask = 0;
+ do {
+ if (*ap >= '8' || *ap < '0')
+ sh_error(illnum, *argptr);
+ new_mask = (new_mask << 3) + (*ap - '0');
+ } while (*++ap != '\0');
+ } else {
+ int positions, new_val;
+ char op;
+
+ mask = ~mask;
+ new_mask = mask;
+ positions = 0;
+ while (*ap) {
+ while (*ap && strchr("augo", *ap))
+ switch (*ap++) {
+ case 'a': positions |= 0111; break;
+ case 'u': positions |= 0100; break;
+ case 'g': positions |= 0010; break;
+ case 'o': positions |= 0001; break;
+ }
+ if (!positions)
+ positions = 0111; /* default is a */
+ if (!strchr("=+-", op = *ap))
+ break;
+ ap++;
+ new_val = 0;
+ while (*ap && strchr("rwxugoXs", *ap))
+ switch (*ap++) {
+ case 'r': new_val |= 04; break;
+ case 'w': new_val |= 02; break;
+ case 'x': new_val |= 01; break;
+ case 'u': new_val |= mask >> 6;
+ break;
+ case 'g': new_val |= mask >> 3;
+ break;
+ case 'o': new_val |= mask >> 0;
+ break;
+ case 'X': if (mask & 0111)
+ new_val |= 01;
+ break;
+ case 's': /* ignored */
+ break;
+ }
+ new_val = (new_val & 07) * positions;
+ switch (op) {
+ case '-':
+ new_mask &= ~new_val;
+ break;
+ case '=':
+ new_mask = new_val
+ | (new_mask & ~(positions * 07));
+ break;
+ case '+':
+ new_mask |= new_val;
+ }
+ if (*ap == ',') {
+ positions = 0;
+ ap++;
+ } else if (!strchr("=+-", *ap))
+ break;
+ }
+ if (*ap) {
+ sh_error("Illegal mode: %s", *argptr);
+ return 1;
+ }
+ new_mask = ~new_mask;
+ }
+ umask(new_mask);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#ifdef HAVE_GETRLIMIT
+/*
+ * ulimit builtin
+ *
+ * This code, originally by Doug Gwyn, Doug Kingston, Eric Gisin, and
+ * Michael Rendell was ripped from pdksh 5.0.8 and hacked for use with
+ * ash by J.T. Conklin.
+ *
+ * Public domain.
+ */
+
+struct limits {
+ const char *name;
+ int cmd;
+ int factor; /* multiply by to get rlim_{cur,max} values */
+ char option;
+};
+
+static const struct limits limits[] = {
+#ifdef RLIMIT_CPU
+ { "time(seconds)", RLIMIT_CPU, 1, 't' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_FSIZE
+ { "file(blocks)", RLIMIT_FSIZE, 512, 'f' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_DATA
+ { "data(kbytes)", RLIMIT_DATA, 1024, 'd' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_STACK
+ { "stack(kbytes)", RLIMIT_STACK, 1024, 's' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_CORE
+ { "coredump(blocks)", RLIMIT_CORE, 512, 'c' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_RSS
+ { "memory(kbytes)", RLIMIT_RSS, 1024, 'm' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_MEMLOCK
+ { "locked memory(kbytes)", RLIMIT_MEMLOCK, 1024, 'l' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_NPROC
+ { "process", RLIMIT_NPROC, 1, 'p' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_NOFILE
+ { "nofiles", RLIMIT_NOFILE, 1, 'n' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_AS
+ { "vmemory(kbytes)", RLIMIT_AS, 1024, 'v' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_LOCKS
+ { "locks", RLIMIT_LOCKS, 1, 'w' },
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_RTPRIO
+ { "rtprio", RLIMIT_RTPRIO, 1, 'r' },
+#endif
+ { (char *) 0, 0, 0, '\0' }
+};
+
+enum limtype { SOFT = 0x1, HARD = 0x2 };
+
+static void printlim(enum limtype how, const struct rlimit *limit,
+ const struct limits *l)
+{
+ rlim_t val;
+
+ val = limit->rlim_max;
+ if (how & SOFT)
+ val = limit->rlim_cur;
+
+ if (val == RLIM_INFINITY)
+ out1fmt("unlimited\n");
+ else {
+ val /= l->factor;
+ out1fmt("%" PRIdMAX "\n", (intmax_t) val);
+ }
+}
+
+int
+ulimitcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int c;
+ rlim_t val = 0;
+ enum limtype how = SOFT | HARD;
+ const struct limits *l;
+ int set, all = 0;
+ int optc, what;
+ struct rlimit limit;
+
+ what = 'f';
+ while ((optc = nextopt("HSa"
+#ifdef RLIMIT_CPU
+ "t"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_FSIZE
+ "f"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_DATA
+ "d"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_STACK
+ "s"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_CORE
+ "c"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_RSS
+ "m"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_MEMLOCK
+ "l"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_NPROC
+ "p"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_NOFILE
+ "n"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_AS
+ "v"
+#endif
+#ifdef RLIMIT_LOCKS
+ "w"
+#endif
+ )) != '\0')
+ switch (optc) {
+ case 'H':
+ how = HARD;
+ break;
+ case 'S':
+ how = SOFT;
+ break;
+ case 'a':
+ all = 1;
+ break;
+ default:
+ what = optc;
+ }
+
+ for (l = limits; l->option != what; l++)
+ ;
+
+ set = *argptr ? 1 : 0;
+ if (set) {
+ char *p = *argptr;
+
+ if (all || argptr[1])
+ sh_error("too many arguments");
+ if (strcmp(p, "unlimited") == 0)
+ val = RLIM_INFINITY;
+ else {
+ val = (rlim_t) 0;
+
+ while ((c = *p++) >= '0' && c <= '9')
+ {
+ val = (val * 10) + (long)(c - '0');
+ if (val < (rlim_t) 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c)
+ sh_error("bad number");
+ val *= l->factor;
+ }
+ }
+ if (all) {
+ for (l = limits; l->name; l++) {
+ getrlimit(l->cmd, &limit);
+ out1fmt("%-20s ", l->name);
+ printlim(how, &limit, l);
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ getrlimit(l->cmd, &limit);
+ if (set) {
+ if (how & HARD)
+ limit.rlim_max = val;
+ if (how & SOFT)
+ limit.rlim_cur = val;
+ if (setrlimit(l->cmd, &limit) < 0)
+ sh_error("error setting limit (%s)", strerror(errno));
+ } else {
+ printlim(how, &limit, l);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/miscbltin.h b/usr/dash/miscbltin.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dd9a8d1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/miscbltin.h
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1997 Christos Zoulas. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products
+ * derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
+ * OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
+ * IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
+ * INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
+ * NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
+ * DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
+ * THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
+ * (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
+ * THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+int readcmd(int, char **);
+int umaskcmd(int, char **);
+int ulimitcmd(int, char **);
diff --git a/usr/dash/mkbuiltins b/usr/dash/mkbuiltins
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..94b36b9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mkbuiltins
@@ -0,0 +1,115 @@
+#!/bin/sh -
+# $NetBSD: mkbuiltins,v 1.17 2002/11/24 22:35:41 christos Exp $
+#
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)mkbuiltins 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+tempfile=mktemp
+if ! type tempfile > /dev/null 2>&1 && ! type mktemp > /dev/null 2>&1; then
+ _my_tempfile()
+ {
+ local index=0
+ while test -f "${TMPDIR:-/tmp}/builtin.$$.$index"; do
+ index=`expr $index + 1`
+ done
+
+ touch "${TMPDIR:-/tmp}/builtin.$$.$index"
+ echo "${TMPDIR:-/tmp}/builtin.$$.$index"
+ }
+
+ tempfile="_my_tempfile"
+elif ! type tempfile > /dev/null 2>&1; then
+ tempfile="mktemp ${TMPDIR:-/tmp}/builtin.XXXXXX"
+fi
+
+trap 'rm -f $temp $temp2' EXIT
+temp=$($tempfile)
+temp2=$($tempfile)
+
+builtins=$1
+
+exec > builtins.c
+cat <<\!
+/*
+ * This file was generated by the mkbuiltins program.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "builtins.h"
+
+!
+< $builtins sed '/^#/d; /^$/d' > $temp
+awk '{ printf "int %s(int, char **);\n", $1}' $temp
+echo '
+const struct builtincmd builtincmd[] = {'
+awk '{ for (i = 2 ; i <= NF ; i++) {
+ line = $i "\t" $1
+ if ($i ~ /^-/)
+ line = $(++i) "\t" line
+ print line
+ }}' $temp | LC_ALL=C sort -k 1,1 | tee $temp2 | awk '{
+ opt = ""
+ if (NF > 2) {
+ opt = substr($2, 2)
+ $2 = $3
+ }
+ printf "\t{ \"%s\", %s, %d },\n", $1,
+ (opt ~ /n/) ? "NULL" : $2,
+ (opt ~ /s/) + (opt ~ /[su]/) * 2 + (opt ~ /a/) * 4
+ }'
+echo '};'
+
+exec > builtins.h
+cat <<\!
+/*
+ * This file was generated by the mkbuiltins program.
+ */
+
+!
+sed 's/ -[a-z]*//' $temp2 | nl -b a -v 0 | LC_COLLATE=C sort -u -k 3,3 |
+tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ |
+ awk '{ printf "#define %s (builtincmd + %d)\n", $3, $1}'
+printf '\n#define NUMBUILTINS %d\n' $(wc -l < $temp2)
+echo '
+#define BUILTIN_SPECIAL 0x1
+#define BUILTIN_REGULAR 0x2
+#define BUILTIN_ASSIGN 0x4
+
+struct builtincmd {
+ const char *name;
+ int (*builtin)(int, char **);
+ unsigned flags;
+};
+
+extern const struct builtincmd builtincmd[];'
diff --git a/usr/dash/mkinit.c b/usr/dash/mkinit.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9714bee
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mkinit.c
@@ -0,0 +1,479 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * This program scans all the source files for code to handle various
+ * special events and combines this code into one file. This (allegedly)
+ * improves the structure of the program since there is no need for
+ * anyone outside of a module to know that that module performs special
+ * operations on particular events.
+ *
+ * Usage: mkinit sourcefile...
+ */
+
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+
+/*
+ * OUTFILE is the name of the output file. Output is initially written
+ * to the file OUTTEMP, which is then moved to OUTFILE.
+ */
+
+#define OUTFILE "init.c"
+#define OUTTEMP "init.c.new"
+
+
+/*
+ * A text structure is basicly just a string that grows as more characters
+ * are added onto the end of it. It is implemented as a linked list of
+ * blocks of characters. The routines addstr and addchar append a string
+ * or a single character, respectively, to a text structure. Writetext
+ * writes the contents of a text structure to a file.
+ */
+
+#define BLOCKSIZE 512
+
+struct text {
+ char *nextc;
+ int nleft;
+ struct block *start;
+ struct block *last;
+};
+
+struct block {
+ struct block *next;
+ char text[BLOCKSIZE];
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * There is one event structure for each event that mkinit handles.
+ */
+
+struct event {
+ char *name; /* name of event (e.g. INIT) */
+ char *routine; /* name of routine called on event */
+ char *comment; /* comment describing routine */
+ struct text code; /* code for handling event */
+};
+
+
+char writer[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This file was generated by the mkinit program.\n\
+ */\n\
+\n";
+
+char init[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * Initialization code.\n\
+ */\n";
+
+char reset[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This routine is called when an error or an interrupt occurs in an\n\
+ * interactive shell and control is returned to the main command loop.\n\
+ */\n";
+
+
+struct event event[] = {
+ {"INIT", "init", init},
+ {"RESET", "reset", reset},
+ {NULL, NULL}
+};
+
+
+char *curfile; /* current file */
+int linno; /* current line */
+char *header_files[200]; /* list of header files */
+struct text defines; /* #define statements */
+struct text decls; /* declarations */
+int amiddecls; /* for formatting */
+
+
+void readfile(char *);
+int match(char *, char *);
+int gooddefine(char *);
+void doevent(struct event *, FILE *, char *);
+void doinclude(char *);
+void dodecl(char *, FILE *);
+void output(void);
+void addstr(char *, struct text *);
+void addchar(int, struct text *);
+void writetext(struct text *, FILE *);
+FILE *ckfopen(char *, char *);
+void *ckmalloc(int);
+char *savestr(char *);
+static void error(char *);
+int main(int, char **);
+
+#define equal(s1, s2) (strcmp(s1, s2) == 0)
+
+int
+main(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char **ap;
+
+ header_files[0] = "\"shell.h\"";
+ header_files[1] = "\"mystring.h\"";
+ header_files[2] = "\"init.h\"";
+ for (ap = argv + 1 ; *ap ; ap++)
+ readfile(*ap);
+ output();
+ rename(OUTTEMP, OUTFILE);
+ exit(0);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse an input file.
+ */
+
+void
+readfile(char *fname)
+{
+ FILE *fp;
+ char line[1024];
+ struct event *ep;
+
+ fp = ckfopen(fname, "r");
+ curfile = fname;
+ linno = 0;
+ amiddecls = 0;
+ while (fgets(line, sizeof line, fp) != NULL) {
+ linno++;
+ for (ep = event ; ep->name ; ep++) {
+ if (line[0] == ep->name[0] && match(ep->name, line)) {
+ doevent(ep, fp, fname);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (line[0] == 'I' && match("INCLUDE", line))
+ doinclude(line);
+ if (line[0] == 'M' && match("MKINIT", line))
+ dodecl(line, fp);
+ if (line[0] == '#' && gooddefine(line)) {
+ char *cp;
+ char line2[1024];
+ static const char undef[] = "#undef ";
+
+ strcpy(line2, line);
+ memcpy(line2, undef, sizeof(undef) - 1);
+ cp = line2 + sizeof(undef) - 1;
+ while(*cp && (*cp == ' ' || *cp == '\t'))
+ cp++;
+ while(*cp && *cp != ' ' && *cp != '\t' && *cp != '\n')
+ cp++;
+ *cp++ = '\n'; *cp = '\0';
+ addstr(line2, &defines);
+ addstr(line, &defines);
+ }
+ }
+ fclose(fp);
+}
+
+
+int
+match(char *name, char *line)
+{
+ char *p, *q;
+
+ p = name, q = line;
+ while (*p) {
+ if (*p++ != *q++)
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if (*q != '{' && *q != ' ' && *q != '\t' && *q != '\n')
+ return 0;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+int
+gooddefine(char *line)
+{
+ char *p;
+
+ if (! match("#define", line))
+ return 0; /* not a define */
+ p = line + 7;
+ while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
+ p++;
+ while (*p != ' ' && *p != '\t') {
+ if (*p == '(')
+ return 0; /* macro definition */
+ p++;
+ }
+ while (*p != '\n' && *p != '\0')
+ p++;
+ if (p[-1] == '\\')
+ return 0; /* multi-line definition */
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+void
+doevent(struct event *ep, FILE *fp, char *fname)
+{
+ char line[1024];
+ int indent;
+ char *p;
+
+ sprintf(line, "\n /* from %s: */\n", fname);
+ addstr(line, &ep->code);
+ addstr(" {\n", &ep->code);
+ for (;;) {
+ linno++;
+ if (fgets(line, sizeof line, fp) == NULL)
+ error("Unexpected EOF");
+ if (equal(line, "}\n"))
+ break;
+ indent = 6;
+ for (p = line ; *p == '\t' ; p++)
+ indent += 8;
+ for ( ; *p == ' ' ; p++)
+ indent++;
+ if (*p == '\n' || *p == '#')
+ indent = 0;
+ while (indent >= 8) {
+ addchar('\t', &ep->code);
+ indent -= 8;
+ }
+ while (indent > 0) {
+ addchar(' ', &ep->code);
+ indent--;
+ }
+ addstr(p, &ep->code);
+ }
+ addstr(" }\n", &ep->code);
+}
+
+
+void
+doinclude(char *line)
+{
+ char *p;
+ char *name;
+ char **pp;
+
+ for (p = line ; *p != '"' && *p != '<' && *p != '\0' ; p++);
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ error("Expecting '\"' or '<'");
+ name = p;
+ while (*p != ' ' && *p != '\t' && *p != '\n')
+ p++;
+ if (p[-1] != '"' && p[-1] != '>')
+ error("Missing terminator");
+ *p = '\0';
+
+ /* name now contains the name of the include file */
+ for (pp = header_files ; *pp && ! equal(*pp, name) ; pp++);
+ if (*pp == NULL)
+ *pp = savestr(name);
+}
+
+
+void
+dodecl(char *line1, FILE *fp)
+{
+ char line[1024];
+ char *p, *q;
+
+ if (strcmp(line1, "MKINIT\n") == 0) { /* start of struct/union decl */
+ addchar('\n', &decls);
+ do {
+ linno++;
+ if (fgets(line, sizeof line, fp) == NULL)
+ error("Unterminated structure declaration");
+ addstr(line, &decls);
+ } while (line[0] != '}');
+ amiddecls = 0;
+ } else {
+ if (! amiddecls)
+ addchar('\n', &decls);
+ q = NULL;
+ for (p = line1 + 6 ; *p && strchr("=/\n", *p) == NULL; p++)
+ continue;
+ if (*p == '=') { /* eliminate initialization */
+ for (q = p ; *q && *q != ';' ; q++);
+ if (*q == '\0')
+ q = NULL;
+ else {
+ while (p[-1] == ' ')
+ p--;
+ *p = '\0';
+ }
+ }
+ addstr("extern", &decls);
+ addstr(line1 + 6, &decls);
+ if (q != NULL)
+ addstr(q, &decls);
+ amiddecls = 1;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Write the output to the file OUTTEMP.
+ */
+
+void
+output(void)
+{
+ FILE *fp;
+ char **pp;
+ struct event *ep;
+
+ fp = ckfopen(OUTTEMP, "w");
+ fputs(writer, fp);
+ for (pp = header_files ; *pp ; pp++)
+ fprintf(fp, "#include %s\n", *pp);
+ fputs("\n\n\n", fp);
+ writetext(&defines, fp);
+ fputs("\n\n", fp);
+ writetext(&decls, fp);
+ for (ep = event ; ep->name ; ep++) {
+ fputs("\n\n\n", fp);
+ fputs(ep->comment, fp);
+ fprintf(fp, "\nvoid\n%s() {\n", ep->routine);
+ writetext(&ep->code, fp);
+ fprintf(fp, "}\n");
+ }
+ fclose(fp);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * A text structure is simply a block of text that is kept in memory.
+ * Addstr appends a string to the text struct, and addchar appends a single
+ * character.
+ */
+
+void
+addstr(char *s, struct text *text)
+{
+ while (*s) {
+ if (--text->nleft < 0)
+ addchar(*s++, text);
+ else
+ *text->nextc++ = *s++;
+ }
+}
+
+
+void
+addchar(int c, struct text *text)
+{
+ struct block *bp;
+
+ if (--text->nleft < 0) {
+ bp = ckmalloc(sizeof *bp);
+ if (text->start == NULL)
+ text->start = bp;
+ else
+ text->last->next = bp;
+ text->last = bp;
+ text->nextc = bp->text;
+ text->nleft = BLOCKSIZE - 1;
+ }
+ *text->nextc++ = c;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Write the contents of a text structure to a file.
+ */
+void
+writetext(struct text *text, FILE *fp)
+{
+ struct block *bp;
+
+ if (text->start != NULL) {
+ for (bp = text->start ; bp != text->last ; bp = bp->next) {
+ if ((fwrite(bp->text, sizeof (char), BLOCKSIZE, fp)) != BLOCKSIZE)
+ error("Can't write data\n");
+ }
+ if ((fwrite(bp->text, sizeof (char), BLOCKSIZE - text->nleft, fp)) != (BLOCKSIZE - text->nleft))
+ error("Can't write data\n");
+ }
+}
+
+FILE *
+ckfopen(char *file, char *mode)
+{
+ FILE *fp;
+
+ if ((fp = fopen(file, mode)) == NULL) {
+ fprintf(stderr, "Can't open %s\n", file);
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ return fp;
+}
+
+void *
+ckmalloc(int nbytes)
+{
+ char *p;
+
+ if ((p = malloc(nbytes)) == NULL)
+ error("Out of space");
+ return p;
+}
+
+char *
+savestr(char *s)
+{
+ char *p;
+
+ p = ckmalloc(strlen(s) + 1);
+ strcpy(p, s);
+ return p;
+}
+
+static void
+error(char *msg)
+{
+ if (curfile != NULL)
+ fprintf(stderr, "%s:%d: ", curfile, linno);
+ fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", msg);
+ exit(2);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/mknodes.c b/usr/dash/mknodes.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1903a60
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mknodes.c
@@ -0,0 +1,448 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * This program reads the nodetypes file and nodes.c.pat file. It generates
+ * the files nodes.h and nodes.c.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+
+#define MAXTYPES 50 /* max number of node types */
+#define MAXFIELDS 20 /* max fields in a structure */
+#define BUFLEN 100 /* size of character buffers */
+
+/* field types */
+#define T_NODE 1 /* union node *field */
+#define T_NODELIST 2 /* struct nodelist *field */
+#define T_STRING 3
+#define T_INT 4 /* int field */
+#define T_OTHER 5 /* other */
+#define T_TEMP 6 /* don't copy this field */
+
+
+struct field { /* a structure field */
+ char *name; /* name of field */
+ int type; /* type of field */
+ char *decl; /* declaration of field */
+};
+
+
+struct str { /* struct representing a node structure */
+ char *tag; /* structure tag */
+ int nfields; /* number of fields in the structure */
+ struct field field[MAXFIELDS]; /* the fields of the structure */
+ int done; /* set if fully parsed */
+};
+
+
+static int ntypes; /* number of node types */
+static char *nodename[MAXTYPES]; /* names of the nodes */
+static struct str *nodestr[MAXTYPES]; /* type of structure used by the node */
+static int nstr; /* number of structures */
+static struct str str[MAXTYPES]; /* the structures */
+static struct str *curstr; /* current structure */
+static FILE *infp;
+static char line[1024];
+static int linno;
+static char *linep;
+
+static void parsenode(void);
+static void parsefield(void);
+static void output(char *);
+static void outsizes(FILE *);
+static void outfunc(FILE *, int);
+static void indent(int, FILE *);
+static int nextfield(char *);
+static void skipbl(void);
+static int readline(void);
+static void error(const char *, ...);
+static char *savestr(const char *);
+int main(int, char **);
+
+
+int
+main(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+
+ /*
+ * some versions of linux complain: initializer element is not
+ * constant if this is done at compile time.
+ */
+ infp = stdin;
+
+ if (argc != 3)
+ error("usage: mknodes file");
+ if ((infp = fopen(argv[1], "r")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't open %s", argv[1]);
+ while (readline()) {
+ if (line[0] == ' ' || line[0] == '\t')
+ parsefield();
+ else if (line[0] != '\0')
+ parsenode();
+ }
+ output(argv[2]);
+ exit(0);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+
+static void
+parsenode(void)
+{
+ char name[BUFLEN];
+ char tag[BUFLEN];
+ struct str *sp;
+
+ if (curstr && curstr->nfields > 0)
+ curstr->done = 1;
+ nextfield(name);
+ if (! nextfield(tag))
+ error("Tag expected");
+ if (*linep != '\0')
+ error("Garbage at end of line");
+ nodename[ntypes] = savestr(name);
+ for (sp = str ; sp < str + nstr ; sp++) {
+ if (strcmp(sp->tag, tag) == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (sp >= str + nstr) {
+ sp->tag = savestr(tag);
+ sp->nfields = 0;
+ curstr = sp;
+ nstr++;
+ }
+ nodestr[ntypes] = sp;
+ ntypes++;
+}
+
+
+static void
+parsefield(void)
+{
+ char name[BUFLEN];
+ char type[BUFLEN];
+ char decl[2 * BUFLEN];
+ struct field *fp;
+
+ if (curstr == NULL || curstr->done)
+ error("No current structure to add field to");
+ if (! nextfield(name))
+ error("No field name");
+ if (! nextfield(type))
+ error("No field type");
+ fp = &curstr->field[curstr->nfields];
+ fp->name = savestr(name);
+ if (strcmp(type, "nodeptr") == 0) {
+ fp->type = T_NODE;
+ sprintf(decl, "union node *%s", name);
+ } else if (strcmp(type, "nodelist") == 0) {
+ fp->type = T_NODELIST;
+ sprintf(decl, "struct nodelist *%s", name);
+ } else if (strcmp(type, "string") == 0) {
+ fp->type = T_STRING;
+ sprintf(decl, "char *%s", name);
+ } else if (strcmp(type, "int") == 0) {
+ fp->type = T_INT;
+ sprintf(decl, "int %s", name);
+ } else if (strcmp(type, "other") == 0) {
+ fp->type = T_OTHER;
+ } else if (strcmp(type, "temp") == 0) {
+ fp->type = T_TEMP;
+ } else {
+ error("Unknown type %s", type);
+ }
+ if (fp->type == T_OTHER || fp->type == T_TEMP) {
+ skipbl();
+ fp->decl = savestr(linep);
+ } else {
+ if (*linep)
+ error("Garbage at end of line");
+ fp->decl = savestr(decl);
+ }
+ curstr->nfields++;
+}
+
+
+char writer[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This file was generated by the mknodes program.\n\
+ */\n\
+\n";
+
+static void
+output(char *file)
+{
+ FILE *hfile;
+ FILE *cfile;
+ FILE *patfile;
+ int i;
+ struct str *sp;
+ struct field *fp;
+ char *p;
+
+ if ((patfile = fopen(file, "r")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't open %s", file);
+ if ((hfile = fopen("nodes.h", "w")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't create nodes.h");
+ if ((cfile = fopen("nodes.c", "w")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't create nodes.c");
+ fputs(writer, hfile);
+ for (i = 0 ; i < ntypes ; i++)
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define %s %d\n", nodename[i], i);
+ fputs("\n\n\n", hfile);
+ for (sp = str ; sp < &str[nstr] ; sp++) {
+ fprintf(hfile, "struct %s {\n", sp->tag);
+ for (i = sp->nfields, fp = sp->field ; --i >= 0 ; fp++) {
+ fprintf(hfile, " %s;\n", fp->decl);
+ }
+ fputs("};\n\n\n", hfile);
+ }
+ fputs("union node {\n", hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, " int type;\n");
+ for (sp = str ; sp < &str[nstr] ; sp++) {
+ fprintf(hfile, " struct %s %s;\n", sp->tag, sp->tag);
+ }
+ fputs("};\n\n\n", hfile);
+ fputs("struct nodelist {\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\tstruct nodelist *next;\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\tunion node *n;\n", hfile);
+ fputs("};\n\n\n", hfile);
+ fputs("struct funcnode {\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\tint count;\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\tunion node n;\n", hfile);
+ fputs("};\n\n\n", hfile);
+ fputs("struct funcnode *copyfunc(union node *);\n", hfile);
+ fputs("void freefunc(struct funcnode *);\n", hfile);
+
+ fputs(writer, cfile);
+ while (fgets(line, sizeof line, patfile) != NULL) {
+ for (p = line ; *p == ' ' || *p == '\t' ; p++);
+ if (strcmp(p, "%SIZES\n") == 0)
+ outsizes(cfile);
+ else if (strcmp(p, "%CALCSIZE\n") == 0)
+ outfunc(cfile, 1);
+ else if (strcmp(p, "%COPY\n") == 0)
+ outfunc(cfile, 0);
+ else
+ fputs(line, cfile);
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+static void
+outsizes(FILE *cfile)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ fprintf(cfile, "static const short nodesize[%d] = {\n", ntypes);
+ for (i = 0 ; i < ntypes ; i++) {
+ fprintf(cfile, " SHELL_ALIGN(sizeof (struct %s)),\n",
+ nodestr[i]->tag);
+ }
+ fprintf(cfile, "};\n");
+}
+
+
+static void
+outfunc(FILE *cfile, int calcsize)
+{
+ struct str *sp;
+ struct field *fp;
+ int i;
+
+ fputs(" if (n == NULL)\n", cfile);
+ if (calcsize)
+ fputs(" return;\n", cfile);
+ else
+ fputs(" return NULL;\n", cfile);
+ if (calcsize)
+ fputs(" funcblocksize += nodesize[n->type];\n", cfile);
+ else {
+ fputs(" new = funcblock;\n", cfile);
+ fputs(" funcblock = (char *) funcblock + nodesize[n->type];\n", cfile);
+ }
+ fputs(" switch (n->type) {\n", cfile);
+ for (sp = str ; sp < &str[nstr] ; sp++) {
+ for (i = 0 ; i < ntypes ; i++) {
+ if (nodestr[i] == sp)
+ fprintf(cfile, " case %s:\n", nodename[i]);
+ }
+ for (i = sp->nfields ; --i >= 1 ; ) {
+ fp = &sp->field[i];
+ switch (fp->type) {
+ case T_NODE:
+ if (calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "calcsize(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name);
+ } else {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = copynode(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ case T_NODELIST:
+ if (calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "sizenodelist(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name);
+ } else {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = copynodelist(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ case T_STRING:
+ if (calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "funcstringsize += strlen(n->%s.%s) + 1;\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name);
+ } else {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = nodesavestr(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ case T_INT:
+ case T_OTHER:
+ if (! calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = n->%s.%s;\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fputs("break;\n", cfile);
+ }
+ fputs(" };\n", cfile);
+ if (! calcsize)
+ fputs(" new->type = n->type;\n", cfile);
+}
+
+
+static void
+indent(int amount, FILE *fp)
+{
+ while (amount >= 8) {
+ putc('\t', fp);
+ amount -= 8;
+ }
+ while (--amount >= 0) {
+ putc(' ', fp);
+ }
+}
+
+
+static int
+nextfield(char *buf)
+{
+ char *p, *q;
+
+ p = linep;
+ while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
+ p++;
+ q = buf;
+ while (*p != ' ' && *p != '\t' && *p != '\0')
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ *q = '\0';
+ linep = p;
+ return (q > buf);
+}
+
+
+static void
+skipbl(void)
+{
+ while (*linep == ' ' || *linep == '\t')
+ linep++;
+}
+
+
+static int
+readline(void)
+{
+ char *p;
+
+ if (fgets(line, 1024, infp) == NULL)
+ return 0;
+ for (p = line ; *p != '#' && *p != '\n' && *p != '\0' ; p++);
+ while (p > line && (p[-1] == ' ' || p[-1] == '\t'))
+ p--;
+ *p = '\0';
+ linep = line;
+ linno++;
+ if (p - line > BUFLEN)
+ error("Line too long");
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+
+static void
+error(const char *msg, ...)
+{
+ va_list va;
+
+ va_start(va, msg);
+
+ (void) fprintf(stderr, "line %d: ", linno);
+ (void) vfprintf(stderr, msg, va);
+ (void) fputc('\n', stderr);
+
+ va_end(va);
+
+ exit(2);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+
+static char *
+savestr(const char *s)
+{
+ char *p;
+
+ if ((p = malloc(strlen(s) + 1)) == NULL)
+ error("Out of space");
+ (void) strcpy(p, s);
+ return p;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/mksyntax.c b/usr/dash/mksyntax.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a23c18c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mksyntax.c
@@ -0,0 +1,315 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * This program creates syntax.h and syntax.c.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include "parser.h"
+
+
+struct synclass {
+ char *name;
+ char *comment;
+};
+
+/* Syntax classes */
+struct synclass synclass[] = {
+ { "CWORD", "character is nothing special" },
+ { "CNL", "newline character" },
+ { "CBACK", "a backslash character" },
+ { "CSQUOTE", "single quote" },
+ { "CDQUOTE", "double quote" },
+ { "CENDQUOTE", "a terminating quote" },
+ { "CBQUOTE", "backwards single quote" },
+ { "CVAR", "a dollar sign" },
+ { "CENDVAR", "a '}' character" },
+ { "CLP", "a left paren in arithmetic" },
+ { "CRP", "a right paren in arithmetic" },
+ { "CEOF", "end of file" },
+ { "CCTL", "like CWORD, except it must be escaped" },
+ { "CSPCL", "these terminate a word" },
+ { "CIGN", "character should be ignored" },
+ { NULL, NULL }
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * Syntax classes for is_ functions. Warning: if you add new classes
+ * you may have to change the definition of the is_in_name macro.
+ */
+struct synclass is_entry[] = {
+ { "ISDIGIT", "a digit" },
+ { "ISUPPER", "an upper case letter" },
+ { "ISLOWER", "a lower case letter" },
+ { "ISUNDER", "an underscore" },
+ { "ISSPECL", "the name of a special parameter" },
+ { NULL, NULL }
+};
+
+static char writer[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This file was generated by the mksyntax program.\n\
+ */\n\
+\n";
+
+
+static FILE *cfile;
+static FILE *hfile;
+static char *syntax[513];
+
+static void filltable(char *);
+static void init(void);
+static void add(char *, char *);
+static void print(char *);
+static void output_type_macros(void);
+int main(int, char **);
+
+int
+main(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int i;
+ char buf[80];
+ int pos;
+
+ /* Create output files */
+ if ((cfile = fopen("syntax.c", "w")) == NULL) {
+ perror("syntax.c");
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ if ((hfile = fopen("syntax.h", "w")) == NULL) {
+ perror("syntax.h");
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ fputs(writer, hfile);
+ fputs(writer, cfile);
+
+ fputs("#include <ctype.h>\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#ifdef CEOF\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#undef CEOF\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#endif\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\n", hfile);
+
+ /* Generate the #define statements in the header file */
+ fputs("/* Syntax classes */\n", hfile);
+ for (i = 0 ; synclass[i].name ; i++) {
+ sprintf(buf, "#define %s %d", synclass[i].name, i);
+ fputs(buf, hfile);
+ for (pos = strlen(buf) ; pos < 32 ; pos = (pos + 8) & ~07)
+ putc('\t', hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, "/* %s */\n", synclass[i].comment);
+ }
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ fputs("/* Syntax classes for is_ functions */\n", hfile);
+ for (i = 0 ; is_entry[i].name ; i++) {
+ sprintf(buf, "#define %s %#o", is_entry[i].name, 1 << i);
+ fputs(buf, hfile);
+ for (pos = strlen(buf) ; pos < 32 ; pos = (pos + 8) & ~07)
+ putc('\t', hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, "/* %s */\n", is_entry[i].comment);
+ }
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define SYNBASE %d\n", 130);
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define PEOF %d\n\n", -130);
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define PEOA %d\n\n", -129);
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ fputs("#define BASESYNTAX (basesyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#define DQSYNTAX (dqsyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#define SQSYNTAX (sqsyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#define ARISYNTAX (arisyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ output_type_macros(); /* is_digit, etc. */
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+
+ /* Generate the syntax tables. */
+ fputs("#include \"shell.h\"\n", cfile);
+ fputs("#include \"syntax.h\"\n\n", cfile);
+ init();
+ fputs("/* syntax table used when not in quotes */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("\\", "CBACK");
+ add("'", "CSQUOTE");
+ add("\"", "CDQUOTE");
+ add("`", "CBQUOTE");
+ add("$", "CVAR");
+ add("}", "CENDVAR");
+ add("<>();&| \t", "CSPCL");
+ syntax[1] = "CSPCL";
+ print("basesyntax");
+ init();
+ fputs("\n/* syntax table used when in double quotes */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("\\", "CBACK");
+ add("\"", "CENDQUOTE");
+ add("`", "CBQUOTE");
+ add("$", "CVAR");
+ add("}", "CENDVAR");
+ /* ':/' for tilde expansion, '-' for [a\-x] pattern ranges */
+ add("!*?[=~:/-]", "CCTL");
+ print("dqsyntax");
+ init();
+ fputs("\n/* syntax table used when in single quotes */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("'", "CENDQUOTE");
+ /* ':/' for tilde expansion, '-' for [a\-x] pattern ranges */
+ add("!*?[=~:/-]\\", "CCTL");
+ print("sqsyntax");
+ init();
+ fputs("\n/* syntax table used when in arithmetic */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("\\", "CBACK");
+ add("`", "CBQUOTE");
+ add("$", "CVAR");
+ add("}", "CENDVAR");
+ add("(", "CLP");
+ add(")", "CRP");
+ print("arisyntax");
+ filltable("0");
+ fputs("\n/* character classification table */\n", cfile);
+ add("0123456789", "ISDIGIT");
+ add("abcdefghijklmnopqrstucvwxyz", "ISLOWER");
+ add("ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUCVWXYZ", "ISUPPER");
+ add("_", "ISUNDER");
+ add("#?$!-*@", "ISSPECL");
+ print("is_type");
+ exit(0);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Clear the syntax table.
+ */
+
+static void
+filltable(char *dftval)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0 ; i < 258; i++)
+ syntax[i] = dftval;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Initialize the syntax table with default values.
+ */
+
+static void
+init(void)
+{
+ int ctl;
+
+ filltable("CWORD");
+ syntax[0] = "CEOF";
+ syntax[1] = "CIGN";
+ for (ctl = CTL_FIRST; ctl <= CTL_LAST; ctl++ )
+ syntax[130 + ctl] = "CCTL";
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Add entries to the syntax table.
+ */
+
+static void
+add(char *p, char *type)
+{
+ while (*p)
+ syntax[(signed char)*p++ + 130] = type;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Output the syntax table.
+ */
+
+static void
+print(char *name)
+{
+ int i;
+ int col;
+
+ fprintf(hfile, "extern const char %s[];\n", name);
+ fprintf(cfile, "const char %s[] = {\n", name);
+ col = 0;
+ for (i = 0 ; i < 258; i++) {
+ if (i == 0) {
+ fputs(" ", cfile);
+ } else if ((i & 03) == 0) {
+ fputs(",\n ", cfile);
+ col = 0;
+ } else {
+ putc(',', cfile);
+ while (++col < 9 * (i & 03))
+ putc(' ', cfile);
+ }
+ fputs(syntax[i], cfile);
+ col += strlen(syntax[i]);
+ }
+ fputs("\n};\n", cfile);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Output character classification macros (e.g. is_digit). If digits are
+ * contiguous, we can test for them quickly.
+ */
+
+static char *macro[] = {
+ "#define is_digit(c)\t((unsigned)((c) - '0') <= 9)\n",
+ "#define is_alpha(c)\tisalpha((unsigned char)(c))\n",
+ "#define is_name(c)\t((c) == '_' || isalpha((unsigned char)(c)))\n",
+ "#define is_in_name(c)\t((c) == '_' || isalnum((unsigned char)(c)))\n",
+ "#define is_special(c)\t((is_type+SYNBASE)[(signed char)(c)] & (ISSPECL|ISDIGIT))\n",
+ NULL
+};
+
+static void
+output_type_macros(void)
+{
+ char **pp;
+
+ for (pp = macro ; *pp ; pp++)
+ fputs(*pp, hfile);
+ fputs("#define digit_val(c)\t((c) - '0')\n", hfile);
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/mktokens b/usr/dash/mktokens
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8fbcef1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mktokens
@@ -0,0 +1,92 @@
+#!/bin/sh -
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)mktokens 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# The following is a list of tokens. The second column is nonzero if the
+# token marks the end of a list. The third column is the name to print in
+# error messages.
+
+cat > /tmp/ka$$ <<\!
+TEOF 1 end of file
+TNL 0 newline
+TSEMI 0 ";"
+TBACKGND 0 "&"
+TAND 0 "&&"
+TOR 0 "||"
+TPIPE 0 "|"
+TLP 0 "("
+TRP 1 ")"
+TENDCASE 1 ";;"
+TENDBQUOTE 1 "`"
+TREDIR 0 redirection
+TWORD 0 word
+TNOT 0 "!"
+TCASE 0 "case"
+TDO 1 "do"
+TDONE 1 "done"
+TELIF 1 "elif"
+TELSE 1 "else"
+TESAC 1 "esac"
+TFI 1 "fi"
+TFOR 0 "for"
+TIF 0 "if"
+TIN 0 "in"
+TTHEN 1 "then"
+TUNTIL 0 "until"
+TWHILE 0 "while"
+TBEGIN 0 "{"
+TEND 1 "}"
+!
+nl=`wc -l /tmp/ka$$`
+
+awk '{print "#define " $1 " " NR-1}' /tmp/ka$$
+echo '
+/* Array indicating which tokens mark the end of a list */
+const char tokendlist[] = {'
+awk '{print "\t" $2 ","}' /tmp/ka$$
+echo '};
+
+const char *const tokname[] = {'
+sed -e 's/"/\\"/g' \
+ -e 's/[^ ]*[ ][ ]*[^ ]*[ ][ ]*\(.*\)/ "\1",/' \
+ /tmp/ka$$
+echo '};
+'
+sed 's/"//g' /tmp/ka$$ | awk '
+/TNOT/{print "#define KWDOFFSET " NR-1; print "";
+ print "STATIC const char *const parsekwd[] = {"}
+/TNOT/,/neverfound/{if (last) print " \"" last "\","; last = $3}
+END{print " \"" last "\"\n};"}'
+
+rm /tmp/ka$$
diff --git a/usr/dash/myhistedit.h b/usr/dash/myhistedit.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5888088
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/myhistedit.h
@@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)myhistedit.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <histedit.h>
+
+extern History *hist;
+extern EditLine *el;
+extern int displayhist;
+
+void histedit(void);
+void sethistsize(const char *);
+void setterm(const char *);
+int histcmd(int, char **);
+int not_fcnumber(char *);
+int str_to_event(const char *, int);
diff --git a/usr/dash/mystring.c b/usr/dash/mystring.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0106bd2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mystring.c
@@ -0,0 +1,257 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * String functions.
+ *
+ * equal(s1, s2) Return true if strings are equal.
+ * scopy(from, to) Copy a string.
+ * scopyn(from, to, n) Like scopy, but checks for overflow.
+ * number(s) Convert a string of digits to an integer.
+ * is_number(s) Return true if s is a string of digits.
+ */
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+
+char nullstr[1]; /* zero length string */
+const char spcstr[] = " ";
+const char snlfmt[] = "%s\n";
+const char dolatstr[] = { CTLQUOTEMARK, CTLVAR, VSNORMAL, '@', '=',
+ CTLQUOTEMARK, '\0' };
+const char qchars[] = { CTLESC, CTLQUOTEMARK, 0 };
+const char illnum[] = "Illegal number: %s";
+const char homestr[] = "HOME";
+
+/*
+ * equal - #defined in mystring.h
+ */
+
+/*
+ * scopy - #defined in mystring.h
+ */
+
+
+#if 0
+/*
+ * scopyn - copy a string from "from" to "to", truncating the string
+ * if necessary. "To" is always nul terminated, even if
+ * truncation is performed. "Size" is the size of "to".
+ */
+
+void
+scopyn(const char *from, char *to, int size)
+{
+
+ while (--size > 0) {
+ if ((*to++ = *from++) == '\0')
+ return;
+ }
+ *to = '\0';
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * prefix -- see if pfx is a prefix of string.
+ */
+
+char *
+prefix(const char *string, const char *pfx)
+{
+ while (*pfx) {
+ if (*pfx++ != *string++)
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return (char *) string;
+}
+
+void badnum(const char *s)
+{
+ sh_error(illnum, s);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Convert a string into an integer of type intmax_t. Alow trailing spaces.
+ */
+intmax_t atomax(const char *s, int base)
+{
+ char *p;
+ intmax_t r;
+
+ errno = 0;
+ r = strtoimax(s, &p, base);
+
+ if (errno != 0)
+ badnum(s);
+
+ /*
+ * Disallow completely blank strings in non-arithmetic (base != 0)
+ * contexts.
+ */
+ if (p == s && base)
+ badnum(s);
+
+ while (isspace((unsigned char)*p))
+ p++;
+
+ if (*p)
+ badnum(s);
+
+ return r;
+}
+
+intmax_t atomax10(const char *s)
+{
+ return atomax(s, 10);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Convert a string of digits to an integer, printing an error message on
+ * failure.
+ */
+
+int
+number(const char *s)
+{
+ intmax_t n = atomax10(s);
+
+ if (n < 0 || n > INT_MAX)
+ badnum(s);
+
+ return n;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Check for a valid number. This should be elsewhere.
+ */
+
+int
+is_number(const char *p)
+{
+ do {
+ if (! is_digit(*p))
+ return 0;
+ } while (*++p != '\0');
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Produce a possibly single quoted string suitable as input to the shell.
+ * The return string is allocated on the stack.
+ */
+
+char *
+single_quote(const char *s) {
+ char *p;
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(p);
+
+ do {
+ char *q;
+ size_t len;
+
+ len = strchrnul(s, '\'') - s;
+
+ q = p = makestrspace(len + 3, p);
+
+ *q++ = '\'';
+ q = mempcpy(q, s, len);
+ *q++ = '\'';
+ s += len;
+
+ STADJUST(q - p, p);
+
+ len = strspn(s, "'");
+ if (!len)
+ break;
+
+ q = p = makestrspace(len + 3, p);
+
+ *q++ = '"';
+ q = mempcpy(q, s, len);
+ *q++ = '"';
+ s += len;
+
+ STADJUST(q - p, p);
+ } while (*s);
+
+ USTPUTC(0, p);
+
+ return stackblock();
+}
+
+/*
+ * Like strdup but works with the ash stack.
+ */
+
+char *
+sstrdup(const char *p)
+{
+ size_t len = strlen(p) + 1;
+ return memcpy(stalloc(len), p, len);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Wrapper around strcmp for qsort/bsearch/...
+ */
+int
+pstrcmp(const void *a, const void *b)
+{
+ return strcmp(*(const char *const *) a, *(const char *const *) b);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Find a string is in a sorted array.
+ */
+const char *const *
+findstring(const char *s, const char *const *array, size_t nmemb)
+{
+ return bsearch(&s, array, nmemb, sizeof(const char *), pstrcmp);
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/mystring.h b/usr/dash/mystring.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..083ea98
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/mystring.h
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)mystring.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+extern const char snlfmt[];
+extern const char spcstr[];
+extern const char dolatstr[];
+#define DOLATSTRLEN 6
+extern const char qchars[];
+extern const char illnum[];
+extern const char homestr[];
+
+#if 0
+void scopyn(const char *, char *, int);
+#endif
+char *prefix(const char *, const char *);
+void badnum(const char *s) __attribute__ ((noreturn));
+intmax_t atomax(const char *, int);
+intmax_t atomax10(const char *);
+int number(const char *);
+int is_number(const char *);
+char *single_quote(const char *);
+char *sstrdup(const char *);
+int pstrcmp(const void *, const void *);
+const char *const *findstring(const char *, const char *const *, size_t);
+
+#define equal(s1, s2) (strcmp(s1, s2) == 0)
+#define scopy(s1, s2) ((void)strcpy(s2, s1))
diff --git a/usr/dash/nodes.c.pat b/usr/dash/nodes.c.pat
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9125bc7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/nodes.c.pat
@@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)nodes.c.pat 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+/*
+ * Routine for dealing with parsed shell commands.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "machdep.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+
+int funcblocksize; /* size of structures in function */
+int funcstringsize; /* size of strings in node */
+pointer funcblock; /* block to allocate function from */
+char *funcstring; /* block to allocate strings from */
+
+%SIZES
+
+
+STATIC void calcsize(union node *);
+STATIC void sizenodelist(struct nodelist *);
+STATIC union node *copynode(union node *);
+STATIC struct nodelist *copynodelist(struct nodelist *);
+STATIC char *nodesavestr(char *);
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Make a copy of a parse tree.
+ */
+
+struct funcnode *
+copyfunc(union node *n)
+{
+ struct funcnode *f;
+ size_t blocksize;
+
+ funcblocksize = offsetof(struct funcnode, n);
+ funcstringsize = 0;
+ calcsize(n);
+ blocksize = funcblocksize;
+ f = ckmalloc(blocksize + funcstringsize);
+ funcblock = (char *) f + offsetof(struct funcnode, n);
+ funcstring = (char *) f + blocksize;
+ copynode(n);
+ f->count = 0;
+ return f;
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+calcsize(n)
+ union node *n;
+{
+ %CALCSIZE
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+sizenodelist(lp)
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+{
+ while (lp) {
+ funcblocksize += SHELL_ALIGN(sizeof(struct nodelist));
+ calcsize(lp->n);
+ lp = lp->next;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+copynode(n)
+ union node *n;
+{
+ union node *new;
+
+ %COPY
+ return new;
+}
+
+
+STATIC struct nodelist *
+copynodelist(lp)
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+{
+ struct nodelist *start;
+ struct nodelist **lpp;
+
+ lpp = &start;
+ while (lp) {
+ *lpp = funcblock;
+ funcblock = (char *) funcblock +
+ SHELL_ALIGN(sizeof(struct nodelist));
+ (*lpp)->n = copynode(lp->n);
+ lp = lp->next;
+ lpp = &(*lpp)->next;
+ }
+ *lpp = NULL;
+ return start;
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC char *
+nodesavestr(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ char *rtn = funcstring;
+
+ funcstring = stpcpy(funcstring, s) + 1;
+ return rtn;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Free a parse tree.
+ */
+
+void
+freefunc(struct funcnode *f)
+{
+ if (f && --f->count < 0)
+ ckfree(f);
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/nodetypes b/usr/dash/nodetypes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ceaf478
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/nodetypes
@@ -0,0 +1,151 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+# Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+# Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)nodetypes 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+
+# This file describes the nodes used in parse trees. Unindented lines
+# contain a node type followed by a structure tag. Subsequent indented
+# lines specify the fields of the structure. Several node types can share
+# the same structure, in which case the fields of the structure should be
+# specified only once.
+#
+# A field of a structure is described by the name of the field followed
+# by a type. The currently implemented types are:
+# nodeptr - a pointer to a node
+# nodelist - a pointer to a list of nodes
+# string - a pointer to a nul terminated string
+# int - an integer
+# other - any type that can be copied by assignment
+# temp - a field that doesn't have to be copied when the node is copied
+# The last two types should be followed by the text of a C declaration for
+# the field.
+
+NCMD ncmd # a simple command
+ type int
+ linno int
+ assign nodeptr # variable assignments
+ args nodeptr # the arguments
+ redirect nodeptr # list of file redirections
+
+NPIPE npipe # a pipeline
+ type int
+ backgnd int # set to run pipeline in background
+ cmdlist nodelist # the commands in the pipeline
+
+NREDIR nredir # redirection (of a complex command)
+ type int
+ linno int
+ n nodeptr # the command
+ redirect nodeptr # list of file redirections
+
+NBACKGND nredir # run command in background
+NSUBSHELL nredir # run command in a subshell
+
+NAND nbinary # the && operator
+NOR nbinary # the || operator
+
+NSEMI nbinary # two commands separated by a semicolon
+ type int
+ ch1 nodeptr # the first child
+ ch2 nodeptr # the second child
+
+NIF nif # the if statement. Elif clauses are handled
+ type int # using multiple if nodes.
+ test nodeptr # if test
+ ifpart nodeptr # then ifpart
+ elsepart nodeptr # else elsepart
+
+NWHILE nbinary # the while statement. First child is the test
+NUNTIL nbinary # the until statement
+
+NFOR nfor # the for statement
+ type int
+ linno int
+ args nodeptr # for var in args
+ body nodeptr # do body; done
+ var string # the for variable
+
+NCASE ncase # a case statement
+ type int
+ linno int
+ expr nodeptr # the word to switch on
+ cases nodeptr # the list of cases (NCLIST nodes)
+
+NCLIST nclist # a case
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # the next case in list
+ pattern nodeptr # list of patterns for this case
+ body nodeptr # code to execute for this case
+
+
+NDEFUN ndefun # a function
+ type int
+ linno int
+ text string
+ body nodeptr
+
+NARG narg # represents a word
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next word in list
+ text string # the text of the word
+ backquote nodelist # list of commands in back quotes
+
+NTO nfile # fd> fname
+NCLOBBER nfile # fd>| fname
+NFROM nfile # fd< fname
+NFROMTO nfile # fd<> fname
+NAPPEND nfile # fd>> fname
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next redirection in list
+ fd int # file descriptor being redirected
+ fname nodeptr # file name, in a NARG node
+ expfname temp char *expfname # actual file name
+
+NTOFD ndup # fd<&dupfd
+NFROMFD ndup # fd>&dupfd
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next redirection in list
+ fd int # file descriptor being redirected
+ dupfd int # file descriptor to duplicate
+ vname nodeptr # file name if fd>&$var
+
+
+NHERE nhere # fd<<\!
+NXHERE nhere # fd<<!
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next redirection in list
+ fd int # file descriptor being redirected
+ doc nodeptr # input to command (NARG node)
+
+NNOT nnot # ! command (actually pipeline)
+ type int
+ com nodeptr
diff --git a/usr/dash/options.c b/usr/dash/options.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6f381e6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/options.c
@@ -0,0 +1,559 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#define DEFINE_OPTIONS
+#include "options.h"
+#undef DEFINE_OPTIONS
+#include "nodes.h" /* for other header files */
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#ifndef SMALL
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+#endif
+#include "show.h"
+
+char *arg0; /* value of $0 */
+struct shparam shellparam; /* current positional parameters */
+char **argptr; /* argument list for builtin commands */
+char *optionarg; /* set by nextopt (like getopt) */
+char *optptr; /* used by nextopt */
+
+char *minusc; /* argument to -c option */
+
+static const char *const optnames[NOPTS] = {
+ "errexit",
+ "noglob",
+ "ignoreeof",
+ "interactive",
+ "monitor",
+ "noexec",
+ "stdin",
+ "xtrace",
+ "verbose",
+ "vi",
+ "emacs",
+ "noclobber",
+ "allexport",
+ "notify",
+ "nounset",
+ "nolog",
+ "debug",
+};
+
+const char optletters[NOPTS] = {
+ 'e',
+ 'f',
+ 'I',
+ 'i',
+ 'm',
+ 'n',
+ 's',
+ 'x',
+ 'v',
+ 'V',
+ 'E',
+ 'C',
+ 'a',
+ 'b',
+ 'u',
+ 0,
+ 0,
+};
+
+char optlist[NOPTS];
+
+
+static int options(int);
+STATIC void minus_o(char *, int);
+STATIC void setoption(int, int);
+STATIC int getopts(char *, char *, char **);
+
+
+/*
+ * Process the shell command line arguments.
+ */
+
+int
+procargs(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int i;
+ const char *xminusc;
+ char **xargv;
+ int login;
+
+ xargv = argv;
+ login = xargv[0] && xargv[0][0] == '-';
+ arg0 = xargv[0];
+ if (argc > 0)
+ xargv++;
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ optlist[i] = 2;
+ argptr = xargv;
+ login |= options(1);
+ xargv = argptr;
+ xminusc = minusc;
+ if (*xargv == NULL) {
+ if (xminusc)
+ sh_error("-c requires an argument");
+ sflag = 1;
+ }
+ if (iflag == 2 && sflag == 1 && isatty(0) && isatty(1))
+ iflag = 1;
+ if (mflag == 2)
+ mflag = iflag;
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ if (optlist[i] == 2)
+ optlist[i] = 0;
+#if DEBUG == 2
+ debug = 1;
+#endif
+ /* POSIX 1003.2: first arg after -c cmd is $0, remainder $1... */
+ if (xminusc) {
+ minusc = *xargv++;
+ if (*xargv)
+ goto setarg0;
+ } else if (!sflag) {
+ setinputfile(*xargv, 0);
+setarg0:
+ arg0 = *xargv++;
+ commandname = arg0;
+ }
+
+ shellparam.p = xargv;
+ shellparam.optind = 1;
+ shellparam.optoff = -1;
+ /* assert(shellparam.malloc == 0 && shellparam.nparam == 0); */
+ while (*xargv) {
+ shellparam.nparam++;
+ xargv++;
+ }
+ optschanged();
+
+ return login;
+}
+
+
+void
+optschanged(void)
+{
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ opentrace();
+#endif
+ setinteractive(iflag);
+#ifndef SMALL
+ histedit();
+#endif
+ setjobctl(mflag);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Process shell options. The global variable argptr contains a pointer
+ * to the argument list; we advance it past the options.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+options(int cmdline)
+{
+ char *p;
+ int val;
+ int c;
+ int login = 0;
+
+ if (cmdline)
+ minusc = NULL;
+ while ((p = *argptr) != NULL) {
+ argptr++;
+ if ((c = *p++) == '-') {
+ val = 1;
+ if (p[0] == '\0' || (p[0] == '-' && p[1] == '\0')) {
+ if (!cmdline) {
+ /* "-" means turn off -x and -v */
+ if (p[0] == '\0')
+ xflag = vflag = 0;
+ /* "--" means reset params */
+ else if (*argptr == NULL)
+ setparam(argptr);
+ }
+ break; /* "-" or "--" terminates options */
+ }
+ } else if (c == '+') {
+ val = 0;
+ } else {
+ argptr--;
+ break;
+ }
+ while ((c = *p++) != '\0') {
+ if (c == 'c' && cmdline) {
+ minusc = p; /* command is after shell args*/
+ } else if (c == 'l' && cmdline) {
+ login = 1;
+ } else if (c == 'o') {
+ minus_o(*argptr, val);
+ if (*argptr)
+ argptr++;
+ } else {
+ setoption(c, val);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ return login;
+}
+
+STATIC void
+minus_o(char *name, int val)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ if (name == NULL) {
+ if (val) {
+ out1str("Current option settings\n");
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ out1fmt("%-16s%s\n", optnames[i],
+ optlist[i] ? "on" : "off");
+ } else {
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ out1fmt("set %s %s\n",
+ optlist[i] ? "-o" : "+o",
+ optnames[i]);
+
+ }
+ } else {
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ if (equal(name, optnames[i])) {
+ optlist[i] = val;
+ return;
+ }
+ sh_error("Illegal option -o %s", name);
+ }
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+setoption(int flag, int val)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ if (optletters[i] == flag) {
+ optlist[i] = val;
+ if (val) {
+ /* #%$ hack for ksh semantics */
+ if (flag == 'V')
+ Eflag = 0;
+ else if (flag == 'E')
+ Vflag = 0;
+ }
+ return;
+ }
+ sh_error("Illegal option -%c", flag);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Set the shell parameters.
+ */
+
+void
+setparam(char **argv)
+{
+ char **newparam;
+ char **ap;
+ int nparam;
+
+ for (nparam = 0 ; argv[nparam] ; nparam++);
+ ap = newparam = ckmalloc((nparam + 1) * sizeof *ap);
+ while (*argv) {
+ *ap++ = savestr(*argv++);
+ }
+ *ap = NULL;
+ freeparam(&shellparam);
+ shellparam.malloc = 1;
+ shellparam.nparam = nparam;
+ shellparam.p = newparam;
+ shellparam.optind = 1;
+ shellparam.optoff = -1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Free the list of positional parameters.
+ */
+
+void
+freeparam(volatile struct shparam *param)
+{
+ char **ap;
+
+ if (param->malloc) {
+ for (ap = param->p ; *ap ; ap++)
+ ckfree(*ap);
+ ckfree(param->p);
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The shift builtin command.
+ */
+
+int
+shiftcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ int n;
+ char **ap1, **ap2;
+
+ n = 1;
+ if (argc > 1)
+ n = number(argv[1]);
+ if (n > shellparam.nparam)
+ sh_error("can't shift that many");
+ INTOFF;
+ shellparam.nparam -= n;
+ for (ap1 = shellparam.p ; --n >= 0 ; ap1++) {
+ if (shellparam.malloc)
+ ckfree(*ap1);
+ }
+ ap2 = shellparam.p;
+ while ((*ap2++ = *ap1++) != NULL);
+ shellparam.optind = 1;
+ shellparam.optoff = -1;
+ INTON;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The set command builtin.
+ */
+
+int
+setcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ if (argc == 1)
+ return showvars(nullstr, 0, VUNSET);
+ INTOFF;
+ options(0);
+ optschanged();
+ if (*argptr != NULL) {
+ setparam(argptr);
+ }
+ INTON;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+void
+getoptsreset(value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ shellparam.optind = number(value) ?: 1;
+ shellparam.optoff = -1;
+}
+
+/*
+ * The getopts builtin. Shellparam.optnext points to the next argument
+ * to be processed. Shellparam.optptr points to the next character to
+ * be processed in the current argument. If shellparam.optnext is NULL,
+ * then it's the first time getopts has been called.
+ */
+
+int
+getoptscmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char **optbase;
+
+ if (argc < 3)
+ sh_error("Usage: getopts optstring var [arg]");
+ else if (argc == 3) {
+ optbase = shellparam.p;
+ if ((unsigned)shellparam.optind > shellparam.nparam + 1) {
+ shellparam.optind = 1;
+ shellparam.optoff = -1;
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ optbase = &argv[3];
+ if ((unsigned)shellparam.optind > argc - 2) {
+ shellparam.optind = 1;
+ shellparam.optoff = -1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return getopts(argv[1], argv[2], optbase);
+}
+
+STATIC int
+getopts(char *optstr, char *optvar, char **optfirst)
+{
+ char *p, *q;
+ char c = '?';
+ int done = 0;
+ char s[2];
+ char **optnext;
+ int ind = shellparam.optind;
+ int off = shellparam.optoff;
+
+ shellparam.optind = -1;
+ optnext = optfirst + ind - 1;
+
+ if (ind <= 1 || off < 0 || strlen(optnext[-1]) < off)
+ p = NULL;
+ else
+ p = optnext[-1] + off;
+ if (p == NULL || *p == '\0') {
+ /* Current word is done, advance */
+ p = *optnext;
+ if (p == NULL || *p != '-' || *++p == '\0') {
+atend:
+ p = NULL;
+ done = 1;
+ goto out;
+ }
+ optnext++;
+ if (p[0] == '-' && p[1] == '\0') /* check for "--" */
+ goto atend;
+ }
+
+ c = *p++;
+ for (q = optstr; *q != c; ) {
+ if (*q == '\0') {
+ if (optstr[0] == ':') {
+ s[0] = c;
+ s[1] = '\0';
+ setvar("OPTARG", s, 0);
+ } else {
+ outfmt(&errout, "Illegal option -%c\n", c);
+ (void) unsetvar("OPTARG");
+ }
+ c = '?';
+ goto out;
+ }
+ if (*++q == ':')
+ q++;
+ }
+
+ if (*++q == ':') {
+ if (*p == '\0' && (p = *optnext) == NULL) {
+ if (optstr[0] == ':') {
+ s[0] = c;
+ s[1] = '\0';
+ setvar("OPTARG", s, 0);
+ c = ':';
+ } else {
+ outfmt(&errout, "No arg for -%c option\n", c);
+ (void) unsetvar("OPTARG");
+ c = '?';
+ }
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ if (p == *optnext)
+ optnext++;
+ setvar("OPTARG", p, 0);
+ p = NULL;
+ } else
+ setvar("OPTARG", nullstr, 0);
+
+out:
+ ind = optnext - optfirst + 1;
+ setvarint("OPTIND", ind, VNOFUNC);
+ s[0] = c;
+ s[1] = '\0';
+ setvar(optvar, s, 0);
+
+ shellparam.optoff = p ? p - *(optnext - 1) : -1;
+ shellparam.optind = ind;
+
+ return done;
+}
+
+/*
+ * XXX - should get rid of. have all builtins use getopt(3). the
+ * library getopt must have the BSD extension static variable "optreset"
+ * otherwise it can't be used within the shell safely.
+ *
+ * Standard option processing (a la getopt) for builtin routines. The
+ * only argument that is passed to nextopt is the option string; the
+ * other arguments are unnecessary. It return the character, or '\0' on
+ * end of input.
+ */
+
+int
+nextopt(const char *optstring)
+{
+ char *p;
+ const char *q;
+ char c;
+
+ if ((p = optptr) == NULL || *p == '\0') {
+ p = *argptr;
+ if (p == NULL || *p != '-' || *++p == '\0')
+ return '\0';
+ argptr++;
+ if (p[0] == '-' && p[1] == '\0') /* check for "--" */
+ return '\0';
+ }
+ c = *p++;
+ for (q = optstring ; *q != c ; ) {
+ if (*q == '\0')
+ sh_error("Illegal option -%c", c);
+ if (*++q == ':')
+ q++;
+ }
+ if (*++q == ':') {
+ if (*p == '\0' && (p = *argptr++) == NULL)
+ sh_error("No arg for -%c option", c);
+ optionarg = p;
+ p = NULL;
+ }
+ optptr = p;
+ return c;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/options.h b/usr/dash/options.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..975fe33
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/options.h
@@ -0,0 +1,86 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)options.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+struct shparam {
+ int nparam; /* # of positional parameters (without $0) */
+ unsigned char malloc; /* if parameter list dynamically allocated */
+ char **p; /* parameter list */
+ int optind; /* next parameter to be processed by getopts */
+ int optoff; /* used by getopts */
+};
+
+
+
+#define eflag optlist[0]
+#define fflag optlist[1]
+#define Iflag optlist[2]
+#define iflag optlist[3]
+#define mflag optlist[4]
+#define nflag optlist[5]
+#define sflag optlist[6]
+#define xflag optlist[7]
+#define vflag optlist[8]
+#define Vflag optlist[9]
+#define Eflag optlist[10]
+#define Cflag optlist[11]
+#define aflag optlist[12]
+#define bflag optlist[13]
+#define uflag optlist[14]
+#define nolog optlist[15]
+#define debug optlist[16]
+
+#define NOPTS 17
+
+extern const char optletters[NOPTS];
+extern char optlist[NOPTS];
+
+
+extern char *minusc; /* argument to -c option */
+extern char *arg0; /* $0 */
+extern struct shparam shellparam; /* $@ */
+extern char **argptr; /* argument list for builtin commands */
+extern char *optionarg; /* set by nextopt */
+extern char *optptr; /* used by nextopt */
+
+int procargs(int, char **);
+void optschanged(void);
+void setparam(char **);
+void freeparam(volatile struct shparam *);
+int shiftcmd(int, char **);
+int setcmd(int, char **);
+int getoptscmd(int, char **);
+int nextopt(const char *);
+void getoptsreset(const char *);
diff --git a/usr/dash/output.c b/usr/dash/output.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bb7c6ad
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/output.c
@@ -0,0 +1,399 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Shell output routines. We use our own output routines because:
+ * When a builtin command is interrupted we have to discard
+ * any pending output.
+ * When a builtin command appears in back quotes, we want to
+ * save the output of the command in a region obtained
+ * via malloc, rather than doing a fork and reading the
+ * output of the command via a pipe.
+ * Our output routines may be smaller than the stdio routines.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/types.h> /* quad_t */
+#include <sys/param.h> /* BSD4_4 */
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h> /* defines BUFSIZ */
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#endif
+#include <limits.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+
+#define OUTBUFSIZ BUFSIZ
+#define MEM_OUT -3 /* output to dynamically allocated memory */
+
+
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+struct output output = {
+ .stream = 0, .nextc = 0, .end = 0, .buf = 0, .bufsize = 0, .fd = 1, .flags = 0
+};
+struct output errout = {
+ .stream = 0, .nextc = 0, .end = 0, .buf = 0, .bufsize = 0, .fd = 2, .flags = 0
+}
+#ifdef notyet
+struct output memout = {
+ .stream = 0, .nextc = 0, .end = 0, .buf = 0, .bufsize = 0, .fd = MEM_OUT, .flags = 0
+};
+#endif
+#else
+struct output output = {
+ .nextc = 0, .end = 0, .buf = 0, .bufsize = OUTBUFSIZ, .fd = 1, .flags = 0
+};
+struct output errout = {
+ .nextc = 0, .end = 0, .buf = 0, .bufsize = 0, .fd = 2, .flags = 0
+};
+struct output preverrout;
+#ifdef notyet
+struct output memout = {
+ .nextc = 0, .end = 0, .buf = 0, .bufsize = 0, .fd = MEM_OUT, .flags = 0
+};
+#endif
+#endif
+struct output *out1 = &output;
+struct output *out2 = &errout;
+
+
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+static void __outstr(const char *, size_t, struct output *);
+#endif
+static int xvsnprintf(char *, size_t, const char *, va_list);
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+
+INCLUDE "output.h"
+INCLUDE "memalloc.h"
+
+INIT {
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+ initstreams();
+#endif
+}
+
+RESET {
+#ifdef notyet
+ out1 = &output;
+ out2 = &errout;
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+ if (memout.stream != NULL)
+ __closememout();
+#endif
+ if (memout.buf != NULL) {
+ ckfree(memout.buf);
+ memout.buf = NULL;
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+#endif
+
+
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+static void
+__outstr(const char *p, size_t len, struct output *dest)
+{
+ size_t bufsize;
+ size_t offset;
+ size_t nleft;
+
+ nleft = dest->end - dest->nextc;
+ if (nleft >= len) {
+buffered:
+ dest->nextc = mempcpy(dest->nextc, p, len);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ bufsize = dest->bufsize;
+ if (!bufsize) {
+ ;
+ } else if (dest->buf == NULL) {
+ if (dest->fd == MEM_OUT && len > bufsize) {
+ bufsize = len;
+ }
+ offset = 0;
+ goto alloc;
+ } else if (dest->fd == MEM_OUT) {
+ offset = bufsize;
+ if (bufsize >= len) {
+ bufsize <<= 1;
+ } else {
+ bufsize += len;
+ }
+ if (bufsize < offset)
+ goto err;
+alloc:
+ INTOFF;
+ dest->buf = ckrealloc(dest->buf, bufsize);
+ dest->bufsize = bufsize;
+ dest->end = dest->buf + bufsize;
+ dest->nextc = dest->buf + offset;
+ INTON;
+ } else {
+ flushout(dest);
+ }
+
+ nleft = dest->end - dest->nextc;
+ if (nleft > len)
+ goto buffered;
+
+ if ((xwrite(dest->fd, p, len))) {
+err:
+ dest->flags |= OUTPUT_ERR;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+
+void
+outstr(const char *p, struct output *file)
+{
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+ INTOFF;
+ fputs(p, file->stream);
+ INTON;
+#else
+ size_t len;
+
+ len = strlen(p);
+ __outstr(p, len, file);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+
+
+void
+outcslow(int c, struct output *dest)
+{
+ char buf = c;
+ __outstr(&buf, 1, dest);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+void
+flushall(void)
+{
+ flushout(&output);
+#ifdef FLUSHERR
+ flushout(&errout);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+void
+flushout(struct output *dest)
+{
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+ INTOFF;
+ fflush(dest->stream);
+ INTON;
+#else
+ size_t len;
+
+ len = dest->nextc - dest->buf;
+ if (!len || dest->fd < 0)
+ return;
+ dest->nextc = dest->buf;
+ if ((xwrite(dest->fd, dest->buf, len)))
+ dest->flags |= OUTPUT_ERR;
+#endif
+}
+
+
+void
+outfmt(struct output *file, const char *fmt, ...)
+{
+ va_list ap;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ doformat(file, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+
+void
+out1fmt(const char *fmt, ...)
+{
+ va_list ap;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ doformat(out1, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+
+int
+fmtstr(char *outbuf, size_t length, const char *fmt, ...)
+{
+ va_list ap;
+ int ret;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ ret = xvsnprintf(outbuf, length, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ return ret;
+}
+
+
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+void
+doformat(struct output *dest, const char *f, va_list ap)
+{
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ char *s;
+ int len, ret;
+ size_t size;
+ va_list ap2;
+
+ va_copy(ap2, ap);
+ size = dest->end - dest->nextc;
+ len = xvsnprintf(dest->nextc, size, f, ap2);
+ va_end(ap2);
+ if (len < 0) {
+ dest->flags |= OUTPUT_ERR;
+ return;
+ }
+ if (len < size) {
+ dest->nextc += len;
+ return;
+ }
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ s = stalloc((len >= stackblocksize() ? len : stackblocksize()) + 1);
+ ret = xvsnprintf(s, len + 1, f, ap);
+ if (ret == len)
+ __outstr(s, len, dest);
+ else
+ dest->flags |= OUTPUT_ERR;
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Version of write which resumes after a signal is caught.
+ */
+
+int
+xwrite(int fd, const void *p, size_t n)
+{
+ const char *buf = p;
+
+ while (n) {
+ ssize_t i;
+ size_t m;
+
+ m = n;
+ if (m > SSIZE_MAX)
+ m = SSIZE_MAX;
+ do {
+ i = write(fd, buf, m);
+ } while (i < 0 && errno == EINTR);
+ if (i < 0)
+ return -1;
+ buf += i;
+ n -= i;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+#ifdef notyet
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+void initstreams() {
+ output.stream = stdout;
+ errout.stream = stderr;
+}
+
+
+void
+openmemout(void) {
+ INTOFF;
+ memout.stream = open_memstream(&memout.buf, &memout.bufsize);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+int
+__closememout(void) {
+ int error;
+ error = fclose(memout.stream);
+ memout.stream = NULL;
+ return error;
+}
+#endif
+#endif
+
+
+static int
+xvsnprintf(char *outbuf, size_t length, const char *fmt, va_list ap)
+{
+ int ret;
+
+#ifdef __sun
+ /*
+ * vsnprintf() on older versions of Solaris returns -1 when
+ * passed a length of 0. To avoid this, use a dummy
+ * 1-character buffer instead.
+ */
+ char dummy[1];
+
+ if (length == 0) {
+ outbuf = dummy;
+ length = sizeof(dummy);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ INTOFF;
+ ret = vsnprintf(outbuf, length, fmt, ap);
+ INTON;
+ return ret;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/output.h b/usr/dash/output.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f853e9d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/output.h
@@ -0,0 +1,123 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)output.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#ifndef OUTPUT_INCL
+
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+#include <stdio.h>
+#endif
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+struct output {
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+ FILE *stream;
+#endif
+ char *nextc;
+ char *end;
+ char *buf;
+ size_t bufsize;
+ int fd;
+ int flags;
+};
+
+extern struct output output;
+extern struct output errout;
+extern struct output preverrout;
+#ifdef notyet
+extern struct output memout;
+#endif
+extern struct output *out1;
+extern struct output *out2;
+
+void outstr(const char *, struct output *);
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+void outcslow(int, struct output *);
+#endif
+void flushall(void);
+void flushout(struct output *);
+void outfmt(struct output *, const char *, ...)
+ __attribute__((__format__(__printf__,2,3)));
+void out1fmt(const char *, ...)
+ __attribute__((__format__(__printf__,1,2)));
+int fmtstr(char *, size_t, const char *, ...)
+ __attribute__((__format__(__printf__,3,4)));
+#ifndef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+void doformat(struct output *, const char *, va_list);
+#endif
+int xwrite(int, const void *, size_t);
+#ifdef notyet
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+void initstreams(void);
+void openmemout(void);
+int __closememout(void);
+#endif
+#endif
+
+static inline void
+freestdout()
+{
+ output.nextc = output.buf;
+ output.flags = 0;
+}
+
+#define OUTPUT_ERR 01 /* error occurred on output */
+
+#ifdef USE_GLIBC_STDIO
+static inline void outc(int ch, struct output *file)
+{
+ putc(ch, file->stream);
+}
+#define doformat(d, f, a) vfprintf((d)->stream, (f), (a))
+#else
+static inline void outc(int ch, struct output *file)
+{
+ if (file->nextc == file->end)
+ outcslow(ch, file);
+ else {
+ *file->nextc = ch;
+ file->nextc++;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+#define out1c(c) outc((c), out1)
+#define out2c(c) outcslow((c), out2)
+#define out1str(s) outstr((s), out1)
+#define out2str(s) outstr((s), out2)
+#define outerr(f) (f)->flags
+
+#define OUTPUT_INCL
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/parser.c b/usr/dash/parser.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6e076a5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/parser.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1568 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#if HAVE_ALLOCA_H
+#include <alloca.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "expand.h" /* defines rmescapes() */
+#include "exec.h" /* defines find_builtin() */
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "alias.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "builtins.h"
+#include "system.h"
+#ifndef SMALL
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Shell command parser.
+ */
+
+/* values returned by readtoken */
+#include "token.h"
+
+
+
+/* Used by expandstr to get here-doc like behaviour. */
+#define FAKEEOFMARK (char *)1
+
+
+
+struct heredoc {
+ struct heredoc *next; /* next here document in list */
+ union node *here; /* redirection node */
+ char *eofmark; /* string indicating end of input */
+ int striptabs; /* if set, strip leading tabs */
+};
+
+
+
+struct heredoc *heredoclist; /* list of here documents to read */
+int doprompt; /* if set, prompt the user */
+int needprompt; /* true if interactive and at start of line */
+int lasttoken; /* last token read */
+MKINIT int tokpushback; /* last token pushed back */
+char *wordtext; /* text of last word returned by readtoken */
+int checkkwd;
+struct nodelist *backquotelist;
+union node *redirnode;
+struct heredoc *heredoc;
+int quoteflag; /* set if (part of) last token was quoted */
+
+
+STATIC union node *list(int);
+STATIC union node *andor(void);
+STATIC union node *pipeline(void);
+STATIC union node *command(void);
+STATIC union node *simplecmd(void);
+STATIC union node *makename(void);
+STATIC void parsefname(void);
+STATIC void parseheredoc(void);
+STATIC int peektoken(void);
+STATIC int readtoken(void);
+STATIC int xxreadtoken(void);
+STATIC int readtoken1(int, char const *, char *, int);
+STATIC void synexpect(int) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+STATIC void synerror(const char *) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+STATIC void setprompt(int);
+
+
+static inline int
+isassignment(const char *p)
+{
+ const char *q = endofname(p);
+ if (p == q)
+ return 0;
+ return *q == '=';
+}
+
+static inline int realeofmark(const char *eofmark)
+{
+ return eofmark && eofmark != FAKEEOFMARK;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Read and parse a command. Returns NEOF on end of file. (NULL is a
+ * valid parse tree indicating a blank line.)
+ */
+
+union node *
+parsecmd(int interact)
+{
+ int t;
+
+ tokpushback = 0;
+ doprompt = interact;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(doprompt);
+ needprompt = 0;
+ t = readtoken();
+ if (t == TEOF)
+ return NEOF;
+ if (t == TNL)
+ return NULL;
+ tokpushback++;
+ return list(1);
+}
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+list(int nlflag)
+{
+ union node *n1, *n2, *n3;
+ int tok;
+
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ if (nlflag == 2 && tokendlist[peektoken()])
+ return NULL;
+ n1 = NULL;
+ for (;;) {
+ n2 = andor();
+ tok = readtoken();
+ if (tok == TBACKGND) {
+ if (n2->type == NPIPE) {
+ n2->npipe.backgnd = 1;
+ } else {
+ if (n2->type != NREDIR) {
+ n3 = stalloc(sizeof(struct nredir));
+ n3->nredir.n = n2;
+ n3->nredir.redirect = NULL;
+ n2 = n3;
+ }
+ n2->type = NBACKGND;
+ }
+ }
+ if (n1 == NULL) {
+ n1 = n2;
+ }
+ else {
+ n3 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nbinary));
+ n3->type = NSEMI;
+ n3->nbinary.ch1 = n1;
+ n3->nbinary.ch2 = n2;
+ n1 = n3;
+ }
+ switch (tok) {
+ case TBACKGND:
+ case TSEMI:
+ tok = readtoken();
+ /* fall through */
+ case TNL:
+ if (tok == TNL) {
+ parseheredoc();
+ if (nlflag == 1)
+ return n1;
+ } else {
+ tokpushback++;
+ }
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ if (tokendlist[peektoken()])
+ return n1;
+ break;
+ case TEOF:
+ if (heredoclist)
+ parseheredoc();
+ else
+ pungetc(); /* push back EOF on input */
+ return n1;
+ default:
+ if (nlflag == 1)
+ synexpect(-1);
+ tokpushback++;
+ return n1;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+andor(void)
+{
+ union node *n1, *n2, *n3;
+ int t;
+
+ n1 = pipeline();
+ for (;;) {
+ if ((t = readtoken()) == TAND) {
+ t = NAND;
+ } else if (t == TOR) {
+ t = NOR;
+ } else {
+ tokpushback++;
+ return n1;
+ }
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ n2 = pipeline();
+ n3 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nbinary));
+ n3->type = t;
+ n3->nbinary.ch1 = n1;
+ n3->nbinary.ch2 = n2;
+ n1 = n3;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+pipeline(void)
+{
+ union node *n1, *n2, *pipenode;
+ struct nodelist *lp, *prev;
+ int negate;
+
+ negate = 0;
+ TRACE(("pipeline: entered\n"));
+ if (readtoken() == TNOT) {
+ negate = !negate;
+ checkkwd = CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ } else
+ tokpushback++;
+ n1 = command();
+ if (readtoken() == TPIPE) {
+ pipenode = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct npipe));
+ pipenode->type = NPIPE;
+ pipenode->npipe.backgnd = 0;
+ lp = (struct nodelist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ pipenode->npipe.cmdlist = lp;
+ lp->n = n1;
+ do {
+ prev = lp;
+ lp = (struct nodelist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ lp->n = command();
+ prev->next = lp;
+ } while (readtoken() == TPIPE);
+ lp->next = NULL;
+ n1 = pipenode;
+ }
+ tokpushback++;
+ if (negate) {
+ n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nnot));
+ n2->type = NNOT;
+ n2->nnot.com = n1;
+ return n2;
+ } else
+ return n1;
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+command(void)
+{
+ union node *n1, *n2;
+ union node *ap, **app;
+ union node *cp, **cpp;
+ union node *redir, **rpp;
+ union node **rpp2;
+ int t;
+ int savelinno;
+
+ redir = NULL;
+ rpp2 = &redir;
+
+ savelinno = plinno;
+
+ switch (readtoken()) {
+ default:
+ synexpect(-1);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ case TIF:
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nif));
+ n1->type = NIF;
+ n1->nif.test = list(0);
+ if (readtoken() != TTHEN)
+ synexpect(TTHEN);
+ n1->nif.ifpart = list(0);
+ n2 = n1;
+ while (readtoken() == TELIF) {
+ n2->nif.elsepart = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nif));
+ n2 = n2->nif.elsepart;
+ n2->type = NIF;
+ n2->nif.test = list(0);
+ if (readtoken() != TTHEN)
+ synexpect(TTHEN);
+ n2->nif.ifpart = list(0);
+ }
+ if (lasttoken == TELSE)
+ n2->nif.elsepart = list(0);
+ else {
+ n2->nif.elsepart = NULL;
+ tokpushback++;
+ }
+ t = TFI;
+ break;
+ case TWHILE:
+ case TUNTIL: {
+ int got;
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nbinary));
+ n1->type = (lasttoken == TWHILE)? NWHILE : NUNTIL;
+ n1->nbinary.ch1 = list(0);
+ if ((got=readtoken()) != TDO) {
+TRACE(("expecting DO got %s %s\n", tokname[got], got == TWORD ? wordtext : ""));
+ synexpect(TDO);
+ }
+ n1->nbinary.ch2 = list(0);
+ t = TDONE;
+ break;
+ }
+ case TFOR:
+ if (readtoken() != TWORD || quoteflag || ! goodname(wordtext))
+ synerror("Bad for loop variable");
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nfor));
+ n1->type = NFOR;
+ n1->nfor.linno = savelinno;
+ n1->nfor.var = wordtext;
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ if (readtoken() == TIN) {
+ app = &ap;
+ while (readtoken() == TWORD) {
+ n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n2->type = NARG;
+ n2->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n2->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ *app = n2;
+ app = &n2->narg.next;
+ }
+ *app = NULL;
+ n1->nfor.args = ap;
+ if (lasttoken != TNL && lasttoken != TSEMI)
+ synexpect(-1);
+ } else {
+ n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n2->type = NARG;
+ n2->narg.text = (char *)dolatstr;
+ n2->narg.backquote = NULL;
+ n2->narg.next = NULL;
+ n1->nfor.args = n2;
+ /*
+ * Newline or semicolon here is optional (but note
+ * that the original Bourne shell only allowed NL).
+ */
+ if (lasttoken != TSEMI)
+ tokpushback++;
+ }
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ if (readtoken() != TDO)
+ synexpect(TDO);
+ n1->nfor.body = list(0);
+ t = TDONE;
+ break;
+ case TCASE:
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct ncase));
+ n1->type = NCASE;
+ n1->ncase.linno = savelinno;
+ if (readtoken() != TWORD)
+ synexpect(TWORD);
+ n1->ncase.expr = n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n2->type = NARG;
+ n2->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n2->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ n2->narg.next = NULL;
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ if (readtoken() != TIN)
+ synexpect(TIN);
+ cpp = &n1->ncase.cases;
+next_case:
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD;
+ t = readtoken();
+ while(t != TESAC) {
+ if (lasttoken == TLP)
+ readtoken();
+ *cpp = cp = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nclist));
+ cp->type = NCLIST;
+ app = &cp->nclist.pattern;
+ for (;;) {
+ *app = ap = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ ap->type = NARG;
+ ap->narg.text = wordtext;
+ ap->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ if (readtoken() != TPIPE)
+ break;
+ app = &ap->narg.next;
+ readtoken();
+ }
+ ap->narg.next = NULL;
+ if (lasttoken != TRP)
+ synexpect(TRP);
+ cp->nclist.body = list(2);
+
+ cpp = &cp->nclist.next;
+
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD;
+ if ((t = readtoken()) != TESAC) {
+ if (t != TENDCASE)
+ synexpect(TENDCASE);
+ else
+ goto next_case;
+ }
+ }
+ *cpp = NULL;
+ goto redir;
+ case TLP:
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nredir));
+ n1->type = NSUBSHELL;
+ n1->nredir.linno = savelinno;
+ n1->nredir.n = list(0);
+ n1->nredir.redirect = NULL;
+ t = TRP;
+ break;
+ case TBEGIN:
+ n1 = list(0);
+ t = TEND;
+ break;
+ case TWORD:
+ case TREDIR:
+ tokpushback++;
+ return simplecmd();
+ }
+
+ if (readtoken() != t)
+ synexpect(t);
+
+redir:
+ /* Now check for redirection which may follow command */
+ checkkwd = CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ rpp = rpp2;
+ while (readtoken() == TREDIR) {
+ *rpp = n2 = redirnode;
+ rpp = &n2->nfile.next;
+ parsefname();
+ }
+ tokpushback++;
+ *rpp = NULL;
+ if (redir) {
+ if (n1->type != NSUBSHELL) {
+ n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nredir));
+ n2->type = NREDIR;
+ n2->nredir.linno = savelinno;
+ n2->nredir.n = n1;
+ n1 = n2;
+ }
+ n1->nredir.redirect = redir;
+ }
+
+ return n1;
+}
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+simplecmd(void) {
+ union node *args, **app;
+ union node *n = NULL;
+ union node *vars, **vpp;
+ union node **rpp, *redir;
+ int savecheckkwd;
+ int savelinno;
+
+ args = NULL;
+ app = &args;
+ vars = NULL;
+ vpp = &vars;
+ redir = NULL;
+ rpp = &redir;
+
+ savecheckkwd = CHKALIAS;
+ savelinno = plinno;
+ for (;;) {
+ checkkwd = savecheckkwd;
+ switch (readtoken()) {
+ case TWORD:
+ n = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n->type = NARG;
+ n->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ if (savecheckkwd && isassignment(wordtext)) {
+ *vpp = n;
+ vpp = &n->narg.next;
+ } else {
+ *app = n;
+ app = &n->narg.next;
+ savecheckkwd = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+ case TREDIR:
+ *rpp = n = redirnode;
+ rpp = &n->nfile.next;
+ parsefname(); /* read name of redirection file */
+ break;
+ case TLP:
+ if (
+ args && app == &args->narg.next &&
+ !vars && !redir
+ ) {
+ struct builtincmd *bcmd;
+ const char *name;
+
+ /* We have a function */
+ if (readtoken() != TRP)
+ synexpect(TRP);
+ name = n->narg.text;
+ if (
+ !goodname(name) || (
+ (bcmd = find_builtin(name)) &&
+ bcmd->flags & BUILTIN_SPECIAL
+ )
+ )
+ synerror("Bad function name");
+ n->type = NDEFUN;
+ checkkwd = CHKNL | CHKKWD | CHKALIAS;
+ n->ndefun.text = n->narg.text;
+ n->ndefun.linno = plinno;
+ n->ndefun.body = command();
+ return n;
+ }
+ /* fall through */
+ default:
+ tokpushback++;
+ goto out;
+ }
+ }
+out:
+ *app = NULL;
+ *vpp = NULL;
+ *rpp = NULL;
+ n = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct ncmd));
+ n->type = NCMD;
+ n->ncmd.linno = savelinno;
+ n->ncmd.args = args;
+ n->ncmd.assign = vars;
+ n->ncmd.redirect = redir;
+ return n;
+}
+
+STATIC union node *
+makename(void)
+{
+ union node *n;
+
+ n = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n->type = NARG;
+ n->narg.next = NULL;
+ n->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ return n;
+}
+
+void fixredir(union node *n, const char *text, int err)
+ {
+ TRACE(("Fix redir %s %d\n", text, err));
+ if (!err)
+ n->ndup.vname = NULL;
+
+ if (is_digit(text[0]) && text[1] == '\0')
+ n->ndup.dupfd = digit_val(text[0]);
+ else if (text[0] == '-' && text[1] == '\0')
+ n->ndup.dupfd = -1;
+ else {
+
+ if (err)
+ synerror("Bad fd number");
+ else
+ n->ndup.vname = makename();
+ }
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+parsefname(void)
+{
+ union node *n = redirnode;
+
+ if (n->type == NHERE)
+ checkkwd = CHKEOFMARK;
+ if (readtoken() != TWORD)
+ synexpect(-1);
+ if (n->type == NHERE) {
+ struct heredoc *here = heredoc;
+ struct heredoc *p;
+
+ if (quoteflag == 0)
+ n->type = NXHERE;
+ TRACE(("Here document %d\n", n->type));
+ rmescapes(wordtext);
+ here->eofmark = wordtext;
+ here->next = NULL;
+ if (heredoclist == NULL)
+ heredoclist = here;
+ else {
+ for (p = heredoclist ; p->next ; p = p->next);
+ p->next = here;
+ }
+ } else if (n->type == NTOFD || n->type == NFROMFD) {
+ fixredir(n, wordtext, 0);
+ } else {
+ n->nfile.fname = makename();
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Input any here documents.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+parseheredoc(void)
+{
+ struct heredoc *here;
+ union node *n;
+
+ here = heredoclist;
+ heredoclist = 0;
+
+ while (here) {
+ if (needprompt) {
+ setprompt(2);
+ }
+ readtoken1(pgetc(), here->here->type == NHERE? SQSYNTAX : DQSYNTAX,
+ here->eofmark, here->striptabs);
+ n = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n->narg.type = NARG;
+ n->narg.next = NULL;
+ n->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ here->here->nhere.doc = n;
+ here = here->next;
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC int
+peektoken(void)
+{
+ int t;
+
+ t = readtoken();
+ tokpushback++;
+ return (t);
+}
+
+STATIC int
+readtoken(void)
+{
+ int t;
+ int kwd = checkkwd;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ int alreadyseen = tokpushback;
+#endif
+
+top:
+ t = xxreadtoken();
+
+ /*
+ * eat newlines
+ */
+ if (kwd & CHKNL) {
+ while (t == TNL) {
+ parseheredoc();
+ t = xxreadtoken();
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (t != TWORD || quoteflag) {
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * check for keywords
+ */
+ if (kwd & CHKKWD) {
+ const char *const *pp;
+
+ if ((pp = findkwd(wordtext))) {
+ lasttoken = t = pp - parsekwd + KWDOFFSET;
+ TRACE(("keyword %s recognized\n", tokname[t]));
+ goto out;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (checkkwd & CHKALIAS) {
+ struct alias *ap;
+ if ((ap = lookupalias(wordtext, 1)) != NULL) {
+ if (*ap->val) {
+ pushstring(ap->val, ap);
+ }
+ goto top;
+ }
+ }
+out:
+ checkkwd = 0;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (!alreadyseen)
+ TRACE(("token %s %s\n", tokname[t], t == TWORD ? wordtext : ""));
+ else
+ TRACE(("reread token %s %s\n", tokname[t], t == TWORD ? wordtext : ""));
+#endif
+ return (t);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Read the next input token.
+ * If the token is a word, we set backquotelist to the list of cmds in
+ * backquotes. We set quoteflag to true if any part of the word was
+ * quoted.
+ * If the token is TREDIR, then we set redirnode to a structure containing
+ * the redirection.
+ *
+ * [Change comment: here documents and internal procedures]
+ * [Readtoken shouldn't have any arguments. Perhaps we should make the
+ * word parsing code into a separate routine. In this case, readtoken
+ * doesn't need to have any internal procedures, but parseword does.
+ * We could also make parseoperator in essence the main routine, and
+ * have parseword (readtoken1?) handle both words and redirection.]
+ */
+
+#define RETURN(token) return lasttoken = token
+
+STATIC int
+xxreadtoken(void)
+{
+ int c;
+
+ if (tokpushback) {
+ tokpushback = 0;
+ return lasttoken;
+ }
+ if (needprompt) {
+ setprompt(2);
+ }
+ for (;;) { /* until token or start of word found */
+ c = pgetc_macro();
+ switch (c) {
+ case ' ': case '\t':
+ case PEOA:
+ continue;
+ case '#':
+ while ((c = pgetc()) != '\n' && c != PEOF);
+ pungetc();
+ continue;
+ case '\\':
+ if (pgetc() == '\n') {
+ plinno++;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(2);
+ continue;
+ }
+ pungetc();
+ goto breakloop;
+ case '\n':
+ plinno++;
+ needprompt = doprompt;
+ RETURN(TNL);
+ case PEOF:
+ RETURN(TEOF);
+ case '&':
+ if (pgetc() == '&')
+ RETURN(TAND);
+ pungetc();
+ RETURN(TBACKGND);
+ case '|':
+ if (pgetc() == '|')
+ RETURN(TOR);
+ pungetc();
+ RETURN(TPIPE);
+ case ';':
+ if (pgetc() == ';')
+ RETURN(TENDCASE);
+ pungetc();
+ RETURN(TSEMI);
+ case '(':
+ RETURN(TLP);
+ case ')':
+ RETURN(TRP);
+ default:
+ goto breakloop;
+ }
+ }
+breakloop:
+ return readtoken1(c, BASESYNTAX, (char *)NULL, 0);
+#undef RETURN
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * If eofmark is NULL, read a word or a redirection symbol. If eofmark
+ * is not NULL, read a here document. In the latter case, eofmark is the
+ * word which marks the end of the document and striptabs is true if
+ * leading tabs should be stripped from the document. The argument firstc
+ * is the first character of the input token or document.
+ *
+ * Because C does not have internal subroutines, I have simulated them
+ * using goto's to implement the subroutine linkage. The following macros
+ * will run code that appears at the end of readtoken1.
+ */
+
+#define CHECKEND() {goto checkend; checkend_return:;}
+#define PARSEREDIR() {goto parseredir; parseredir_return:;}
+#define PARSESUB() {goto parsesub; parsesub_return:;}
+#define PARSEBACKQOLD() {oldstyle = 1; goto parsebackq; parsebackq_oldreturn:;}
+#define PARSEBACKQNEW() {oldstyle = 0; goto parsebackq; parsebackq_newreturn:;}
+#define PARSEARITH() {goto parsearith; parsearith_return:;}
+
+STATIC int
+readtoken1(int firstc, char const *syntax, char *eofmark, int striptabs)
+{
+ int c = firstc;
+ char *out;
+ size_t len;
+ struct nodelist *bqlist;
+ int quotef;
+ int dblquote;
+ int varnest; /* levels of variables expansion */
+ int arinest; /* levels of arithmetic expansion */
+ int parenlevel; /* levels of parens in arithmetic */
+ int dqvarnest; /* levels of variables expansion within double quotes */
+ int oldstyle;
+ /* syntax before arithmetic */
+ char const *uninitialized_var(prevsyntax);
+
+ dblquote = 0;
+ if (syntax == DQSYNTAX)
+ dblquote = 1;
+ quotef = 0;
+ bqlist = NULL;
+ varnest = 0;
+ arinest = 0;
+ parenlevel = 0;
+ dqvarnest = 0;
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(out);
+ loop: { /* for each line, until end of word */
+#if ATTY
+ if (c == '\034' && doprompt
+ && attyset() && ! equal(termval(), "emacs")) {
+ attyline();
+ if (syntax == BASESYNTAX)
+ return readtoken();
+ c = pgetc();
+ goto loop;
+ }
+#endif
+ CHECKEND(); /* set c to PEOF if at end of here document */
+ for (;;) { /* until end of line or end of word */
+ CHECKSTRSPACE(4, out); /* permit 4 calls to USTPUTC */
+ switch(syntax[c]) {
+ case CNL: /* '\n' */
+ if (syntax == BASESYNTAX)
+ goto endword; /* exit outer loop */
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ plinno++;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(2);
+ c = pgetc();
+ goto loop; /* continue outer loop */
+ case CWORD:
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ break;
+ case CCTL:
+ if (eofmark == NULL || dblquote)
+ USTPUTC(CTLESC, out);
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ break;
+ /* backslash */
+ case CBACK:
+ c = pgetc2();
+ if (c == PEOF) {
+ USTPUTC(CTLESC, out);
+ USTPUTC('\\', out);
+ pungetc();
+ } else if (c == '\n') {
+ plinno++;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(2);
+ } else {
+ if (
+ dblquote &&
+ c != '\\' && c != '`' &&
+ c != '$' && (
+ c != '"' ||
+ eofmark != NULL
+ )
+ ) {
+ USTPUTC('\\', out);
+ }
+ USTPUTC(CTLESC, out);
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ quotef++;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CSQUOTE:
+ syntax = SQSYNTAX;
+quotemark:
+ if (eofmark == NULL) {
+ USTPUTC(CTLQUOTEMARK, out);
+ }
+ break;
+ case CDQUOTE:
+ syntax = DQSYNTAX;
+ dblquote = 1;
+ goto quotemark;
+ case CENDQUOTE:
+ if (eofmark && !varnest)
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ else {
+ if (dqvarnest == 0) {
+ syntax = BASESYNTAX;
+ dblquote = 0;
+ }
+ quotef++;
+ goto quotemark;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CVAR: /* '$' */
+ PARSESUB(); /* parse substitution */
+ break;
+ case CENDVAR: /* '}' */
+ if (varnest > 0) {
+ varnest--;
+ if (dqvarnest > 0) {
+ dqvarnest--;
+ }
+ USTPUTC(CTLENDVAR, out);
+ } else {
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ }
+ break;
+ case CLP: /* '(' in arithmetic */
+ parenlevel++;
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ break;
+ case CRP: /* ')' in arithmetic */
+ if (parenlevel > 0) {
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ --parenlevel;
+ } else {
+ if (pgetc() == ')') {
+ USTPUTC(CTLENDARI, out);
+ if (!--arinest)
+ syntax = prevsyntax;
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * unbalanced parens
+ * (don't 2nd guess - no error)
+ */
+ pungetc();
+ USTPUTC(')', out);
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ case CBQUOTE: /* '`' */
+ PARSEBACKQOLD();
+ break;
+ case CEOF:
+ goto endword; /* exit outer loop */
+ case CIGN:
+ break;
+ default:
+ if (varnest == 0)
+ goto endword; /* exit outer loop */
+ if (c != PEOA) {
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ }
+ }
+ c = pgetc_macro();
+ }
+ }
+endword:
+ if (syntax == ARISYNTAX)
+ synerror("Missing '))'");
+ if (syntax != BASESYNTAX && eofmark == NULL)
+ synerror("Unterminated quoted string");
+ if (varnest != 0) {
+ /* { */
+ synerror("Missing '}'");
+ }
+ USTPUTC('\0', out);
+ len = out - (char *)stackblock();
+ out = stackblock();
+ if (eofmark == NULL) {
+ if ((c == '>' || c == '<')
+ && quotef == 0
+ && len <= 2
+ && (*out == '\0' || is_digit(*out))) {
+ PARSEREDIR();
+ return lasttoken = TREDIR;
+ } else {
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ }
+ quoteflag = quotef;
+ backquotelist = bqlist;
+ grabstackblock(len);
+ wordtext = out;
+ return lasttoken = TWORD;
+/* end of readtoken routine */
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Check to see whether we are at the end of the here document. When this
+ * is called, c is set to the first character of the next input line. If
+ * we are at the end of the here document, this routine sets the c to PEOF.
+ */
+
+checkend: {
+ if (realeofmark(eofmark)) {
+ int markloc;
+ char *p;
+
+ if (c == PEOA) {
+ c = pgetc2();
+ }
+ if (striptabs) {
+ while (c == '\t') {
+ c = pgetc2();
+ }
+ }
+
+ markloc = out - (char *)stackblock();
+ for (p = eofmark; STPUTC(c, out), *p; p++) {
+ if (c != *p)
+ goto more_heredoc;
+
+ c = pgetc2();
+ }
+
+ if (c == '\n' || c == PEOF) {
+ c = PEOF;
+ plinno++;
+ needprompt = doprompt;
+ } else {
+ int len;
+
+more_heredoc:
+ p = (char *)stackblock() + markloc + 1;
+ len = out - p;
+
+ if (len) {
+ len -= c < 0;
+ c = p[-1];
+
+ if (len) {
+ char *str;
+
+ str = alloca(len + 1);
+ *(char *)mempcpy(str, p, len) = 0;
+
+ pushstring(str, NULL);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ STADJUST((char *)stackblock() + markloc - out, out);
+ }
+ goto checkend_return;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse a redirection operator. The variable "out" points to a string
+ * specifying the fd to be redirected. The variable "c" contains the
+ * first character of the redirection operator.
+ */
+
+parseredir: {
+ char fd = *out;
+ union node *np;
+
+ np = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nfile));
+ if (c == '>') {
+ np->nfile.fd = 1;
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (c == '>')
+ np->type = NAPPEND;
+ else if (c == '|')
+ np->type = NCLOBBER;
+ else if (c == '&')
+ np->type = NTOFD;
+ else {
+ np->type = NTO;
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ } else { /* c == '<' */
+ np->nfile.fd = 0;
+ switch (c = pgetc()) {
+ case '<':
+ if (sizeof (struct nfile) != sizeof (struct nhere)) {
+ np = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nhere));
+ np->nfile.fd = 0;
+ }
+ np->type = NHERE;
+ heredoc = (struct heredoc *)stalloc(sizeof (struct heredoc));
+ heredoc->here = np;
+ if ((c = pgetc()) == '-') {
+ heredoc->striptabs = 1;
+ } else {
+ heredoc->striptabs = 0;
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case '&':
+ np->type = NFROMFD;
+ break;
+
+ case '>':
+ np->type = NFROMTO;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ np->type = NFROM;
+ pungetc();
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (fd != '\0')
+ np->nfile.fd = digit_val(fd);
+ redirnode = np;
+ goto parseredir_return;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse a substitution. At this point, we have read the dollar sign
+ * and nothing else.
+ */
+
+parsesub: {
+ int subtype;
+ int typeloc;
+ char *p;
+ static const char types[] = "}-+?=";
+
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (
+ (checkkwd & CHKEOFMARK) ||
+ c <= PEOA ||
+ (c != '(' && c != '{' && !is_name(c) && !is_special(c))
+ ) {
+ USTPUTC('$', out);
+ pungetc();
+ } else if (c == '(') { /* $(command) or $((arith)) */
+ if (pgetc() == '(') {
+ PARSEARITH();
+ } else {
+ pungetc();
+ PARSEBACKQNEW();
+ }
+ } else {
+ USTPUTC(CTLVAR, out);
+ typeloc = out - (char *)stackblock();
+ STADJUST(1, out);
+ subtype = VSNORMAL;
+ if (likely(c == '{')) {
+ c = pgetc();
+ subtype = 0;
+ }
+varname:
+ if (is_name(c)) {
+ do {
+ STPUTC(c, out);
+ c = pgetc();
+ } while (is_in_name(c));
+ } else if (is_digit(c)) {
+ do {
+ STPUTC(c, out);
+ c = pgetc();
+ } while (is_digit(c));
+ }
+ else if (is_special(c)) {
+ int cc = c;
+
+ c = pgetc();
+
+ if (!subtype && cc == '#') {
+ subtype = VSLENGTH;
+
+ if (c == '_' || isalnum(c))
+ goto varname;
+
+ cc = c;
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (cc == '}' || c != '}') {
+ pungetc();
+ subtype = 0;
+ c = cc;
+ cc = '#';
+ }
+ }
+
+ USTPUTC(cc, out);
+ }
+ else
+ goto badsub;
+
+ if (subtype == 0) {
+ switch (c) {
+ case ':':
+ subtype = VSNUL;
+ c = pgetc();
+ /*FALLTHROUGH*/
+ default:
+ p = strchr(types, c);
+ if (p == NULL)
+ break;
+ subtype |= p - types + VSNORMAL;
+ break;
+ case '%':
+ case '#':
+ {
+ int cc = c;
+ subtype = c == '#' ? VSTRIMLEFT :
+ VSTRIMRIGHT;
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (c == cc)
+ subtype++;
+ else
+ pungetc();
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ } else {
+badsub:
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ *((char *)stackblock() + typeloc) = subtype;
+ if (subtype != VSNORMAL) {
+ varnest++;
+ if (dblquote)
+ dqvarnest++;
+ }
+ STPUTC('=', out);
+ }
+ goto parsesub_return;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to parse command substitutions. Newstyle is set if the command
+ * is enclosed inside $(...); nlpp is a pointer to the head of the linked
+ * list of commands (passed by reference), and savelen is the number of
+ * characters on the top of the stack which must be preserved.
+ */
+
+parsebackq: {
+ struct nodelist **nlpp;
+ union node *n;
+ char *str;
+ size_t savelen;
+ int uninitialized_var(saveprompt);
+
+ str = NULL;
+ savelen = out - (char *)stackblock();
+ if (savelen > 0) {
+ str = alloca(savelen);
+ memcpy(str, stackblock(), savelen);
+ }
+ if (oldstyle) {
+ /* We must read until the closing backquote, giving special
+ treatment to some slashes, and then push the string and
+ reread it as input, interpreting it normally. */
+ char *pout;
+ int pc;
+ size_t psavelen;
+ char *pstr;
+
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(pout);
+ for (;;) {
+ if (needprompt) {
+ setprompt(2);
+ }
+ switch (pc = pgetc()) {
+ case '`':
+ goto done;
+
+ case '\\':
+ if ((pc = pgetc()) == '\n') {
+ plinno++;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(2);
+ /*
+ * If eating a newline, avoid putting
+ * the newline into the new character
+ * stream (via the STPUTC after the
+ * switch).
+ */
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (pc != '\\' && pc != '`' && pc != '$'
+ && (!dblquote || pc != '"'))
+ STPUTC('\\', pout);
+ if (pc > PEOA) {
+ break;
+ }
+ /* fall through */
+
+ case PEOF:
+ case PEOA:
+ synerror("EOF in backquote substitution");
+
+ case '\n':
+ plinno++;
+ needprompt = doprompt;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ STPUTC(pc, pout);
+ }
+done:
+ STPUTC('\0', pout);
+ psavelen = pout - (char *)stackblock();
+ if (psavelen > 0) {
+ pstr = grabstackstr(pout);
+ setinputstring(pstr);
+ }
+ }
+ nlpp = &bqlist;
+ while (*nlpp)
+ nlpp = &(*nlpp)->next;
+ *nlpp = (struct nodelist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ (*nlpp)->next = NULL;
+
+ if (oldstyle) {
+ saveprompt = doprompt;
+ doprompt = 0;
+ }
+
+ n = list(2);
+
+ if (oldstyle)
+ doprompt = saveprompt;
+ else {
+ if (readtoken() != TRP)
+ synexpect(TRP);
+ }
+
+ (*nlpp)->n = n;
+ if (oldstyle) {
+ /*
+ * Start reading from old file again, ignoring any pushed back
+ * tokens left from the backquote parsing
+ */
+ popfile();
+ tokpushback = 0;
+ }
+ while (stackblocksize() <= savelen)
+ growstackblock();
+ STARTSTACKSTR(out);
+ if (str) {
+ memcpy(out, str, savelen);
+ STADJUST(savelen, out);
+ }
+ USTPUTC(CTLBACKQ, out);
+ if (oldstyle)
+ goto parsebackq_oldreturn;
+ else
+ goto parsebackq_newreturn;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Parse an arithmetic expansion (indicate start of one and set state)
+ */
+parsearith: {
+
+ if (++arinest == 1) {
+ prevsyntax = syntax;
+ syntax = ARISYNTAX;
+ }
+ USTPUTC(CTLARI, out);
+ goto parsearith_return;
+}
+
+} /* end of readtoken */
+
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "parser.h"
+RESET {
+ tokpushback = 0;
+ checkkwd = 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Return of a legal variable name (a letter or underscore followed by zero or
+ * more letters, underscores, and digits).
+ */
+
+char *
+endofname(const char *name)
+ {
+ char *p;
+
+ p = (char *) name;
+ if (! is_name(*p))
+ return p;
+ while (*++p) {
+ if (! is_in_name(*p))
+ break;
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called when an unexpected token is read during the parse. The argument
+ * is the token that is expected, or -1 if more than one type of token can
+ * occur at this point.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+synexpect(int token)
+{
+ char msg[64];
+
+ if (token >= 0) {
+ fmtstr(msg, 64, "%s unexpected (expecting %s)",
+ tokname[lasttoken], tokname[token]);
+ } else {
+ fmtstr(msg, 64, "%s unexpected", tokname[lasttoken]);
+ }
+ synerror(msg);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+synerror(const char *msg)
+{
+ errlinno = plinno;
+ sh_error("Syntax error: %s", msg);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+STATIC void
+setprompt(int which)
+{
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ int show;
+
+ needprompt = 0;
+ whichprompt = which;
+
+#ifdef SMALL
+ show = 1;
+#else
+ show = !el;
+#endif
+ if (show) {
+ pushstackmark(&smark, stackblocksize());
+ out2str(getprompt(NULL));
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ }
+}
+
+const char *
+expandstr(const char *ps)
+{
+ union node n;
+ int saveprompt;
+
+ /* XXX Fix (char *) cast. */
+ setinputstring((char *)ps);
+
+ saveprompt = doprompt;
+ doprompt = 0;
+
+ readtoken1(pgetc(), DQSYNTAX, FAKEEOFMARK, 0);
+
+ doprompt = saveprompt;
+
+ popfile();
+
+ n.narg.type = NARG;
+ n.narg.next = NULL;
+ n.narg.text = wordtext;
+ n.narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+
+ expandarg(&n, NULL, EXP_QUOTED);
+ return stackblock();
+}
+
+/*
+ * called by editline -- any expansions to the prompt
+ * should be added here.
+ */
+const char *
+getprompt(void *unused)
+{
+ const char *prompt;
+
+ switch (whichprompt) {
+ default:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ return "<internal prompt error>";
+#endif
+ case 0:
+ return nullstr;
+ case 1:
+ prompt = ps1val();
+ break;
+ case 2:
+ prompt = ps2val();
+ break;
+ }
+
+ return expandstr(prompt);
+}
+
+const char *const *
+findkwd(const char *s)
+{
+ return findstring(
+ s, parsekwd, sizeof(parsekwd) / sizeof(const char *)
+ );
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/parser.h b/usr/dash/parser.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e6caed6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/parser.h
@@ -0,0 +1,93 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)parser.h 8.3 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+/* control characters in argument strings */
+#define CTL_FIRST -127 /* first 'special' character */
+#define CTLESC -127 /* escape next character */
+#define CTLVAR -126 /* variable defn */
+#define CTLENDVAR -125
+#define CTLBACKQ -124
+#define CTLARI -122 /* arithmetic expression */
+#define CTLENDARI -121
+#define CTLQUOTEMARK -120
+#define CTL_LAST -120 /* last 'special' character */
+
+/* variable substitution byte (follows CTLVAR) */
+#define VSTYPE 0x0f /* type of variable substitution */
+#define VSNUL 0x10 /* colon--treat the empty string as unset */
+
+/* values of VSTYPE field */
+#define VSNORMAL 0x1 /* normal variable: $var or ${var} */
+#define VSMINUS 0x2 /* ${var-text} */
+#define VSPLUS 0x3 /* ${var+text} */
+#define VSQUESTION 0x4 /* ${var?message} */
+#define VSASSIGN 0x5 /* ${var=text} */
+#define VSTRIMRIGHT 0x6 /* ${var%pattern} */
+#define VSTRIMRIGHTMAX 0x7 /* ${var%%pattern} */
+#define VSTRIMLEFT 0x8 /* ${var#pattern} */
+#define VSTRIMLEFTMAX 0x9 /* ${var##pattern} */
+#define VSLENGTH 0xa /* ${#var} */
+
+/* values of checkkwd variable */
+#define CHKALIAS 0x1
+#define CHKKWD 0x2
+#define CHKNL 0x4
+#define CHKEOFMARK 0x8
+
+
+/*
+ * NEOF is returned by parsecmd when it encounters an end of file. It
+ * must be distinct from NULL, so we use the address of a variable that
+ * happens to be handy.
+ */
+extern int tokpushback;
+#define NEOF ((union node *)&tokpushback)
+extern int whichprompt; /* 1 == PS1, 2 == PS2 */
+extern int checkkwd;
+
+
+union node *parsecmd(int);
+void fixredir(union node *, const char *, int);
+const char *getprompt(void *);
+const char *const *findkwd(const char *);
+char *endofname(const char *);
+const char *expandstr(const char *);
+
+static inline int
+goodname(const char *p)
+{
+ return !*endofname(p);
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/redir.c b/usr/dash/redir.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f96a76b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/redir.c
@@ -0,0 +1,459 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/param.h> /* PIPE_BUF */
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+
+/*
+ * Code for dealing with input/output redirection.
+ */
+
+#include "main.h"
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+
+
+#define REALLY_CLOSED -3 /* fd that was closed and still is */
+#define EMPTY -2 /* marks an unused slot in redirtab */
+#define CLOSED -1 /* fd opened for redir needs to be closed */
+
+#ifndef PIPE_BUF
+# define PIPESIZE 4096 /* amount of buffering in a pipe */
+#else
+# define PIPESIZE PIPE_BUF
+#endif
+
+
+MKINIT
+struct redirtab {
+ struct redirtab *next;
+ int renamed[10];
+};
+
+
+MKINIT struct redirtab *redirlist;
+
+STATIC int openredirect(union node *);
+#ifdef notyet
+STATIC void dupredirect(union node *, int, char[10]);
+#else
+STATIC void dupredirect(union node *, int);
+#endif
+STATIC int openhere(union node *);
+
+
+/*
+ * Process a list of redirection commands. If the REDIR_PUSH flag is set,
+ * old file descriptors are stashed away so that the redirection can be
+ * undone by calling popredir. If the REDIR_BACKQ flag is set, then the
+ * standard output, and the standard error if it becomes a duplicate of
+ * stdout, is saved in memory.
+ */
+
+void
+redirect(union node *redir, int flags)
+{
+ union node *n;
+ struct redirtab *sv;
+ int i;
+ int fd;
+ int newfd;
+ int *p;
+#if notyet
+ char memory[10]; /* file descriptors to write to memory */
+
+ for (i = 10 ; --i >= 0 ; )
+ memory[i] = 0;
+ memory[1] = flags & REDIR_BACKQ;
+#endif
+ if (!redir)
+ return;
+ sv = NULL;
+ INTOFF;
+ if (likely(flags & REDIR_PUSH))
+ sv = redirlist;
+ n = redir;
+ do {
+ newfd = openredirect(n);
+ if (newfd < -1)
+ continue;
+
+ fd = n->nfile.fd;
+
+ if (sv) {
+ p = &sv->renamed[fd];
+ i = *p;
+
+ if (likely(i == EMPTY)) {
+ i = CLOSED;
+ if (fd != newfd) {
+ i = savefd(fd, fd);
+ fd = -1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (i == newfd)
+ /* Can only happen if i == newfd == CLOSED */
+ i = REALLY_CLOSED;
+
+ *p = i;
+ }
+
+ if (fd == newfd)
+ continue;
+
+#ifdef notyet
+ dupredirect(n, newfd, memory);
+#else
+ dupredirect(n, newfd);
+#endif
+ } while ((n = n->nfile.next));
+ INTON;
+#ifdef notyet
+ if (memory[1])
+ out1 = &memout;
+ if (memory[2])
+ out2 = &memout;
+#endif
+ if (flags & REDIR_SAVEFD2 && sv->renamed[2] >= 0)
+ preverrout.fd = sv->renamed[2];
+}
+
+
+STATIC int
+openredirect(union node *redir)
+{
+ struct stat64 sb;
+ char *fname;
+ int f;
+
+ switch (redir->nfile.type) {
+ case NFROM:
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+ if ((f = open64(fname, O_RDONLY)) < 0)
+ goto eopen;
+ break;
+ case NFROMTO:
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+ if ((f = open64(fname, O_RDWR|O_CREAT, 0666)) < 0)
+ goto ecreate;
+ break;
+ case NTO:
+ /* Take care of noclobber mode. */
+ if (Cflag) {
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+ if (stat64(fname, &sb) < 0) {
+ if ((f = open64(fname, O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_EXCL, 0666)) < 0)
+ goto ecreate;
+ } else if (!S_ISREG(sb.st_mode)) {
+ if ((f = open64(fname, O_WRONLY, 0666)) < 0)
+ goto ecreate;
+ if (fstat64(f, &sb) < 0 && S_ISREG(sb.st_mode)) {
+ close(f);
+ errno = EEXIST;
+ goto ecreate;
+ }
+ } else {
+ errno = EEXIST;
+ goto ecreate;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case NCLOBBER:
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+ if ((f = open64(fname, O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_TRUNC, 0666)) < 0)
+ goto ecreate;
+ break;
+ case NAPPEND:
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+ if ((f = open64(fname, O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_APPEND, 0666)) < 0)
+ goto ecreate;
+ break;
+ case NTOFD:
+ case NFROMFD:
+ f = redir->ndup.dupfd;
+ if (f == redir->nfile.fd)
+ f = -2;
+ break;
+ default:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ abort();
+#endif
+ /* Fall through to eliminate warning. */
+ case NHERE:
+ case NXHERE:
+ f = openhere(redir);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ return f;
+ecreate:
+ sh_error("cannot create %s: %s", fname, errmsg(errno, E_CREAT));
+eopen:
+ sh_error("cannot open %s: %s", fname, errmsg(errno, E_OPEN));
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+#ifdef notyet
+dupredirect(redir, f, memory)
+#else
+dupredirect(redir, f)
+#endif
+ union node *redir;
+ int f;
+#ifdef notyet
+ char memory[10];
+#endif
+ {
+ int fd = redir->nfile.fd;
+ int err = 0;
+
+#ifdef notyet
+ memory[fd] = 0;
+#endif
+ if (redir->nfile.type == NTOFD || redir->nfile.type == NFROMFD) {
+ /* if not ">&-" */
+ if (f >= 0) {
+#ifdef notyet
+ if (memory[f])
+ memory[fd] = 1;
+ else
+#endif
+ if (dup2(f, fd) < 0) {
+ err = errno;
+ goto err;
+ }
+ return;
+ }
+ f = fd;
+ } else if (dup2(f, fd) < 0)
+ err = errno;
+
+ close(f);
+ if (err < 0)
+ goto err;
+
+ return;
+
+err:
+ sh_error("%d: %s", f, strerror(err));
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Handle here documents. Normally we fork off a process to write the
+ * data to a pipe. If the document is short, we can stuff the data in
+ * the pipe without forking.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+openhere(union node *redir)
+{
+ char *p;
+ int pip[2];
+ size_t len = 0;
+
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0)
+ sh_error("Pipe call failed");
+
+ p = redir->nhere.doc->narg.text;
+ if (redir->type == NXHERE) {
+ expandarg(redir->nhere.doc, NULL, EXP_QUOTED);
+ p = stackblock();
+ }
+
+ len = strlen(p);
+ if (len <= PIPESIZE) {
+ xwrite(pip[1], p, len);
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ if (forkshell((struct job *)NULL, (union node *)NULL, FORK_NOJOB) == 0) {
+ close(pip[0]);
+ signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN);
+#ifdef SIGTSTP
+ signal(SIGTSTP, SIG_IGN);
+#endif
+ signal(SIGPIPE, SIG_DFL);
+ xwrite(pip[1], p, len);
+ _exit(0);
+ }
+out:
+ close(pip[1]);
+ return pip[0];
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Undo the effects of the last redirection.
+ */
+
+void
+popredir(int drop)
+{
+ struct redirtab *rp;
+ int i;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ rp = redirlist;
+ for (i = 0 ; i < 10 ; i++) {
+ switch (rp->renamed[i]) {
+ case CLOSED:
+ if (!drop)
+ close(i);
+ break;
+ case EMPTY:
+ case REALLY_CLOSED:
+ break;
+ default:
+ if (!drop)
+ dup2(rp->renamed[i], i);
+ close(rp->renamed[i]);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ redirlist = rp->next;
+ ckfree(rp);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Undo all redirections. Called on error or interrupt.
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+
+INCLUDE "redir.h"
+
+RESET {
+ /*
+ * Discard all saved file descriptors.
+ */
+ unwindredir(0);
+}
+
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Move a file descriptor to > 10. Invokes sh_error on error unless
+ * the original file dscriptor is not open.
+ */
+
+int
+savefd(int from, int ofd)
+{
+ int newfd;
+ int err;
+
+ newfd = fcntl(from, F_DUPFD, 10);
+ err = newfd < 0 ? errno : 0;
+ if (err != EBADF) {
+ close(ofd);
+ if (err)
+ sh_error("%d: %s", from, strerror(err));
+ else
+ fcntl(newfd, F_SETFD, FD_CLOEXEC);
+ }
+
+ return newfd;
+}
+
+
+int
+redirectsafe(union node *redir, int flags)
+{
+ int err;
+ volatile int saveint;
+ struct jmploc *volatile savehandler = handler;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+
+ SAVEINT(saveint);
+ if (!(err = setjmp(jmploc.loc) * 2)) {
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ redirect(redir, flags);
+ }
+ handler = savehandler;
+ if (err && exception != EXERROR)
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+ RESTOREINT(saveint);
+ return err;
+}
+
+
+void unwindredir(struct redirtab *stop)
+{
+ while (redirlist != stop)
+ popredir(0);
+}
+
+
+struct redirtab *pushredir(union node *redir)
+{
+ struct redirtab *sv;
+ struct redirtab *q;
+ int i;
+
+ q = redirlist;
+ if (!redir)
+ goto out;
+
+ sv = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct redirtab));
+ sv->next = q;
+ redirlist = sv;
+ for (i = 0; i < 10; i++)
+ sv->renamed[i] = EMPTY;
+
+out:
+ return q;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/redir.h b/usr/dash/redir.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8e56995
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/redir.h
@@ -0,0 +1,53 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)redir.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+/* flags passed to redirect */
+#define REDIR_PUSH 01 /* save previous values of file descriptors */
+#ifdef notyet
+#define REDIR_BACKQ 02 /* save the command output in memory */
+#endif
+#define REDIR_SAVEFD2 03 /* set preverrout */
+
+struct redirtab;
+union node;
+void redirect(union node *, int);
+void popredir(int);
+void clearredir(void);
+int savefd(int, int);
+int redirectsafe(union node *, int);
+void unwindredir(struct redirtab *stop);
+struct redirtab *pushredir(union node *redir);
+
diff --git a/usr/dash/sh.1 b/usr/dash/sh.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ff5881a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/sh.1
@@ -0,0 +1,2332 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\" Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+.\" Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" Kenneth Almquist.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)sh.1 8.6 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+.\"
+.Dd January 19, 2003
+.Os
+.Dt SH 1
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm sh
+.Nd command interpreter (shell)
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl aCefnuvxIimqVEb
+.Op Cm +aCefnuvxIimqVEb
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl o Ar option_name
+.Op Cm +o Ar option_name
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Ar command_file Oo Ar argument ... Oc
+.Ek
+.Nm
+.Fl c
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl aCefnuvxIimqVEb
+.Op Cm +aCefnuvxIimqVEb
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl o Ar option_name
+.Op Cm +o Ar option_name
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Ar command_string
+.Op Ar command_name Oo Ar argument ... Oc
+.Ek
+.Nm
+.Fl s
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl aCefnuvxIimqVEb
+.Op Cm +aCefnuvxIimqVEb
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl o Ar option_name
+.Op Cm +o Ar option_name
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Ar argument ...
+.Ek
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm
+is the standard command interpreter for the system.
+The current version of
+.Nm
+is in the process of being changed to conform with the
+.Tn POSIX
+1003.2 and 1003.2a specifications for the shell.
+This version has many
+features which make it appear similar in some respects to the Korn shell,
+but it is not a Korn shell clone (see
+.Xr ksh 1 ) .
+Only features designated by
+.Tn POSIX ,
+plus a few Berkeley extensions, are being incorporated into this shell.
+We expect
+.Tn POSIX
+conformance by the time 4.4 BSD is released.
+This man page is not intended
+to be a tutorial or a complete specification of the shell.
+.Ss Overview
+The shell is a command that reads lines from either a file or the
+terminal, interprets them, and generally executes other commands.
+It is the program that is running when a user logs into the system
+(although a user can select a different shell with the
+.Xr chsh 1
+command).
+The shell implements a language that has flow control
+constructs, a macro facility that provides a variety of features in
+addition to data storage, along with built in history and line editing
+capabilities.
+It incorporates many features to aid interactive use and
+has the advantage that the interpretative language is common to both
+interactive and non-interactive use (shell scripts).
+That is, commands
+can be typed directly to the running shell or can be put into a file and
+the file can be executed directly by the shell.
+.Ss Invocation
+If no args are present and if the standard input of the shell
+is connected to a terminal (or if the
+.Fl i
+flag is set),
+and the
+.Fl c
+option is not present, the shell is considered an interactive shell.
+An interactive shell generally prompts before each command and handles
+programming and command errors differently (as described below).
+When first starting,
+the shell inspects argument 0, and if it begins with a dash
+.Sq - ,
+the shell is also considered
+a login shell.
+This is normally done automatically by the system
+when the user first logs in.
+A login shell first reads commands
+from the files
+.Pa /etc/profile
+and
+.Pa .profile
+if they exist.
+If the environment variable
+.Ev ENV
+is set on entry to an interactive shell, or is set in the
+.Pa .profile
+of a login shell, the shell next reads
+commands from the file named in
+.Ev ENV .
+Therefore, a user should place commands that are to be executed only at
+login time in the
+.Pa .profile
+file, and commands that are executed for every interactive shell inside the
+.Ev ENV
+file.
+To set the
+.Ev ENV
+variable to some file, place the following line in your
+.Pa .profile
+of your home directory
+.Pp
+.Dl ENV=$HOME/.shinit; export ENV
+.Pp
+substituting for
+.Dq .shinit
+any filename you wish.
+.Pp
+If command line arguments besides the options have been specified, then
+the shell treats the first argument as the name of a file from which to
+read commands (a shell script), and the remaining arguments are set as the
+positional parameters of the shell ($1, $2, etc).
+Otherwise, the shell
+reads commands from its standard input.
+.Ss Argument List Processing
+All of the single letter options have a corresponding name that can be
+used as an argument to the
+.Fl o
+option.
+The set
+.Fl o
+name is provided next to the single letter option in
+the description below.
+Specifying a dash
+.Dq -
+turns the option on, while using a plus
+.Dq +
+disables the option.
+The following options can be set from the command line or
+with the
+.Ic set
+builtin (described later).
+.Bl -tag -width aaaallexportfoo -offset indent
+.It Fl a Em allexport
+Export all variables assigned to.
+.It Fl c
+Read commands from the
+.Ar command_string
+operand instead of from the standard input.
+Special parameter 0 will be set from the
+.Ar command_name
+operand and the positional parameters ($1, $2, etc.)
+set from the remaining argument operands.
+.It Fl C Em noclobber
+Don't overwrite existing files with
+.Dq \*[Gt] .
+.It Fl e Em errexit
+If not interactive, exit immediately if any untested command fails.
+The exit status of a command is considered to be
+explicitly tested if the command is used to control an
+.Ic if ,
+.Ic elif ,
+.Ic while ,
+or
+.Ic until ;
+or if the command is the left hand operand of an
+.Dq &&
+or
+.Dq ||
+operator.
+.It Fl f Em noglob
+Disable pathname expansion.
+.It Fl n Em noexec
+If not interactive, read commands but do not execute them.
+This is useful for checking the syntax of shell scripts.
+.It Fl u Em nounset
+Write a message to standard error when attempting to expand a variable
+that is not set, and if the shell is not interactive, exit immediately.
+.It Fl v Em verbose
+The shell writes its input to standard error as it is read.
+Useful for debugging.
+.It Fl x Em xtrace
+Write each command to standard error (preceded by a
+.Sq +\ )
+before it is executed.
+Useful for debugging.
+.It Fl I Em ignoreeof
+Ignore EOF's from input when interactive.
+.It Fl i Em interactive
+Force the shell to behave interactively.
+.It Fl m Em monitor
+Turn on job control (set automatically when interactive).
+.It Fl s Em stdin
+Read commands from standard input (set automatically if no file arguments
+are present).
+This option has no effect when set after the shell has
+already started running (i.e. with
+.Ic set ) .
+.It Fl V Em vi
+Enable the built-in
+.Xr vi 1
+command line editor (disables
+.Fl E
+if it has been set).
+.It Fl E Em emacs
+Enable the built-in
+.Xr emacs 1
+command line editor (disables
+.Fl V
+if it has been set).
+.It Fl b Em notify
+Enable asynchronous notification of background job completion.
+(UNIMPLEMENTED for 4.4alpha)
+.El
+.Ss Lexical Structure
+The shell reads input in terms of lines from a file and breaks it up into
+words at whitespace (blanks and tabs), and at certain sequences of
+characters that are special to the shell called
+.Dq operators .
+There are two types of operators: control operators and redirection
+operators (their meaning is discussed later).
+Following is a list of operators:
+.Bl -ohang -offset indent
+.It "Control operators:"
+.Dl & && \&( \&) \&; ;; | || \*[Lt]newline\*[Gt]
+.It "Redirection operators:"
+.Dl \*[Lt] \*[Gt] \*[Gt]| \*[Lt]\*[Lt] \*[Gt]\*[Gt] \*[Lt]& \*[Gt]& \*[Lt]\*[Lt]- \*[Lt]\*[Gt]
+.El
+.Ss Quoting
+Quoting is used to remove the special meaning of certain characters or
+words to the shell, such as operators, whitespace, or keywords.
+There are three types of quoting: matched single quotes,
+matched double quotes, and backslash.
+.Ss Backslash
+A backslash preserves the literal meaning of the following
+character, with the exception of
+.Aq newline .
+A backslash preceding a
+.Aq newline
+is treated as a line continuation.
+.Ss Single Quotes
+Enclosing characters in single quotes preserves the literal meaning of all
+the characters (except single quotes, making it impossible to put
+single-quotes in a single-quoted string).
+.Ss Double Quotes
+Enclosing characters within double quotes preserves the literal
+meaning of all characters except dollarsign
+.Pq $ ,
+backquote
+.Pq ` ,
+and backslash
+.Pq \e .
+The backslash inside double quotes is historically weird, and serves to
+quote only the following characters:
+.Dl $ ` \*q \e \*[Lt]newline\*[Gt] .
+Otherwise it remains literal.
+.Ss Reserved Words
+Reserved words are words that have special meaning to the
+shell and are recognized at the beginning of a line and
+after a control operator.
+The following are reserved words:
+.Bl -column while while while while while -offset indent
+.It ! Ta elif Ta fi Ta while Ta case
+.It else Ta for Ta then Ta { Ta }
+.It do Ta done Ta until Ta if Ta esac
+.El
+.Pp
+Their meaning is discussed later.
+.Ss Aliases
+An alias is a name and corresponding value set using the
+.Xr alias 1
+builtin command.
+Whenever a reserved word may occur (see above),
+and after checking for reserved words, the shell
+checks the word to see if it matches an alias.
+If it does, it replaces it in the input stream with its value.
+For example, if there is an alias called
+.Dq lf
+with the value
+.Dq "ls -F" ,
+then the input:
+.Pp
+.Dl lf foobar Aq return
+.Pp
+would become
+.Pp
+.Dl ls -F foobar Aq return
+.Pp
+Aliases provide a convenient way for naive users to create shorthands for
+commands without having to learn how to create functions with arguments.
+They can also be used to create lexically obscure code.
+This use is discouraged.
+.Ss Commands
+The shell interprets the words it reads according to a language, the
+specification of which is outside the scope of this man page (refer to the
+BNF in the
+.Tn POSIX
+1003.2 document).
+Essentially though, a line is read and if the first
+word of the line (or after a control operator) is not a reserved word,
+then the shell has recognized a simple command.
+Otherwise, a complex
+command or some other special construct may have been recognized.
+.Ss Simple Commands
+If a simple command has been recognized, the shell performs
+the following actions:
+.Bl -enum -offset indent
+.It
+Leading words of the form
+.Dq name=value
+are stripped off and assigned to the environment of the simple command.
+Redirection operators and their arguments (as described below) are
+stripped off and saved for processing.
+.It
+The remaining words are expanded as described in
+the section called
+.Dq Expansions ,
+and the first remaining word is considered the command name and the
+command is located.
+The remaining words are considered the arguments of the command.
+If no command name resulted, then the
+.Dq name=value
+variable assignments recognized in item 1 affect the current shell.
+.It
+Redirections are performed as described in the next section.
+.El
+.Ss Redirections
+Redirections are used to change where a command reads its input or sends
+its output.
+In general, redirections open, close, or duplicate an
+existing reference to a file.
+The overall format used for redirection is:
+.Pp
+.Dl [n] Va redir-op Ar file
+.Pp
+where
+.Va redir-op
+is one of the redirection operators mentioned previously.
+Following is a list of the possible redirections.
+The
+.Bq n
+is an optional number, as in
+.Sq 3
+(not
+.Sq Bq 3 ,
+that refers to a file descriptor.
+.Bl -tag -width aaabsfiles -offset indent
+.It [n] Ns \*[Gt] file
+Redirect standard output (or n) to file.
+.It [n] Ns \*[Gt]| file
+Same, but override the
+.Fl C
+option.
+.It [n] Ns \*[Gt]\*[Gt] file
+Append standard output (or n) to file.
+.It [n] Ns \*[Lt] file
+Redirect standard input (or n) from file.
+.It [n1] Ns \*[Lt]& Ns n2
+Duplicate standard input (or n1) from file descriptor n2.
+.It [n] Ns \*[Lt]&-
+Close standard input (or n).
+.It [n1] Ns \*[Gt]& Ns n2
+Duplicate standard output (or n1) to n2.
+.It [n] Ns \*[Gt]&-
+Close standard output (or n).
+.It [n] Ns \*[Lt]\*[Gt] file
+Open file for reading and writing on standard input (or n).
+.El
+.Pp
+The following redirection is often called a
+.Dq here-document .
+.Bl -item -offset indent
+.It
+.Li [n]\*[Lt]\*[Lt] delimiter
+.Dl here-doc-text ...
+.Li delimiter
+.El
+.Pp
+All the text on successive lines up to the delimiter is saved away and
+made available to the command on standard input, or file descriptor n if
+it is specified.
+If the delimiter as specified on the initial line is
+quoted, then the here-doc-text is treated literally, otherwise the text is
+subjected to parameter expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic
+expansion (as described in the section on
+.Dq Expansions ) .
+If the operator is
+.Dq \*[Lt]\*[Lt]-
+instead of
+.Dq \*[Lt]\*[Lt] ,
+then leading tabs in the here-doc-text are stripped.
+.Ss Search and Execution
+There are three types of commands: shell functions, builtin commands, and
+normal programs -- and the command is searched for (by name) in that order.
+They each are executed in a different way.
+.Pp
+When a shell function is executed, all of the shell positional parameters
+(except $0, which remains unchanged) are set to the arguments of the shell
+function.
+The variables which are explicitly placed in the environment of
+the command (by placing assignments to them before the function name) are
+made local to the function and are set to the values given.
+Then the command given in the function definition is executed.
+The positional parameters are restored to their original values
+when the command completes.
+This all occurs within the current shell.
+.Pp
+Shell builtins are executed internally to the shell, without spawning a
+new process.
+.Pp
+Otherwise, if the command name doesn't match a function or builtin, the
+command is searched for as a normal program in the file system (as
+described in the next section).
+When a normal program is executed, the shell runs the program,
+passing the arguments and the environment to the program.
+If the program is not a normal executable file (i.e., if it does
+not begin with the "magic number" whose
+.Tn ASCII
+representation is "#!", so
+.Xr execve 2
+returns
+.Er ENOEXEC
+then) the shell will interpret the program in a subshell.
+The child shell will reinitialize itself in this case,
+so that the effect will be as if a
+new shell had been invoked to handle the ad-hoc shell script, except that
+the location of hashed commands located in the parent shell will be
+remembered by the child.
+.Pp
+Note that previous versions of this document and the source code itself
+misleadingly and sporadically refer to a shell script without a magic
+number as a "shell procedure".
+.Ss Path Search
+When locating a command, the shell first looks to see if it has a shell
+function by that name.
+Then it looks for a builtin command by that name.
+If a builtin command is not found, one of two things happen:
+.Bl -enum
+.It
+Command names containing a slash are simply executed without performing
+any searches.
+.It
+The shell searches each entry in
+.Ev PATH
+in turn for the command.
+The value of the
+.Ev PATH
+variable should be a series of entries separated by colons.
+Each entry consists of a directory name.
+The current directory may be indicated
+implicitly by an empty directory name, or explicitly by a single period.
+.El
+.Ss Command Exit Status
+Each command has an exit status that can influence the behaviour
+of other shell commands.
+The paradigm is that a command exits
+with zero for normal or success, and non-zero for failure,
+error, or a false indication.
+The man page for each command
+should indicate the various exit codes and what they mean.
+Additionally, the builtin commands return exit codes, as does
+an executed shell function.
+.Pp
+If a command consists entirely of variable assignments then the
+exit status of the command is that of the last command substitution
+if any, otherwise 0.
+.Ss Complex Commands
+Complex commands are combinations of simple commands with control
+operators or reserved words, together creating a larger complex command.
+More generally, a command is one of the following:
+.Bl -bullet
+.It
+simple command
+.It
+pipeline
+.It
+list or compound-list
+.It
+compound command
+.It
+function definition
+.El
+.Pp
+Unless otherwise stated, the exit status of a command is that of the last
+simple command executed by the command.
+.Ss Pipelines
+A pipeline is a sequence of one or more commands separated
+by the control operator |.
+The standard output of all but
+the last command is connected to the standard input
+of the next command.
+The standard output of the last
+command is inherited from the shell, as usual.
+.Pp
+The format for a pipeline is:
+.Pp
+.Dl [!] command1 [ | command2 ...]
+.Pp
+The standard output of command1 is connected to the standard input of
+command2.
+The standard input, standard output, or both of a command is
+considered to be assigned by the pipeline before any redirection specified
+by redirection operators that are part of the command.
+.Pp
+If the pipeline is not in the background (discussed later), the shell
+waits for all commands to complete.
+.Pp
+If the reserved word ! does not precede the pipeline, the exit status is
+the exit status of the last command specified in the pipeline.
+Otherwise, the exit status is the logical NOT of the exit status of the
+last command.
+That is, if the last command returns zero, the exit status
+is 1; if the last command returns greater than zero, the exit status is
+zero.
+.Pp
+Because pipeline assignment of standard input or standard output or both
+takes place before redirection, it can be modified by redirection.
+For example:
+.Pp
+.Dl $ command1 2\*[Gt]&1 | command2
+.Pp
+sends both the standard output and standard error of command1
+to the standard input of command2.
+.Pp
+A ; or
+.Aq newline
+terminator causes the preceding AND-OR-list (described
+next) to be executed sequentially; a & causes asynchronous execution of
+the preceding AND-OR-list.
+.Pp
+Note that unlike some other shells, each process in the pipeline is a
+child of the invoking shell (unless it is a shell builtin, in which case
+it executes in the current shell -- but any effect it has on the
+environment is wiped).
+.Ss Background Commands -- &
+If a command is terminated by the control operator ampersand (&), the
+shell executes the command asynchronously -- that is, the shell does not
+wait for the command to finish before executing the next command.
+.Pp
+The format for running a command in background is:
+.Pp
+.Dl command1 & [command2 & ...]
+.Pp
+If the shell is not interactive, the standard input of an asynchronous
+command is set to
+.Pa /dev/null .
+.Ss Lists -- Generally Speaking
+A list is a sequence of zero or more commands separated by newlines,
+semicolons, or ampersands, and optionally terminated by one of these three
+characters.
+The commands in a list are executed in the order they are written.
+If command is followed by an ampersand, the shell starts the
+command and immediately proceed onto the next command; otherwise it waits
+for the command to terminate before proceeding to the next one.
+.Ss Short-Circuit List Operators
+.Dq &&
+and
+.Dq ||
+are AND-OR list operators.
+.Dq &&
+executes the first command, and then executes the second command iff the
+exit status of the first command is zero.
+.Dq ||
+is similar, but executes the second command iff the exit status of the first
+command is nonzero.
+.Dq &&
+and
+.Dq ||
+both have the same priority.
+.Ss Flow-Control Constructs -- if, while, for, case
+The syntax of the if command is
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+if list
+then list
+[ elif list
+then list ] ...
+[ else list ]
+fi
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The syntax of the while command is
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+while list
+do list
+done
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The two lists are executed repeatedly while the exit status of the
+first list is zero.
+The until command is similar, but has the word
+until in place of while, which causes it to
+repeat until the exit status of the first list is zero.
+.Pp
+The syntax of the for command is
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+for variable in word ...
+do list
+done
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The words are expanded, and then the list is executed repeatedly with the
+variable set to each word in turn.
+do and done may be replaced with
+.Dq {
+and
+.Dq } .
+.Pp
+The syntax of the break and continue command is
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+break [ num ]
+continue [ num ]
+.Ed
+.Pp
+Break terminates the num innermost for or while loops.
+Continue continues with the next iteration of the innermost loop.
+These are implemented as builtin commands.
+.Pp
+The syntax of the case command is
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+case word in
+pattern) list ;;
+\&...
+esac
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The pattern can actually be one or more patterns (see
+.Sx Shell Patterns
+described later), separated by
+.Dq \*(Ba
+characters.
+.Ss Grouping Commands Together
+Commands may be grouped by writing either
+.Pp
+.Dl (list)
+.Pp
+or
+.Pp
+.Dl { list; }
+.Pp
+The first of these executes the commands in a subshell.
+Builtin commands grouped into a (list) will not affect the current shell.
+The second form does not fork another shell so is slightly more efficient.
+Grouping commands together this way allows you to redirect
+their output as though they were one program:
+.Pp
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+{ printf \*q hello \*q ; printf \*q world\\n" ; } \*[Gt] greeting
+.Ed
+.Pp
+Note that
+.Dq }
+must follow a control operator (here,
+.Dq \&; )
+so that it is recognized as a reserved word and not as another command argument.
+.Ss Functions
+The syntax of a function definition is
+.Pp
+.Dl name ( ) command
+.Pp
+A function definition is an executable statement; when executed it
+installs a function named name and returns an exit status of zero.
+The command is normally a list enclosed between
+.Dq {
+and
+.Dq } .
+.Pp
+Variables may be declared to be local to a function by using a local
+command.
+This should appear as the first statement of a function, and the syntax is
+.Pp
+.Dl local [ variable | - ] ...
+.Pp
+Local is implemented as a builtin command.
+.Pp
+When a variable is made local, it inherits the initial value and exported
+and readonly flags from the variable with the same name in the surrounding
+scope, if there is one.
+Otherwise, the variable is initially unset.
+The shell uses dynamic scoping, so that if you make the variable x local to
+function f, which then calls function g, references to the variable x made
+inside g will refer to the variable x declared inside f, not to the global
+variable named x.
+.Pp
+The only special parameter that can be made local is
+.Dq - .
+Making
+.Dq -
+local any shell options that are changed via the set command inside the
+function to be restored to their original values when the function
+returns.
+.Pp
+The syntax of the return command is
+.Pp
+.Dl return [ exitstatus ]
+.Pp
+It terminates the currently executing function.
+Return is implemented as a builtin command.
+.Ss Variables and Parameters
+The shell maintains a set of parameters.
+A parameter denoted by a name is called a variable.
+When starting up, the shell turns all the environment
+variables into shell variables.
+New variables can be set using the form
+.Pp
+.Dl name=value
+.Pp
+Variables set by the user must have a name consisting solely of
+alphabetics, numerics, and underscores - the first of which must not be
+numeric.
+A parameter can also be denoted by a number or a special
+character as explained below.
+.Ss Positional Parameters
+A positional parameter is a parameter denoted by a number (n \*[Gt] 0).
+The shell sets these initially to the values of its command line arguments
+that follow the name of the shell script.
+The
+.Ic set
+builtin can also be used to set or reset them.
+.Ss Special Parameters
+A special parameter is a parameter denoted by one of the following special
+characters.
+The value of the parameter is listed next to its character.
+.Bl -tag -width thinhyphena
+.It *
+Expands to the positional parameters, starting from one.
+When the
+expansion occurs within a double-quoted string it expands to a single
+field with the value of each parameter separated by the first character of
+the
+.Ev IFS
+variable, or by a
+.Aq space
+if
+.Ev IFS
+is unset.
+.It @
+Expands to the positional parameters, starting from one.
+When the expansion occurs within double-quotes, each positional
+parameter expands as a separate argument.
+If there are no positional parameters, the
+expansion of @ generates zero arguments, even when @ is
+double-quoted.
+What this basically means, for example, is
+if $1 is
+.Dq abc
+and $2 is
+.Dq def ghi ,
+then
+.Qq $@
+expands to
+the two arguments:
+.Pp
+.Sm off
+.Dl \*q abc \*q \ \*q def\ ghi \*q
+.Sm on
+.It #
+Expands to the number of positional parameters.
+.It ?
+Expands to the exit status of the most recent pipeline.
+.It - (Hyphen.)
+Expands to the current option flags (the single-letter
+option names concatenated into a string) as specified on
+invocation, by the set builtin command, or implicitly
+by the shell.
+.It $
+Expands to the process ID of the invoked shell.
+A subshell retains the same value of $ as its parent.
+.It !
+Expands to the process ID of the most recent background
+command executed from the current shell.
+For a pipeline, the process ID is that of the last command in the pipeline.
+.It 0 (Zero.)
+Expands to the name of the shell or shell script.
+.El
+.Ss Word Expansions
+This clause describes the various expansions that are performed on words.
+Not all expansions are performed on every word, as explained later.
+.Pp
+Tilde expansions, parameter expansions, command substitutions, arithmetic
+expansions, and quote removals that occur within a single word expand to a
+single field.
+It is only field splitting or pathname expansion that can
+create multiple fields from a single word.
+The single exception to this
+rule is the expansion of the special parameter @ within double-quotes, as
+was described above.
+.Pp
+The order of word expansion is:
+.Bl -enum
+.It
+Tilde Expansion, Parameter Expansion, Command Substitution,
+Arithmetic Expansion (these all occur at the same time).
+.It
+Field Splitting is performed on fields
+generated by step (1) unless the
+.Ev IFS
+variable is null.
+.It
+Pathname Expansion (unless set
+.Fl f
+is in effect).
+.It
+Quote Removal.
+.El
+.Pp
+The $ character is used to introduce parameter expansion, command
+substitution, or arithmetic evaluation.
+.Ss Tilde Expansion (substituting a user's home directory)
+A word beginning with an unquoted tilde character (~) is
+subjected to tilde expansion.
+All the characters up to
+a slash (/) or the end of the word are treated as a username
+and are replaced with the user's home directory.
+If the username is missing (as in
+.Pa ~/foobar ) ,
+the tilde is replaced with the value of the
+.Va HOME
+variable (the current user's home directory).
+.Ss Parameter Expansion
+The format for parameter expansion is as follows:
+.Pp
+.Dl ${expression}
+.Pp
+where expression consists of all characters until the matching
+.Dq } .
+Any
+.Dq }
+escaped by a backslash or within a quoted string, and characters in
+embedded arithmetic expansions, command substitutions, and variable
+expansions, are not examined in determining the matching
+.Dq } .
+.Pp
+The simplest form for parameter expansion is:
+.Pp
+.Dl ${parameter}
+.Pp
+The value, if any, of parameter is substituted.
+.Pp
+The parameter name or symbol can be enclosed in braces, which are
+optional except for positional parameters with more than one digit or
+when parameter is followed by a character that could be interpreted as
+part of the name.
+If a parameter expansion occurs inside double-quotes:
+.Bl -enum
+.It
+Pathname expansion is not performed on the results of the expansion.
+.It
+Field splitting is not performed on the results of the
+expansion, with the exception of @.
+.El
+.Pp
+In addition, a parameter expansion can be modified by using one of the
+following formats.
+.Bl -tag -width aaparameterwordaaaaa
+.It ${parameter:-word}
+Use Default Values.
+If parameter is unset or null, the expansion of word
+is substituted; otherwise, the value of parameter is substituted.
+.It ${parameter:=word}
+Assign Default Values.
+If parameter is unset or null, the expansion of
+word is assigned to parameter.
+In all cases, the final value of parameter is substituted.
+Only variables, not positional parameters or special
+parameters, can be assigned in this way.
+.It ${parameter:?[word]}
+Indicate Error if Null or Unset.
+If parameter is unset or null, the
+expansion of word (or a message indicating it is unset if word is omitted)
+is written to standard error and the shell exits with a nonzero exit status.
+Otherwise, the value of parameter is substituted.
+An interactive shell need not exit.
+.It ${parameter:+word}
+Use Alternative Value.
+If parameter is unset or null, null is
+substituted; otherwise, the expansion of word is substituted.
+.El
+.Pp
+In the parameter expansions shown previously, use of the colon in the
+format results in a test for a parameter that is unset or null; omission
+of the colon results in a test for a parameter that is only unset.
+.Bl -tag -width aaparameterwordaaaaa
+.It ${#parameter}
+String Length.
+The length in characters of the value of parameter.
+.El
+.Pp
+The following four varieties of parameter expansion provide for substring
+processing.
+In each case, pattern matching notation (see
+.Sx Shell Patterns ) ,
+rather than regular expression notation, is used to evaluate the patterns.
+If parameter is * or @, the result of the expansion is unspecified.
+Enclosing the full parameter expansion string in double-quotes does not
+cause the following four varieties of pattern characters to be quoted,
+whereas quoting characters within the braces has this effect.
+.Bl -tag -width aaparameterwordaaaaa
+.It ${parameter%word}
+Remove Smallest Suffix Pattern.
+The word is expanded to produce a pattern.
+The parameter expansion then results in parameter, with the
+smallest portion of the suffix matched by the pattern deleted.
+.It ${parameter%%word}
+Remove Largest Suffix Pattern.
+The word is expanded to produce a pattern.
+The parameter expansion then results in parameter, with the largest
+portion of the suffix matched by the pattern deleted.
+.It ${parameter#word}
+Remove Smallest Prefix Pattern.
+The word is expanded to produce a pattern.
+The parameter expansion then results in parameter, with the
+smallest portion of the prefix matched by the pattern deleted.
+.It ${parameter##word}
+Remove Largest Prefix Pattern.
+The word is expanded to produce a pattern.
+The parameter expansion then results in parameter, with the largest
+portion of the prefix matched by the pattern deleted.
+.El
+.Ss Command Substitution
+Command substitution allows the output of a command to be substituted in
+place of the command name itself.
+Command substitution occurs when the command is enclosed as follows:
+.Pp
+.Dl $(command)
+.Pp
+or
+.Po
+.Dq backquoted
+version
+.Pc :
+.Pp
+.Dl `command`
+.Pp
+The shell expands the command substitution by executing command in a
+subshell environment and replacing the command substitution with the
+standard output of the command, removing sequences of one or more
+.Ao newline Ac Ns s
+at the end of the substitution.
+(Embedded
+.Ao newline Ac Ns s
+before
+the end of the output are not removed; however, during field splitting,
+they may be translated into
+.Ao space Ac Ns s ,
+depending on the value of
+.Ev IFS
+and quoting that is in effect.)
+.Ss Arithmetic Expansion
+Arithmetic expansion provides a mechanism for evaluating an arithmetic
+expression and substituting its value.
+The format for arithmetic expansion is as follows:
+.Pp
+.Dl $((expression))
+.Pp
+The expression is treated as if it were in double-quotes, except
+that a double-quote inside the expression is not treated specially.
+The shell expands all tokens in the expression for parameter expansion,
+command substitution, and quote removal.
+.Pp
+Next, the shell treats this as an arithmetic expression and
+substitutes the value of the expression.
+.Ss White Space Splitting (Field Splitting)
+After parameter expansion, command substitution, and
+arithmetic expansion the shell scans the results of
+expansions and substitutions that did not occur in double-quotes for
+field splitting and multiple fields can result.
+.Pp
+The shell treats each character of the
+.Ev IFS
+as a delimiter and uses the delimiters to split the results of parameter
+expansion and command substitution into fields.
+.Ss Pathname Expansion (File Name Generation)
+Unless the
+.Fl f
+flag is set, file name generation is performed after word splitting is
+complete.
+Each word is viewed as a series of patterns, separated by slashes.
+The process of expansion replaces the word with the names of all
+existing files whose names can be formed by replacing each pattern with a
+string that matches the specified pattern.
+There are two restrictions on
+this: first, a pattern cannot match a string containing a slash, and
+second, a pattern cannot match a string starting with a period unless the
+first character of the pattern is a period.
+The next section describes the
+patterns used for both Pathname Expansion and the
+.Ic case
+command.
+.Ss Shell Patterns
+A pattern consists of normal characters, which match themselves,
+and meta-characters.
+The meta-characters are
+.Dq \&! ,
+.Dq * ,
+.Dq \&? ,
+and
+.Dq \&[ .
+These characters lose their special meanings if they are quoted.
+When command or variable substitution is performed
+and the dollar sign or back quotes are not double quoted,
+the value of the variable or the output of
+the command is scanned for these characters and they are turned into
+meta-characters.
+.Pp
+An asterisk
+.Pq Dq *
+matches any string of characters.
+A question mark matches any single character.
+A left bracket
+.Pq Dq \&[
+introduces a character class.
+The end of the character class is indicated by a
+.Pq Dq \&] ;
+if the
+.Dq \&]
+is missing then the
+.Dq \&[
+matches a
+.Dq \&[
+rather than introducing a character class.
+A character class matches any of the characters between the square brackets.
+A range of characters may be specified using a minus sign.
+The character class may be complemented
+by making an exclamation point the first character of the character class.
+.Pp
+To include a
+.Dq \&]
+in a character class, make it the first character listed (after the
+.Dq \&! ,
+if any).
+To include a minus sign, make it the first or last character listed.
+.Ss Builtins
+This section lists the builtin commands which are builtin because they
+need to perform some operation that can't be performed by a separate
+process.
+In addition to these, there are several other commands that may
+be builtin for efficiency (e.g.
+.Xr printf 1 ,
+.Xr echo 1 ,
+.Xr test 1 ,
+etc).
+.Bl -tag -width 5n
+.It :
+.It true
+A null command that returns a 0 (true) exit value.
+.It \&. file
+The commands in the specified file are read and executed by the shell.
+.It alias Op Ar name Ns Op Ar "=string ..."
+If
+.Ar name=string
+is specified, the shell defines the alias
+.Ar name
+with value
+.Ar string .
+If just
+.Ar name
+is specified, the value of the alias
+.Ar name
+is printed.
+With no arguments, the
+.Ic alias
+builtin prints the
+names and values of all defined aliases (see
+.Ic unalias ) .
+.It bg [ Ar job ] ...
+Continue the specified jobs (or the current job if no
+jobs are given) in the background.
+.It Xo command
+.Op Fl p
+.Op Fl v
+.Op Fl V
+.Ar command
+.Op Ar arg ...
+.Xc
+Execute the specified command but ignore shell functions when searching
+for it.
+(This is useful when you
+have a shell function with the same name as a builtin command.)
+.Bl -tag -width 5n
+.It Fl p
+search for command using a
+.Ev PATH
+that guarantees to find all the standard utilities.
+.It Fl V
+Do not execute the command but
+search for the command and print the resolution of the
+command search.
+This is the same as the type builtin.
+.It Fl v
+Do not execute the command but
+search for the command and print the absolute pathname
+of utilities, the name for builtins or the expansion of aliases.
+.El
+.It cd Ar -
+.It Xo cd Op Fl LP
+.Op Ar directory
+.Xc
+Switch to the specified directory (default
+.Ev HOME ) .
+If an entry for
+.Ev CDPATH
+appears in the environment of the
+.Ic cd
+command or the shell variable
+.Ev CDPATH
+is set and the directory name does not begin with a slash, then the
+directories listed in
+.Ev CDPATH
+will be searched for the specified directory.
+The format of
+.Ev CDPATH
+is the same as that of
+.Ev PATH .
+If a single dash is specified as the argument, it will be replaced by the
+value of
+.Ev OLDPWD .
+The
+.Ic cd
+command will print out the name of the
+directory that it actually switched to if this is different from the name
+that the user gave.
+These may be different either because the
+.Ev CDPATH
+mechanism was used or because the argument is a single dash.
+The
+.Fl P
+option causes the physical directory structure to be used, that is, all
+symbolic links are resolved to their respective values. The
+.Fl L
+option turns off the effect of any preceding
+.Fl P
+options.
+.It Xo echo Op Fl n
+.Ar args...
+.Xc
+Print the arguments on the standard output, separated by spaces.
+Unless the
+.Fl n
+option is present, a newline is output following the arguments.
+.Pp
+If any of the following sequences of characters is encountered during
+output, the sequence is not output. Instead, the specified action is
+performed:
+.Bl -tag -width indent
+.It Li \eb
+A backspace character is output.
+.It Li \ec
+Subsequent output is suppressed. This is normally used at the end of the
+last argument to suppress the trailing newline that
+.Ic echo
+would otherwise output.
+.It Li \ef
+Output a form feed.
+.It Li \en
+Output a newline character.
+.It Li \er
+Output a carriage return.
+.It Li \et
+Output a (horizontal) tab character.
+.It Li \ev
+Output a vertical tab.
+.It Li \e0 Ns Ar digits
+Output the character whose value is given by zero to three octal digits.
+If there are zero digits, a nul character is output.
+.It Li \e\e
+Output a backslash.
+.El
+.Pp
+All other backslash sequences elicit undefined behaviour.
+.It eval Ar string ...
+Concatenate all the arguments with spaces.
+Then re-parse and execute the command.
+.It exec Op Ar command arg ...
+Unless command is omitted, the shell process is replaced with the
+specified program (which must be a real program, not a shell builtin or
+function).
+Any redirections on the
+.Ic exec
+command are marked as permanent, so that they are not undone when the
+.Ic exec
+command finishes.
+.It exit Op Ar exitstatus
+Terminate the shell process.
+If
+.Ar exitstatus
+is given it is used as the exit status of the shell; otherwise the
+exit status of the preceding command is used.
+.It export Ar name ...
+.It export Fl p
+The specified names are exported so that they will appear in the
+environment of subsequent commands.
+The only way to un-export a variable is to unset it.
+The shell allows the value of a variable to be set at the
+same time it is exported by writing
+.Pp
+.Dl export name=value
+.Pp
+With no arguments the export command lists the names of all exported variables.
+With the
+.Fl p
+option specified the output will be formatted suitably for non-interactive use.
+.It Xo fc Op Fl e Ar editor
+.Op Ar first Op Ar last
+.Xc
+.It Xo fc Fl l
+.Op Fl nr
+.Op Ar first Op Ar last
+.Xc
+.It Xo fc Fl s Op Ar old=new
+.Op Ar first
+.Xc
+The
+.Ic fc
+builtin lists, or edits and re-executes, commands previously entered
+to an interactive shell.
+.Bl -tag -width 5n
+.It Fl e No editor
+Use the editor named by editor to edit the commands.
+The editor string is a command name, subject to search via the
+.Ev PATH
+variable.
+The value in the
+.Ev FCEDIT
+variable is used as a default when
+.Fl e
+is not specified.
+If
+.Ev FCEDIT
+is null or unset, the value of the
+.Ev EDITOR
+variable is used.
+If
+.Ev EDITOR
+is null or unset,
+.Xr ed 1
+is used as the editor.
+.It Fl l No (ell)
+List the commands rather than invoking an editor on them.
+The commands are written in the sequence indicated by
+the first and last operands, as affected by
+.Fl r ,
+with each command preceded by the command number.
+.It Fl n
+Suppress command numbers when listing with -l.
+.It Fl r
+Reverse the order of the commands listed (with
+.Fl l )
+or edited (with neither
+.Fl l
+nor
+.Fl s ) .
+.It Fl s
+Re-execute the command without invoking an editor.
+.It first
+.It last
+Select the commands to list or edit.
+The number of previous commands that
+can be accessed are determined by the value of the
+.Ev HISTSIZE
+variable.
+The value of first or last or both are one of the following:
+.Bl -tag -width 5n
+.It [+]number
+A positive number representing a command number; command numbers can be
+displayed with the
+.Fl l
+option.
+.It Fl number
+A negative decimal number representing the command that was executed
+number of commands previously.
+For example, \-1 is the immediately previous command.
+.El
+.It string
+A string indicating the most recently entered command that begins with
+that string.
+If the old=new operand is not also specified with
+.Fl s ,
+the string form of the first operand cannot contain an embedded equal sign.
+.El
+.Pp
+The following environment variables affect the execution of fc:
+.Bl -tag -width HISTSIZE
+.It Ev FCEDIT
+Name of the editor to use.
+.It Ev HISTSIZE
+The number of previous commands that are accessible.
+.El
+.It fg Op Ar job
+Move the specified job or the current job to the foreground.
+.It getopts Ar optstring var
+The
+.Tn POSIX
+.Ic getopts
+command, not to be confused with the
+.Em Bell Labs
+-derived
+.Xr getopt 1 .
+.Pp
+The first argument should be a series of letters, each of which may be
+optionally followed by a colon to indicate that the option requires an
+argument.
+The variable specified is set to the parsed option.
+.Pp
+The
+.Ic getopts
+command deprecates the older
+.Xr getopt 1
+utility due to its handling of arguments containing whitespace.
+.Pp
+The
+.Ic getopts
+builtin may be used to obtain options and their arguments
+from a list of parameters.
+When invoked,
+.Ic getopts
+places the value of the next option from the option string in the list in
+the shell variable specified by
+.Va var
+and its index in the shell variable
+.Ev OPTIND .
+When the shell is invoked,
+.Ev OPTIND
+is initialized to 1.
+For each option that requires an argument, the
+.Ic getopts
+builtin will place it in the shell variable
+.Ev OPTARG .
+If an option is not allowed for in the
+.Va optstring ,
+then
+.Ev OPTARG
+will be unset.
+.Pp
+.Va optstring
+is a string of recognized option letters (see
+.Xr getopt 3 ) .
+If a letter is followed by a colon, the option is expected to have an
+argument which may or may not be separated from it by white space.
+If an option character is not found where expected,
+.Ic getopts
+will set the variable
+.Va var
+to a
+.Dq \&? ;
+.Ic getopts
+will then unset
+.Ev OPTARG
+and write output to standard error.
+By specifying a colon as the first character of
+.Va optstring
+all errors will be ignored.
+.Pp
+A nonzero value is returned when the last option is reached.
+If there are no remaining arguments,
+.Ic getopts
+will set
+.Va var
+to the special option,
+.Dq -- ,
+otherwise, it will set
+.Va var
+to
+.Dq \&? .
+.Pp
+The following code fragment shows how one might process the arguments
+for a command that can take the options
+.Op a
+and
+.Op b ,
+and the option
+.Op c ,
+which requires an argument.
+.Pp
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+while getopts abc: f
+do
+ case $f in
+ a | b) flag=$f;;
+ c) carg=$OPTARG;;
+ \\?) echo $USAGE; exit 1;;
+ esac
+done
+shift `expr $OPTIND - 1`
+.Ed
+.Pp
+This code will accept any of the following as equivalent:
+.Pp
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+cmd \-acarg file file
+cmd \-a \-c arg file file
+cmd \-carg -a file file
+cmd \-a \-carg \-\- file file
+.Ed
+.It hash Fl rv Ar command ...
+The shell maintains a hash table which remembers the
+locations of commands.
+With no arguments whatsoever,
+the
+.Ic hash
+command prints out the contents of this table.
+Entries which have not been looked at since the last
+.Ic cd
+command are marked with an asterisk; it is possible for these entries
+to be invalid.
+.Pp
+With arguments, the
+.Ic hash
+command removes the specified commands from the hash table (unless
+they are functions) and then locates them.
+With the
+.Fl v
+option, hash prints the locations of the commands as it finds them.
+The
+.Fl r
+option causes the hash command to delete all the entries in the hash table
+except for functions.
+.It pwd Op Fl LP
+builtin command remembers what the current directory
+is rather than recomputing it each time.
+This makes it faster.
+However, if the current directory is renamed, the builtin version of
+.Ic pwd
+will continue to print the old name for the directory.
+The
+.Fl P
+option causes the physical value of the current working directory to be shown,
+that is, all symbolic links are resolved to their respective values. The
+.Fl L
+option turns off the effect of any preceding
+.Fl P
+options.
+.It Xo read Op Fl p Ar prompt
+.Op Fl r
+.Ar variable
+.Op Ar ...
+.Xc
+The prompt is printed if the
+.Fl p
+option is specified and the standard input is a terminal.
+Then a line is read from the standard input.
+The trailing newline is deleted from the
+line and the line is split as described in the section on word splitting
+above, and the pieces are assigned to the variables in order.
+At least one variable must be specified.
+If there are more pieces than variables, the remaining pieces
+(along with the characters in
+.Ev IFS
+that separated them) are assigned to the last variable.
+If there are more variables than pieces,
+the remaining variables are assigned the null string.
+The
+.Ic read
+builtin will indicate success unless EOF is encountered on input, in
+which case failure is returned.
+.Pp
+By default, unless the
+.Fl r
+option is specified, the backslash
+.Dq \e
+acts as an escape character, causing the following character to be treated
+literally.
+If a backslash is followed by a newline, the backslash and the
+newline will be deleted.
+.It readonly Ar name ...
+.It readonly Fl p
+The specified names are marked as read only, so that they cannot be
+subsequently modified or unset.
+The shell allows the value of a variable
+to be set at the same time it is marked read only by writing
+.Pp
+.Dl readonly name=value
+.Pp
+With no arguments the readonly command lists the names of all read only
+variables.
+With the
+.Fl p
+option specified the output will be formatted suitably for non-interactive use.
+.Pp
+.It Xo printf Ar format
+.Op Ar arguments ...
+.Xc
+.Ic printf
+formats and prints its arguments, after the first, under control
+of the
+.Ar format .
+The
+.Ar format
+is a character string which contains three types of objects: plain characters,
+which are simply copied to standard output, character escape sequences which
+are converted and copied to the standard output, and format specifications,
+each of which causes printing of the next successive
+.Ar argument .
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar arguments
+after the first are treated as strings if the corresponding format is
+either
+.Cm b ,
+.Cm c
+or
+.Cm s ;
+otherwise it is evaluated as a C constant, with the following extensions:
+.Pp
+.Bl -bullet -offset indent -compact
+.It
+A leading plus or minus sign is allowed.
+.It
+If the leading character is a single or double quote, the value is the
+.Tn ASCII
+code of the next character.
+.El
+.Pp
+The format string is reused as often as necessary to satisfy the
+.Ar arguments .
+Any extra format specifications are evaluated with zero or the null
+string.
+.Pp
+Character escape sequences are in backslash notation as defined in
+.St -ansiC .
+The characters and their meanings are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -offset indent
+.It Cm \ea
+Write a \*[Lt]bell\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \eb
+Write a \*[Lt]backspace\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \ef
+Write a \*[Lt]form-feed\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \en
+Write a \*[Lt]new-line\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \er
+Write a \*[Lt]carriage return\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \et
+Write a \*[Lt]tab\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \ev
+Write a \*[Lt]vertical tab\*[Gt] character.
+.It Cm \e\e
+Write a backslash character.
+.It Cm \e Ns Ar num
+Write an 8\-bit character whose
+.Tn ASCII
+value is the 1\-, 2\-, or 3\-digit
+octal number
+.Ar num .
+.El
+.Pp
+Each format specification is introduced by the percent character
+(``%'').
+The remainder of the format specification includes,
+in the following order:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It "Zero or more of the following flags:"
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Cm #
+A `#' character
+specifying that the value should be printed in an ``alternative form''.
+For
+.Cm b ,
+.Cm c ,
+.Cm d ,
+and
+.Cm s
+formats, this option has no effect.
+For the
+.Cm o
+format the precision of the number is increased to force the first
+character of the output string to a zero.
+For the
+.Cm x
+.Pq Cm X
+format, a non-zero result has the string
+.Li 0x
+.Pq Li 0X
+prepended to it.
+For
+.Cm e ,
+.Cm E ,
+.Cm f ,
+.Cm g ,
+and
+.Cm G
+formats, the result will always contain a decimal point, even if no
+digits follow the point (normally, a decimal point only appears in the
+results of those formats if a digit follows the decimal point).
+For
+.Cm g
+and
+.Cm G
+formats, trailing zeros are not removed from the result as they
+would otherwise be.
+.It Cm \&\-
+A minus sign `\-' which specifies
+.Em left adjustment
+of the output in the indicated field;
+.It Cm \&+
+A `+' character specifying that there should always be
+a sign placed before the number when using signed formats.
+.It Sq \&\ \&
+A space specifying that a blank should be left before a positive number
+for a signed format.
+A `+' overrides a space if both are used;
+.It Cm \&0
+A zero `0' character indicating that zero-padding should be used
+rather than blank-padding.
+A `\-' overrides a `0' if both are used;
+.El
+.It "Field Width:"
+An optional digit string specifying a
+.Em field width ;
+if the output string has fewer characters than the field width it will
+be blank-padded on the left (or right, if the left-adjustment indicator
+has been given) to make up the field width (note that a leading zero
+is a flag, but an embedded zero is part of a field width);
+.It Precision :
+An optional period,
+.Sq Cm \&.\& ,
+followed by an optional digit string giving a
+.Em precision
+which specifies the number of digits to appear after the decimal point,
+for
+.Cm e
+and
+.Cm f
+formats, or the maximum number of characters to be printed
+from a string
+.Sm off
+.Pf ( Cm b
+.Sm on
+and
+.Cm s
+formats); if the digit string is missing, the precision is treated
+as zero;
+.It Format :
+A character which indicates the type of format to use (one of
+.Cm diouxXfwEgGbcs ) .
+.El
+.Pp
+A field width or precision may be
+.Sq Cm \&*
+instead of a digit string.
+In this case an
+.Ar argument
+supplies the field width or precision.
+.Pp
+The format characters and their meanings are:
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Cm diouXx
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed as a signed decimal (d or i), unsigned octal, unsigned decimal,
+or unsigned hexadecimal (X or x), respectively.
+.It Cm f
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed in the style
+.Sm off
+.Pf [\-]ddd Cm \&. No ddd
+.Sm on
+where the number of d's
+after the decimal point is equal to the precision specification for
+the argument.
+If the precision is missing, 6 digits are given; if the precision
+is explicitly 0, no digits and no decimal point are printed.
+.It Cm eE
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed in the style
+.Sm off
+.Pf [\-]d Cm \&. No ddd Cm e No \\*(Pmdd
+.Sm on
+where there
+is one digit before the decimal point and the number after is equal to
+the precision specification for the argument; when the precision is
+missing, 6 digits are produced.
+An upper-case E is used for an `E' format.
+.It Cm gG
+The
+.Ar argument
+is printed in style
+.Cm f
+or in style
+.Cm e
+.Pq Cm E
+whichever gives full precision in minimum space.
+.It Cm b
+Characters from the string
+.Ar argument
+are printed with backslash-escape sequences expanded.
+.br
+The following additional backslash-escape sequences are supported:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Cm \ec
+Causes
+.Nm
+to ignore any remaining characters in the string operand containing it,
+any remaining string operands, and any additional characters in
+the format operand.
+.It Cm \e0 Ns Ar num
+Write an 8\-bit character whose
+.Tn ASCII
+value is the 1\-, 2\-, or 3\-digit
+octal number
+.Ar num .
+.El
+.It Cm c
+The first character of
+.Ar argument
+is printed.
+.It Cm s
+Characters from the string
+.Ar argument
+are printed until the end is reached or until the number of characters
+indicated by the precision specification is reached; if the
+precision is omitted, all characters in the string are printed.
+.It Cm \&%
+Print a `%'; no argument is used.
+.El
+.Pp
+In no case does a non-existent or small field width cause truncation of
+a field; padding takes place only if the specified field width exceeds
+the actual width.
+.It Xo set
+.Oo {
+.Fl options | Cm +options | Cm -- }
+.Oc Ar arg ...
+.Xc
+The
+.Ic set
+command performs three different functions.
+.Pp
+With no arguments, it lists the values of all shell variables.
+.Pp
+If options are given, it sets the specified option
+flags, or clears them as described in the section called
+.Sx Argument List Processing .
+.Pp
+The third use of the set command is to set the values of the shell's
+positional parameters to the specified args.
+To change the positional
+parameters without changing any options, use
+.Dq --
+as the first argument to set.
+If no args are present, the set command
+will clear all the positional parameters (equivalent to executing
+.Dq shift $# . )
+.It shift Op Ar n
+Shift the positional parameters n times.
+A
+.Ic shift
+sets the value of
+.Va $1
+to the value of
+.Va $2 ,
+the value of
+.Va $2
+to the value of
+.Va $3 ,
+and so on, decreasing
+the value of
+.Va $#
+by one.
+If n is greater than the number of positional parameters,
+.Ic shift
+will issue an error message, and exit with return status 2.
+.It test Ar expression
+.It \&[ Ar expression Cm ]
+The
+.Ic test
+utility evaluates the expression and, if it evaluates
+to true, returns a zero (true) exit status; otherwise
+it returns 1 (false).
+If there is no expression, test also
+returns 1 (false).
+.Pp
+All operators and flags are separate arguments to the
+.Ic test
+utility.
+.Pp
+The following primaries are used to construct expression:
+.Bl -tag -width Ar
+.It Fl b Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a block special
+file.
+.It Fl c Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a character
+special file.
+.It Fl d Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a directory.
+.It Fl e Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists (regardless of type).
+.It Fl f Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a regular file.
+.It Fl g Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its set group ID flag
+is set.
+.It Fl h Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a symbolic link.
+.It Fl k Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its sticky bit is set.
+.It Fl n Ar string
+True if the length of
+.Ar string
+is nonzero.
+.It Fl p Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+is a named pipe
+.Po Tn FIFO Pc .
+.It Fl r Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is readable.
+.It Fl s Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and has a size greater
+than zero.
+.It Fl t Ar file_descriptor
+True if the file whose file descriptor number
+is
+.Ar file_descriptor
+is open and is associated with a terminal.
+.It Fl u Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its set user ID flag
+is set.
+.It Fl w Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is writable.
+True
+indicates only that the write flag is on.
+The file is not writable on a read-only file
+system even if this test indicates true.
+.It Fl x Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is executable.
+True
+indicates only that the execute flag is on.
+If
+.Ar file
+is a directory, true indicates that
+.Ar file
+can be searched.
+.It Fl z Ar string
+True if the length of
+.Ar string
+is zero.
+.It Fl L Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a symbolic link.
+This operator is retained for compatibility with previous versions of
+this program.
+Do not rely on its existence; use
+.Fl h
+instead.
+.It Fl O Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its owner matches the effective user id of this process.
+.It Fl G Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its group matches the effective group id of this process.
+.It Fl S Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a socket.
+.It Ar file1 Fl nt Ar file2
+True if
+.Ar file1
+exists and is newer than
+.Ar file2 .
+.It Ar file1 Fl ot Ar file2
+True if
+.Ar file1
+exists and is older than
+.Ar file2 .
+.It Ar file1 Fl ef Ar file2
+True if
+.Ar file1
+and
+.Ar file2
+exist and refer to the same file.
+.It Ar string
+True if
+.Ar string
+is not the null
+string.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&= Ar \&s\&2
+True if the strings
+.Ar \&s\&1
+and
+.Ar \&s\&2
+are identical.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&!= Ar \&s\&2
+True if the strings
+.Ar \&s\&1
+and
+.Ar \&s\&2
+are not identical.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&\*[Lt] Ar \&s\&2
+True if string
+.Ar \&s\&1
+comes before
+.Ar \&s\&2
+based on the ASCII value of their characters.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&\*[Gt] Ar \&s\&2
+True if string
+.Ar \&s\&1
+comes after
+.Ar \&s\&2
+based on the ASCII value of their characters.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&eq Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integers
+.Ar \&n\&1
+and
+.Ar \&n\&2
+are algebraically
+equal.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&ne Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integers
+.Ar \&n\&1
+and
+.Ar \&n\&2
+are not
+algebraically equal.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&gt Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically
+greater than the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&ge Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically
+greater than or equal to the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&lt Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically less
+than the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&le Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically less
+than or equal to the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.El
+.Pp
+These primaries can be combined with the following operators:
+.Bl -tag -width Ar
+.It Cm \&! Ar expression
+True if
+.Ar expression
+is false.
+.It Ar expression1 Fl a Ar expression2
+True if both
+.Ar expression1
+and
+.Ar expression2
+are true.
+.It Ar expression1 Fl o Ar expression2
+True if either
+.Ar expression1
+or
+.Ar expression2
+are true.
+.It Cm \&( Ns Ar expression Ns Cm \&)
+True if expression is true.
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Fl a
+operator has higher precedence than the
+.Fl o
+operator.
+.It times
+Print the accumulated user and system times for the shell and for processes
+run from the shell. The return status is 0.
+.It Xo trap
+.Op Ar action Ar signal ...
+.Xc
+Cause the shell to parse and execute action when any of the specified
+signals are received.
+The signals are specified by signal number or as the name of the signal.
+If
+.Ar signal
+is
+.Li 0 ,
+the action is executed when the shell exits.
+.Ar action
+may be null, which cause the specified signals to be ignored.
+With
+.Ar action
+omitted or set to `-' the specified signals are set to their default action.
+When the shell forks off a subshell, it resets trapped (but not ignored)
+signals to the default action.
+The
+.Ic trap
+command has no effect on signals that were
+ignored on entry to the shell.
+.Ic trap
+without any arguments cause it to write a list of signals and their
+associated action to the standard output in a format that is suitable
+as an input to the shell that achieves the same trapping results.
+.Pp
+Examples:
+.Pp
+.Dl trap
+.Pp
+List trapped signals and their corresponding action
+.Pp
+.Dl trap '' INT QUIT tstp 30
+.Pp
+Ignore signals INT QUIT TSTP USR1
+.Pp
+.Dl trap date INT
+.Pp
+Print date upon receiving signal INT
+.It type Op Ar name ...
+Interpret each name as a command and print the resolution of the command
+search.
+Possible resolutions are:
+shell keyword, alias, shell builtin,
+command, tracked alias and not found.
+For aliases the alias expansion is
+printed; for commands and tracked aliases the complete pathname of the
+command is printed.
+.It ulimit Xo
+.Op Fl H \*(Ba Fl S
+.Op Fl a \*(Ba Fl tfdscmlpn Op Ar value
+.Xc
+Inquire about or set the hard or soft limits on processes or set new
+limits.
+The choice between hard limit (which no process is allowed to
+violate, and which may not be raised once it has been lowered) and soft
+limit (which causes processes to be signaled but not necessarily killed,
+and which may be raised) is made with these flags:
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Fl H
+set or inquire about hard limits
+.It Fl S
+set or inquire about soft limits.
+If neither
+.Fl H
+nor
+.Fl S
+is specified, the soft limit is displayed or both limits are set.
+If both are specified, the last one wins.
+.El
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+The limit to be interrogated or set, then, is chosen by specifying
+any one of these flags:
+.It Fl a
+show all the current limits
+.It Fl t
+show or set the limit on CPU time (in seconds)
+.It Fl f
+show or set the limit on the largest file that can be created
+(in 512-byte blocks)
+.It Fl d
+show or set the limit on the data segment size of a process (in kilobytes)
+.It Fl s
+show or set the limit on the stack size of a process (in kilobytes)
+.It Fl c
+show or set the limit on the largest core dump size that can be produced
+(in 512-byte blocks)
+.It Fl m
+show or set the limit on the total physical memory that can be
+in use by a process (in kilobytes)
+.It Fl l
+show or set the limit on how much memory a process can lock with
+.Xr mlock 2
+(in kilobytes)
+.It Fl p
+show or set the limit on the number of processes this user can
+have at one time
+.It Fl n
+show or set the limit on the number files a process can have open at once
+.El
+.Pp
+If none of these is specified, it is the limit on file size that is shown
+or set.
+If value is specified, the limit is set to that number; otherwise
+the current limit is displayed.
+.Pp
+Limits of an arbitrary process can be displayed or set using the
+.Xr sysctl 8
+utility.
+.Pp
+.It umask Op Ar mask
+Set the value of umask (see
+.Xr umask 2 )
+to the specified octal value.
+If the argument is omitted, the umask value is printed.
+.It unalias Xo
+.Op Fl a
+.Op Ar name
+.Xc
+If
+.Ar name
+is specified, the shell removes that alias.
+If
+.Fl a
+is specified, all aliases are removed.
+.It unset Xo
+.Op Fl fv
+.Ar name ...
+.Xc
+The specified variables and functions are unset and unexported.
+If
+.Fl f
+or
+.Fl v
+is specified, the corresponding function or variable is unset, respectively.
+If a given name corresponds to both a variable and a function, and no
+options are given, only the variable is unset.
+.It wait Op Ar job
+Wait for the specified job to complete and return the exit status of the
+last process in the job.
+If the argument is omitted, wait for all jobs to
+complete and the return an exit status of zero.
+.El
+.Ss Command Line Editing
+When
+.Nm
+is being used interactively from a terminal, the current command
+and the command history (see
+.Ic fc
+in
+.Sx Builtins )
+can be edited using vi-mode command-line editing.
+This mode uses commands, described below,
+similar to a subset of those described in the vi man page.
+The command
+.Ql set -o vi
+enables vi-mode editing and place sh into vi insert mode.
+With vi-mode
+enabled, sh can be switched between insert mode and command mode.
+The editor is not described in full here, but will be in a later document.
+It's similar to vi: typing
+.Aq ESC
+will throw you into command VI command mode.
+Hitting
+.Aq return
+while in command mode will pass the line to the shell.
+.Sh EXIT STATUS
+Errors that are detected by the shell, such as a syntax error, will cause the
+shell to exit with a non-zero exit status.
+If the shell is not an
+interactive shell, the execution of the shell file will be aborted.
+Otherwise
+the shell will return the exit status of the last command executed, or
+if the exit builtin is used with a numeric argument, it will return the
+argument.
+.Sh ENVIRONMENT
+.Bl -tag -width MAILCHECK
+.It Ev HOME
+Set automatically by
+.Xr login 1
+from the user's login directory in the password file
+.Pq Xr passwd 4 .
+This environment variable also functions as the default argument for the
+cd builtin.
+.It Ev PATH
+The default search path for executables.
+See the above section
+.Sx Path Search .
+.It Ev CDPATH
+The search path used with the cd builtin.
+.It Ev MAIL
+The name of a mail file, that will be checked for the arrival of new mail.
+Overridden by
+.Ev MAILPATH .
+.It Ev MAILCHECK
+The frequency in seconds that the shell checks for the arrival of mail
+in the files specified by the
+.Ev MAILPATH
+or the
+.Ev MAIL
+file.
+If set to 0, the check will occur at each prompt.
+.It Ev MAILPATH
+A colon
+.Dq \&:
+separated list of file names, for the shell to check for incoming mail.
+This environment setting overrides the
+.Ev MAIL
+setting.
+There is a maximum of 10 mailboxes that can be monitored at once.
+.It Ev PS1
+The primary prompt string, which defaults to
+.Dq $ \ ,
+unless you are the superuser, in which case it defaults to
+.Dq # \ .
+.It Ev PS2
+The secondary prompt string, which defaults to
+.Dq \*[Gt] \ .
+.It Ev PS4
+Output before each line when execution trace (set -x) is enabled,
+defaults to
+.Dq + \ .
+.It Ev IFS
+Input Field Separators.
+This is normally set to
+.Aq space ,
+.Aq tab ,
+and
+.Aq newline .
+See the
+.Sx White Space Splitting
+section for more details.
+.It Ev TERM
+The default terminal setting for the shell.
+This is inherited by
+children of the shell, and is used in the history editing modes.
+.It Ev HISTSIZE
+The number of lines in the history buffer for the shell.
+.It Ev PWD
+The logical value of the current working directory. This is set by the
+.Ic cd
+command.
+.It Ev OLDPWD
+The previous logical value of the current working directory. This is set by
+the
+.Ic cd
+command.
+.It Ev PPID
+The process ID of the parent process of the shell.
+.El
+.Sh FILES
+.Bl -item -width HOMEprofilexxxx
+.It
+.Pa $HOME/.profile
+.It
+.Pa /etc/profile
+.El
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr csh 1 ,
+.Xr echo 1 ,
+.Xr getopt 1 ,
+.Xr ksh 1 ,
+.Xr login 1 ,
+.Xr printf 1 ,
+.Xr test 1 ,
+.Xr getopt 3 ,
+.Xr passwd 5 ,
+.\" .Xr profile 4 ,
+.Xr environ 7 ,
+.Xr sysctl 8
+.Sh HISTORY
+A
+.Nm
+command appeared in
+.At v1 .
+It was, however, unmaintainable so we wrote this one.
+.Sh BUGS
+Setuid shell scripts should be avoided at all costs, as they are a
+significant security risk.
+.Pp
+PS1, PS2, and PS4 should be subject to parameter expansion before
+being displayed.
diff --git a/usr/dash/shell.h b/usr/dash/shell.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..98edc8b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/shell.h
@@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)shell.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+/*
+ * The follow should be set to reflect the type of system you have:
+ * JOBS -> 1 if you have Berkeley job control, 0 otherwise.
+ * SHORTNAMES -> 1 if your linker cannot handle long names.
+ * define BSD if you are running 4.2 BSD or later.
+ * define SYSV if you are running under System V.
+ * define DEBUG=1 to compile in debugging ('set -o debug' to turn on)
+ * define DEBUG=2 to compile in and turn on debugging.
+ * define DO_SHAREDVFORK to indicate that vfork(2) shares its address
+ * with its parent.
+ *
+ * When debugging is on, debugging info will be written to ./trace and
+ * a quit signal will generate a core dump.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+
+#ifndef JOBS
+#define JOBS 1
+#endif
+#ifndef BSD
+#define BSD 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef DO_SHAREDVFORK
+#if __NetBSD_Version__ >= 104000000
+#define DO_SHAREDVFORK
+#endif
+#endif
+
+typedef void *pointer;
+#ifndef NULL
+#define NULL (void *)0
+#endif
+#define STATIC static
+#define MKINIT /* empty */
+
+extern char nullstr[1]; /* null string */
+
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+#define TRACE(param) trace param
+#define TRACEV(param) tracev param
+#else
+#define TRACE(param)
+#define TRACEV(param)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && __GNUC__ < 3
+#define va_copy __va_copy
+#endif
+
+#if !defined(__GNUC__) || (__GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ < 96)
+#define __builtin_expect(x, expected_value) (x)
+#endif
+
+#define likely(x) __builtin_expect(!!(x),1)
+#define unlikely(x) __builtin_expect(!!(x),0)
+
+/*
+ * Hack to calculate maximum length.
+ * (length * 8 - 1) * log10(2) + 1 + 1 + 12
+ * The second 1 is for the minus sign and the 12 is a safety margin.
+ */
+static inline int max_int_length(int bytes)
+{
+ return (bytes * 8 - 1) * 0.30102999566398119521 + 14;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/show.c b/usr/dash/show.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4a049e9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/show.c
@@ -0,0 +1,406 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "options.h"
+
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+static void shtree(union node *, int, char *, FILE*);
+static void shcmd(union node *, FILE *);
+static void sharg(union node *, FILE *);
+static void indent(int, char *, FILE *);
+static void trstring(char *);
+
+
+void
+showtree(union node *n)
+{
+ trputs("showtree called\n");
+ shtree(n, 1, NULL, stdout);
+}
+
+
+static void
+shtree(union node *n, int ind, char *pfx, FILE *fp)
+{
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ const char *s;
+
+ if (n == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ indent(ind, pfx, fp);
+ switch(n->type) {
+ case NSEMI:
+ s = "; ";
+ goto binop;
+ case NAND:
+ s = " && ";
+ goto binop;
+ case NOR:
+ s = " || ";
+binop:
+ shtree(n->nbinary.ch1, ind, NULL, fp);
+ /* if (ind < 0) */
+ fputs(s, fp);
+ shtree(n->nbinary.ch2, ind, NULL, fp);
+ break;
+ case NCMD:
+ shcmd(n, fp);
+ if (ind >= 0)
+ putc('\n', fp);
+ break;
+ case NPIPE:
+ for (lp = n->npipe.cmdlist ; lp ; lp = lp->next) {
+ shcmd(lp->n, fp);
+ if (lp->next)
+ fputs(" | ", fp);
+ }
+ if (n->npipe.backgnd)
+ fputs(" &", fp);
+ if (ind >= 0)
+ putc('\n', fp);
+ break;
+ default:
+ fprintf(fp, "<node type %d>", n->type);
+ if (ind >= 0)
+ putc('\n', fp);
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+static void
+shcmd(union node *cmd, FILE *fp)
+{
+ union node *np;
+ int first;
+ const char *s;
+ int dftfd;
+
+ first = 1;
+ for (np = cmd->ncmd.args ; np ; np = np->narg.next) {
+ if (! first)
+ putchar(' ');
+ sharg(np, fp);
+ first = 0;
+ }
+ for (np = cmd->ncmd.redirect ; np ; np = np->nfile.next) {
+ if (! first)
+ putchar(' ');
+ switch (np->nfile.type) {
+ case NTO: s = ">"; dftfd = 1; break;
+ case NCLOBBER: s = ">|"; dftfd = 1; break;
+ case NAPPEND: s = ">>"; dftfd = 1; break;
+ case NTOFD: s = ">&"; dftfd = 1; break;
+ case NFROM: s = "<"; dftfd = 0; break;
+ case NFROMFD: s = "<&"; dftfd = 0; break;
+ case NFROMTO: s = "<>"; dftfd = 0; break;
+ default: s = "*error*"; dftfd = 0; break;
+ }
+ if (np->nfile.fd != dftfd)
+ fprintf(fp, "%d", np->nfile.fd);
+ fputs(s, fp);
+ if (np->nfile.type == NTOFD || np->nfile.type == NFROMFD) {
+ fprintf(fp, "%d", np->ndup.dupfd);
+ } else {
+ sharg(np->nfile.fname, fp);
+ }
+ first = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+static void
+sharg(union node *arg, FILE *fp)
+{
+ char *p;
+ struct nodelist *bqlist;
+ int subtype;
+
+ if (arg->type != NARG) {
+ printf("<node type %d>\n", arg->type);
+ abort();
+ }
+ bqlist = arg->narg.backquote;
+ for (p = arg->narg.text ; *p ; p++) {
+ switch ((signed char)*p) {
+ case CTLESC:
+ putc(*++p, fp);
+ break;
+ case CTLVAR:
+ putc('$', fp);
+ putc('{', fp);
+ subtype = *++p;
+ if (subtype == VSLENGTH)
+ putc('#', fp);
+
+ while (*p != '=')
+ putc(*p++, fp);
+
+ if (subtype & VSNUL)
+ putc(':', fp);
+
+ switch (subtype & VSTYPE) {
+ case VSNORMAL:
+ putc('}', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSMINUS:
+ putc('-', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSPLUS:
+ putc('+', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSQUESTION:
+ putc('?', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSASSIGN:
+ putc('=', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSTRIMLEFT:
+ putc('#', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSTRIMLEFTMAX:
+ putc('#', fp);
+ putc('#', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSTRIMRIGHT:
+ putc('%', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSTRIMRIGHTMAX:
+ putc('%', fp);
+ putc('%', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSLENGTH:
+ break;
+ default:
+ printf("<subtype %d>", subtype);
+ }
+ break;
+ case CTLENDVAR:
+ putc('}', fp);
+ break;
+ case CTLBACKQ:
+ putc('$', fp);
+ putc('(', fp);
+ shtree(bqlist->n, -1, NULL, fp);
+ putc(')', fp);
+ break;
+ default:
+ putc(*p, fp);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+static void
+indent(int amount, char *pfx, FILE *fp)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0 ; i < amount ; i++) {
+ if (pfx && i == amount - 1)
+ fputs(pfx, fp);
+ putc('\t', fp);
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Debugging stuff.
+ */
+
+
+FILE *tracefile;
+
+
+void
+trputc(int c)
+{
+ if (debug != 1)
+ return;
+ putc(c, tracefile);
+}
+
+void
+trace(const char *fmt, ...)
+{
+ va_list va;
+
+ if (debug != 1)
+ return;
+ va_start(va, fmt);
+ (void) vfprintf(tracefile, fmt, va);
+ va_end(va);
+}
+
+void
+tracev(const char *fmt, va_list va)
+{
+ if (debug != 1)
+ return;
+ (void) vfprintf(tracefile, fmt, va);
+}
+
+
+void
+trputs(const char *s)
+{
+ if (debug != 1)
+ return;
+ fputs(s, tracefile);
+}
+
+
+static void
+trstring(char *s)
+{
+ char *p;
+ char c;
+
+ if (debug != 1)
+ return;
+ putc('"', tracefile);
+ for (p = s ; *p ; p++) {
+ switch ((signed char)*p) {
+ case '\n': c = 'n'; goto backslash;
+ case '\t': c = 't'; goto backslash;
+ case '\r': c = 'r'; goto backslash;
+ case '"': c = '"'; goto backslash;
+ case '\\': c = '\\'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLESC: c = 'e'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLVAR: c = 'v'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLBACKQ: c = 'q'; goto backslash;
+backslash: putc('\\', tracefile);
+ putc(c, tracefile);
+ break;
+ default:
+ if (*p >= ' ' && *p <= '~')
+ putc(*p, tracefile);
+ else {
+ putc('\\', tracefile);
+ putc(*p >> 6 & 03, tracefile);
+ putc(*p >> 3 & 07, tracefile);
+ putc(*p & 07, tracefile);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ putc('"', tracefile);
+}
+
+
+void
+trargs(char **ap)
+{
+ if (debug != 1)
+ return;
+ while (*ap) {
+ trstring(*ap++);
+ if (*ap)
+ putc(' ', tracefile);
+ else
+ putc('\n', tracefile);
+ }
+}
+
+
+void
+opentrace(void)
+{
+ char s[100];
+#ifdef O_APPEND
+ int flags;
+#endif
+
+ if (debug != 1) {
+ if (tracefile)
+ fflush(tracefile);
+ /* leave open because libedit might be using it */
+ return;
+ }
+#ifdef not_this_way
+ {
+ char *p;
+ if ((p = getenv(homestr)) == NULL) {
+ if (geteuid() == 0)
+ p = "/";
+ else
+ p = "/tmp";
+ }
+ scopy(p, s);
+ strcat(s, "/trace");
+ }
+#else
+ scopy("./trace", s);
+#endif /* not_this_way */
+ if (tracefile) {
+#ifndef __KLIBC__
+ if (!freopen(s, "a", tracefile)) {
+#else
+ if (!(!fclose(tracefile) && (tracefile = fopen(s, "a")))) {
+#endif /* __KLIBC__ */
+ fprintf(stderr, "Can't re-open %s\n", s);
+ debug = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+ } else {
+ if ((tracefile = fopen(s, "a")) == NULL) {
+ fprintf(stderr, "Can't open %s\n", s);
+ debug = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+#ifdef O_APPEND
+ if ((flags = fcntl(fileno(tracefile), F_GETFL, 0)) >= 0)
+ fcntl(fileno(tracefile), F_SETFL, flags | O_APPEND);
+#endif
+#ifndef __KLIBC__
+ setlinebuf(tracefile);
+#endif /* __KLIBC__ */
+ fputs("\nTracing started.\n", tracefile);
+}
+#endif /* DEBUG */
diff --git a/usr/dash/show.h b/usr/dash/show.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d0ccac7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/show.h
@@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1995
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)show.h 1.1 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <stdarg.h>
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+union node;
+void showtree(union node *);
+void trace(const char *, ...);
+void tracev(const char *, va_list);
+void trargs(char **);
+void trputc(int);
+void trputs(const char *);
+void opentrace(void);
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/system.c b/usr/dash/system.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..aa1df8a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/system.c
@@ -0,0 +1,199 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 2004
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products
+ * derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef HAVE_ISALPHA
+#define isalnum _isalnum
+#define iscntrl _iscntrl
+#define islower _islower
+#define isspace _isspace
+#define isalpha _isalpha
+#define isdigit _isdigit
+#define isprint _isprint
+#define isupper _isupper
+#define isblank _isblank
+#define isgraph _isgraph
+#define ispunct _ispunct
+#define isxdigit _isxdigit
+#include <ctype.h>
+#undef isalnum
+#undef iscntrl
+#undef islower
+#undef isspace
+#undef isalpha
+#undef isdigit
+#undef isprint
+#undef isupper
+#undef isblank
+#undef isgraph
+#undef ispunct
+#undef isxdigit
+#endif
+
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "error.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "system.h"
+
+#ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY
+void *mempcpy(void *dest, const void *src, size_t n)
+{
+ return memcpy(dest, src, n) + n;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STPCPY
+char *stpcpy(char *dest, const char *src)
+{
+ size_t len = strlen(src);
+ dest[len] = 0;
+ return mempcpy(dest, src, len);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRCHRNUL
+char *strchrnul(const char *s, int c)
+{
+ char *p = strchr(s, c);
+ if (!p)
+ p = (char *)s + strlen(s);
+ return p;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRSIGNAL
+char *strsignal(int sig)
+{
+ static char buf[19];
+
+ if ((unsigned)sig < NSIG && sys_siglist[sig])
+ return (char *)sys_siglist[sig];
+ fmtstr(buf, sizeof(buf), "Signal %d", sig);
+ return buf;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_BSEARCH
+void *bsearch(const void *key, const void *base, size_t nmemb,
+ size_t size, int (*cmp)(const void *, const void *))
+{
+ while (nmemb) {
+ size_t mididx = nmemb / 2;
+ const void *midobj = base + mididx * size;
+ int diff = cmp(key, midobj);
+
+ if (diff == 0)
+ return (void *)midobj;
+
+ if (diff > 0) {
+ base = midobj + size;
+ nmemb -= mididx + 1;
+ } else
+ nmemb = mididx;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SYSCONF
+long sysconf(int name)
+{
+ sh_error("no sysconf for: %d", name);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_ISALPHA
+int isalnum(int c) {
+ return _isalnum(c);
+}
+
+
+int iscntrl(int c) {
+ return _iscntrl(c);
+}
+
+
+int islower(int c) {
+ return _islower(c);
+}
+
+
+int isspace(int c) {
+ return _isspace(c);
+}
+
+
+int isalpha(int c) {
+ return _isalpha(c);
+}
+
+
+int isdigit(int c) {
+ return _isdigit(c);
+}
+
+
+int isprint(int c) {
+ return _isprint(c);
+}
+
+
+int isupper(int c) {
+ return _isupper(c);
+}
+
+
+#if HAVE_DECL_ISBLANK
+int isblank(int c) {
+ return _isblank(c);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+int isgraph(int c) {
+ return _isgraph(c);
+}
+
+
+int ispunct(int c) {
+ return _ispunct(c);
+}
+
+
+int isxdigit(int c) {
+ return _isxdigit(c);
+}
+#endif
+
+#if !HAVE_DECL_ISBLANK
+int isblank(int c) {
+ return c == ' ' || c == '\t';
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/usr/dash/system.h b/usr/dash/system.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c8424f7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/system.h
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 2004
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products
+ * derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#ifndef SSIZE_MAX
+#define SSIZE_MAX ((ssize_t)((size_t)-1 >> 1))
+#endif
+
+static inline void sigclearmask(void)
+{
+#ifdef HAVE_SIGSETMASK
+ sigsetmask(0);
+#else
+ sigset_t set;
+ sigemptyset(&set);
+ sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &set, 0);
+#endif
+}
+
+#ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY
+void *mempcpy(void *, const void *, size_t);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STPCPY
+char *stpcpy(char *, const char *);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRCHRNUL
+char *strchrnul(const char *, int);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRSIGNAL
+char *strsignal(int);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRTOIMAX
+#define strtoimax strtoll
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRTOUMAX
+#define strtoumax strtoull
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_BSEARCH
+void *bsearch(const void *, const void *, size_t, size_t,
+ int (*)(const void *, const void *));
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_KILLPG
+static inline int killpg(pid_t pid, int signal)
+{
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (pid < 0)
+ abort();
+#endif
+ return kill(-pid, signal);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SYSCONF
+#define _SC_CLK_TCK 2
+long sysconf(int) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+#endif
+
+#if !HAVE_DECL_ISBLANK
+int isblank(int c);
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * A trick to suppress uninitialized variable warning without generating any
+ * code
+ */
+#define uninitialized_var(x) x = x
diff --git a/usr/dash/trap.c b/usr/dash/trap.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1e2a867
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/trap.c
@@ -0,0 +1,467 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "nodes.h" /* for other headers */
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+#ifdef HETIO
+#include "hetio.h"
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Sigmode records the current value of the signal handlers for the various
+ * modes. A value of zero means that the current handler is not known.
+ * S_HARD_IGN indicates that the signal was ignored on entry to the shell,
+ */
+
+#define S_DFL 1 /* default signal handling (SIG_DFL) */
+#define S_CATCH 2 /* signal is caught */
+#define S_IGN 3 /* signal is ignored (SIG_IGN) */
+#define S_HARD_IGN 4 /* signal is ignored permenantly */
+#define S_RESET 5 /* temporary - to reset a hard ignored sig */
+
+
+/* trap handler commands */
+static char *trap[NSIG];
+/* number of non-null traps */
+int trapcnt;
+/* current value of signal */
+char sigmode[NSIG - 1];
+/* indicates specified signal received */
+static char gotsig[NSIG - 1];
+/* last pending signal */
+volatile sig_atomic_t pendingsigs;
+/* received SIGCHLD */
+int gotsigchld;
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "trap.h"
+INIT {
+ sigmode[SIGCHLD - 1] = S_DFL;
+ setsignal(SIGCHLD);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * The trap builtin.
+ */
+
+int
+trapcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char *action;
+ char **ap;
+ int signo;
+
+ nextopt(nullstr);
+ ap = argptr;
+ if (!*ap) {
+ for (signo = 0 ; signo < NSIG ; signo++) {
+ if (trap[signo] != NULL) {
+ out1fmt(
+ "trap -- %s %s\n",
+ single_quote(trap[signo]),
+ signal_name(signo)
+ );
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if (!ap[1])
+ action = NULL;
+ else
+ action = *ap++;
+ while (*ap) {
+ if ((signo = decode_signal(*ap, 0)) < 0) {
+ outfmt(out2, "trap: %s: bad trap\n", *ap);
+ return 1;
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ if (action) {
+ if (action[0] == '-' && action[1] == '\0')
+ action = NULL;
+ else {
+ if (*action)
+ trapcnt++;
+ action = savestr(action);
+ }
+ }
+ if (trap[signo]) {
+ if (*trap[signo])
+ trapcnt--;
+ ckfree(trap[signo]);
+ }
+ trap[signo] = action;
+ if (signo != 0)
+ setsignal(signo);
+ INTON;
+ ap++;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Clear traps on a fork.
+ */
+
+void
+clear_traps(void)
+{
+ char **tp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (tp = trap ; tp < &trap[NSIG] ; tp++) {
+ if (*tp && **tp) { /* trap not NULL or SIG_IGN */
+ ckfree(*tp);
+ *tp = NULL;
+ if (tp != &trap[0])
+ setsignal(tp - trap);
+ }
+ }
+ trapcnt = 0;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Set the signal handler for the specified signal. The routine figures
+ * out what it should be set to.
+ */
+
+void
+setsignal(int signo)
+{
+ int action;
+ char *t, tsig;
+ struct sigaction act;
+
+ if ((t = trap[signo]) == NULL)
+ action = S_DFL;
+ else if (*t != '\0')
+ action = S_CATCH;
+ else
+ action = S_IGN;
+ if (rootshell && action == S_DFL) {
+ switch (signo) {
+ case SIGINT:
+ if (iflag || minusc || sflag == 0)
+ action = S_CATCH;
+ break;
+ case SIGQUIT:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (debug)
+ break;
+#endif
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case SIGTERM:
+ if (iflag)
+ action = S_IGN;
+ break;
+#if JOBS
+ case SIGTSTP:
+ case SIGTTOU:
+ if (mflag)
+ action = S_IGN;
+ break;
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (signo == SIGCHLD)
+ action = S_CATCH;
+
+ t = &sigmode[signo - 1];
+ tsig = *t;
+ if (tsig == 0) {
+ /*
+ * current setting unknown
+ */
+ if (sigaction(signo, 0, &act) == -1) {
+ /*
+ * Pretend it worked; maybe we should give a warning
+ * here, but other shells don't. We don't alter
+ * sigmode, so that we retry every time.
+ */
+ return;
+ }
+ if (act.sa_handler == SIG_IGN) {
+ if (mflag && (signo == SIGTSTP ||
+ signo == SIGTTIN || signo == SIGTTOU)) {
+ tsig = S_IGN; /* don't hard ignore these */
+ } else
+ tsig = S_HARD_IGN;
+ } else {
+ tsig = S_RESET; /* force to be set */
+ }
+ }
+ if (tsig == S_HARD_IGN || tsig == action)
+ return;
+ switch (action) {
+ case S_CATCH:
+ act.sa_handler = onsig;
+ break;
+ case S_IGN:
+ act.sa_handler = SIG_IGN;
+ break;
+ default:
+ act.sa_handler = SIG_DFL;
+ }
+ *t = action;
+ act.sa_flags = 0;
+ sigfillset(&act.sa_mask);
+ sigaction(signo, &act, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Ignore a signal.
+ */
+
+void
+ignoresig(int signo)
+{
+ if (sigmode[signo - 1] != S_IGN && sigmode[signo - 1] != S_HARD_IGN) {
+ signal(signo, SIG_IGN);
+ }
+ sigmode[signo - 1] = S_HARD_IGN;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Signal handler.
+ */
+
+void
+onsig(int signo)
+{
+ if (signo == SIGCHLD) {
+ gotsigchld = 1;
+ if (!trap[SIGCHLD])
+ return;
+ }
+
+ gotsig[signo - 1] = 1;
+ pendingsigs = signo;
+
+ if (signo == SIGINT && !trap[SIGINT]) {
+ if (!suppressint)
+ onint();
+ intpending = 1;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to execute a trap. Perhaps we should avoid entering new trap
+ * handlers while we are executing a trap handler.
+ */
+
+void dotrap(void)
+{
+ char *p;
+ char *q;
+ int i;
+ int savestatus;
+
+ savestatus = exitstatus;
+ pendingsigs = 0;
+ barrier();
+
+ for (i = 0, q = gotsig; i < NSIG - 1; i++, q++) {
+ if (!*q)
+ continue;
+ *q = 0;
+
+ p = trap[i + 1];
+ if (!p)
+ continue;
+ evalstring(p, 0);
+ exitstatus = savestatus;
+ if (evalskip)
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Controls whether the shell is interactive or not.
+ */
+
+
+void
+setinteractive(int on)
+{
+ static int is_interactive;
+
+ if (++on == is_interactive)
+ return;
+ is_interactive = on;
+ setsignal(SIGINT);
+ setsignal(SIGQUIT);
+ setsignal(SIGTERM);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to exit the shell.
+ */
+
+void
+exitshell(void)
+{
+ struct jmploc loc;
+ char *p;
+ volatile int status;
+
+#ifdef HETIO
+ hetio_reset_term();
+#endif
+ status = exitstatus;
+ TRACE(("pid %d, exitshell(%d)\n", getpid(), status));
+ if (setjmp(loc.loc)) {
+ if (exception == EXEXIT)
+ status = exitstatus;
+ goto out;
+ }
+ handler = &loc;
+ if ((p = trap[0])) {
+ trap[0] = NULL;
+ evalskip = 0;
+ evalstring(p, 0);
+ }
+out:
+ /*
+ * Disable job control so that whoever had the foreground before we
+ * started can get it back.
+ */
+ if (likely(!setjmp(loc.loc)))
+ setjobctl(0);
+ flushall();
+ _exit(status);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+/*
+ * Decode a signal name
+ */
+int decode_signal(const char *string, int minsig)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ if (is_number(string)) {
+ i = atoi(string);
+ if (i >= NSIG) {
+ return -1;
+ }
+ return i;
+ }
+
+ for ( i = minsig ; i < NSIG ; i++ ) {
+ if ( sys_sigabbrev[i] &&
+ !strcasecmp(string, sys_sigabbrev[i]) )
+ return i;
+ }
+
+#ifdef SIGRTMIN
+ if ( !strncasecmp(string, "RTMIN", 5) ) {
+ char *ep;
+
+ if ( string[5] && string[5] != '+' )
+ return -1;
+ i = SIGRTMIN + strtol(string+5, &ep, 10);
+ if ( *ep || i < SIGRTMIN || i > SIGRTMAX )
+ return -1;
+ return i;
+ }
+
+ if ( !strncasecmp(string, "RTMAX", 5) ) {
+ char *ep;
+
+ if ( string[5] && string[5] != '-' )
+ return -1;
+ i = SIGRTMAX + strtol(string+5, &ep, 10);
+ if ( *ep || i < SIGRTMIN || i > SIGRTMAX )
+ return -1;
+ return i;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return -1;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Human-readable signal name
+ */
+const char *
+signal_name(int sig)
+{
+ static char buf[64];
+
+ if ( sig < 0 || sig >= NSIG ) {
+ return NULL;
+ } else if ( sys_sigabbrev[sig] ) {
+ return sys_sigabbrev[sig];
+#ifdef SIGRTMIN
+ } else if ( sig >= SIGRTMIN && sig <= SIGRTMAX ) {
+ snprintf(buf, sizeof buf, "RTMIN+%d", sig-SIGRTMIN);
+ return buf;
+#endif
+ } else {
+ snprintf(buf, sizeof buf, "%d", sig);
+ return buf;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/trap.h b/usr/dash/trap.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6590be1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/trap.h
@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)trap.h 8.3 (Berkeley) 6/5/95
+ */
+
+#include <signal.h>
+
+extern int trapcnt;
+extern char sigmode[];
+extern volatile sig_atomic_t pendingsigs;
+extern int gotsigchld;
+
+int trapcmd(int, char **);
+void clear_traps(void);
+void setsignal(int);
+void ignoresig(int);
+void onsig(int);
+void dotrap(void);
+void setinteractive(int);
+void exitshell(void) __attribute__((__noreturn__));
+int decode_signal(const char *, int);
+const char *signal_name(int);
+
+static inline int have_traps(void)
+{
+ return trapcnt;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/var.c b/usr/dash/var.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dc90249
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/var.c
@@ -0,0 +1,710 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_PATHS_H
+#include <paths.h>
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Shell variables.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "nodes.h" /* for other headers */
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "mail.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "show.h"
+#ifndef SMALL
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+#endif
+#include "system.h"
+
+
+#define VTABSIZE 39
+
+
+struct localvar_list {
+ struct localvar_list *next;
+ struct localvar *lv;
+};
+
+MKINIT struct localvar_list *localvar_stack;
+
+const char defpathvar[] =
+ "PATH=/usr/local/sbin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/sbin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/bin";
+#ifdef IFS_BROKEN
+const char defifsvar[] = "IFS= \t\n";
+#else
+const char defifs[] = " \t\n";
+#endif
+
+int lineno;
+char linenovar[sizeof("LINENO=")+sizeof(int)*CHAR_BIT/3+1] = "LINENO=";
+
+/* Some macros in var.h depend on the order, add new variables to the end. */
+struct var varinit[] = {
+#if ATTY
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "ATTY\0", 0 },
+#endif
+#ifdef IFS_BROKEN
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, defifsvar, 0 },
+#else
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "IFS\0", 0 },
+#endif
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "MAIL\0", changemail },
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "MAILPATH\0", changemail },
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, defpathvar, changepath },
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, "PS1=$ ", 0 },
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, "PS2=> ", 0 },
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, "PS4=+ ", 0 },
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, "OPTIND=1", getoptsreset },
+#ifdef WITH_LINENO
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, linenovar, 0 },
+#endif
+#ifndef SMALL
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "TERM\0", 0 },
+ { 0, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "HISTSIZE\0", sethistsize },
+#endif
+};
+
+STATIC struct var *vartab[VTABSIZE];
+
+STATIC struct var **hashvar(const char *);
+STATIC int vpcmp(const void *, const void *);
+STATIC struct var **findvar(struct var **, const char *);
+
+/*
+ * Initialize the varable symbol tables and import the environment
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE <unistd.h>
+INCLUDE <sys/types.h>
+INCLUDE <sys/stat.h>
+INCLUDE "cd.h"
+INCLUDE "output.h"
+INCLUDE "var.h"
+MKINIT char **environ;
+INIT {
+ char **envp;
+ static char ppid[32] = "PPID=";
+ const char *p;
+ struct stat st1, st2;
+
+ initvar();
+ for (envp = environ ; *envp ; envp++) {
+ p = endofname(*envp);
+ if (p != *envp && *p == '=') {
+ setvareq(*envp, VEXPORT|VTEXTFIXED);
+ }
+ }
+
+ fmtstr(ppid + 5, sizeof(ppid) - 5, "%ld", (long) getppid());
+ setvareq(ppid, VTEXTFIXED);
+
+ p = lookupvar("PWD");
+ if (p)
+ if (*p != '/' || stat(p, &st1) || stat(".", &st2) ||
+ st1.st_dev != st2.st_dev || st1.st_ino != st2.st_ino)
+ p = 0;
+ setpwd(p, 0);
+}
+
+RESET {
+ unwindlocalvars(0);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * This routine initializes the builtin variables. It is called when the
+ * shell is initialized.
+ */
+
+void
+initvar(void)
+{
+ struct var *vp;
+ struct var *end;
+ struct var **vpp;
+
+ vp = varinit;
+ end = vp + sizeof(varinit) / sizeof(varinit[0]);
+ do {
+ vpp = hashvar(vp->text);
+ vp->next = *vpp;
+ *vpp = vp;
+ } while (++vp < end);
+ /*
+ * PS1 depends on uid
+ */
+ if (!geteuid())
+ vps1.text = "PS1=# ";
+}
+
+/*
+ * Set the value of a variable. The flags argument is ored with the
+ * flags of the variable. If val is NULL, the variable is unset.
+ */
+
+struct var *setvar(const char *name, const char *val, int flags)
+{
+ char *p, *q;
+ size_t namelen;
+ char *nameeq;
+ size_t vallen;
+ struct var *vp;
+
+ q = endofname(name);
+ p = strchrnul(q, '=');
+ namelen = p - name;
+ if (!namelen || p != q)
+ sh_error("%.*s: bad variable name", namelen, name);
+ vallen = 0;
+ if (val == NULL) {
+ flags |= VUNSET;
+ } else {
+ vallen = strlen(val);
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ p = mempcpy(nameeq = ckmalloc(namelen + vallen + 2), name, namelen);
+ if (val) {
+ *p++ = '=';
+ p = mempcpy(p, val, vallen);
+ }
+ *p = '\0';
+ vp = setvareq(nameeq, flags | VNOSAVE);
+ INTON;
+
+ return vp;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Set the given integer as the value of a variable. The flags argument is
+ * ored with the flags of the variable.
+ */
+
+intmax_t setvarint(const char *name, intmax_t val, int flags)
+{
+ int len = max_int_length(sizeof(val));
+ char buf[len];
+
+ fmtstr(buf, len, "%" PRIdMAX, val);
+ setvar(name, buf, flags);
+ return val;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Same as setvar except that the variable and value are passed in
+ * the first argument as name=value. Since the first argument will
+ * be actually stored in the table, it should not be a string that
+ * will go away.
+ * Called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+struct var *setvareq(char *s, int flags)
+{
+ struct var *vp, **vpp;
+
+ vpp = hashvar(s);
+ flags |= (VEXPORT & (((unsigned) (1 - aflag)) - 1));
+ vpp = findvar(vpp, s);
+ vp = *vpp;
+ if (vp) {
+ if (vp->flags & VREADONLY) {
+ const char *n;
+
+ if (flags & VNOSAVE)
+ free(s);
+ n = vp->text;
+ sh_error("%.*s: is read only", strchrnul(n, '=') - n,
+ n);
+ }
+
+ if (flags & VNOSET)
+ goto out;
+
+ if (vp->func && (flags & VNOFUNC) == 0)
+ (*vp->func)(strchrnul(s, '=') + 1);
+
+ if ((vp->flags & (VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK)) == 0)
+ ckfree(vp->text);
+
+ if (((flags & (VEXPORT|VREADONLY|VSTRFIXED|VUNSET)) |
+ (vp->flags & VSTRFIXED)) == VUNSET) {
+ *vpp = vp->next;
+ ckfree(vp);
+out_free:
+ if ((flags & (VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK|VNOSAVE)) == VNOSAVE)
+ ckfree(s);
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ flags |= vp->flags & ~(VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK|VNOSAVE|VUNSET);
+ } else {
+ if (flags & VNOSET)
+ goto out;
+ if ((flags & (VEXPORT|VREADONLY|VSTRFIXED|VUNSET)) == VUNSET)
+ goto out_free;
+ /* not found */
+ vp = ckmalloc(sizeof (*vp));
+ vp->next = *vpp;
+ vp->func = NULL;
+ *vpp = vp;
+ }
+ if (!(flags & (VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK|VNOSAVE)))
+ s = savestr(s);
+ vp->text = s;
+ vp->flags = flags;
+
+out:
+ return vp;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Process a linked list of variable assignments.
+ */
+
+void
+listsetvar(struct strlist *list, int flags)
+{
+ struct strlist *lp;
+
+ lp = list;
+ if (!lp)
+ return;
+ INTOFF;
+ do {
+ setvareq(lp->text, flags);
+ } while ((lp = lp->next));
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Find the value of a variable. Returns NULL if not set.
+ */
+
+char *
+lookupvar(const char *name)
+{
+ struct var *v;
+
+ if ((v = *findvar(hashvar(name), name)) && !(v->flags & VUNSET)) {
+#ifdef WITH_LINENO
+ if (v == &vlineno && v->text == linenovar) {
+ fmtstr(linenovar+7, sizeof(linenovar)-7, "%d", lineno);
+ }
+#endif
+ return strchrnul(v->text, '=') + 1;
+ }
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+intmax_t lookupvarint(const char *name)
+{
+ return atomax(lookupvar(name) ?: nullstr, 0);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Generate a list of variables satisfying the given conditions.
+ */
+
+char **
+listvars(int on, int off, char ***end)
+{
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp;
+ char **ep;
+ int mask;
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(ep);
+ vpp = vartab;
+ mask = on | off;
+ do {
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vp = vp->next)
+ if ((vp->flags & mask) == on) {
+ if (ep == stackstrend())
+ ep = growstackstr();
+ *ep++ = (char *) vp->text;
+ }
+ } while (++vpp < vartab + VTABSIZE);
+ if (ep == stackstrend())
+ ep = growstackstr();
+ if (end)
+ *end = ep;
+ *ep++ = NULL;
+ return grabstackstr(ep);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * POSIX requires that 'set' (but not export or readonly) output the
+ * variables in lexicographic order - by the locale's collating order (sigh).
+ * Maybe we could keep them in an ordered balanced binary tree
+ * instead of hashed lists.
+ * For now just roll 'em through qsort for printing...
+ */
+
+int
+showvars(const char *prefix, int on, int off)
+{
+ const char *sep;
+ char **ep, **epend;
+
+ ep = listvars(on, off, &epend);
+ qsort(ep, epend - ep, sizeof(char *), vpcmp);
+
+ sep = *prefix ? spcstr : prefix;
+
+ for (; ep < epend; ep++) {
+ const char *p;
+ const char *q;
+
+ p = strchrnul(*ep, '=');
+ q = nullstr;
+ if (*p)
+ q = single_quote(++p);
+
+ out1fmt("%s%s%.*s%s\n", prefix, sep, (int)(p - *ep), *ep, q);
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The export and readonly commands.
+ */
+
+int
+exportcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ struct var *vp;
+ char *name;
+ const char *p;
+ char **aptr;
+ int flag = argv[0][0] == 'r'? VREADONLY : VEXPORT;
+ int notp;
+
+ notp = nextopt("p") - 'p';
+ if (notp && ((name = *(aptr = argptr)))) {
+ do {
+ if ((p = strchr(name, '=')) != NULL) {
+ p++;
+ } else {
+ if ((vp = *findvar(hashvar(name), name))) {
+ vp->flags |= flag;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ setvar(name, p, flag);
+ } while ((name = *++aptr) != NULL);
+ } else {
+ showvars(argv[0], flag, 0);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * The "local" command.
+ */
+
+int
+localcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char *name;
+
+ if (!localvar_stack)
+ sh_error("not in a function");
+
+ argv = argptr;
+ while ((name = *argv++) != NULL) {
+ mklocal(name);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Make a variable a local variable. When a variable is made local, it's
+ * value and flags are saved in a localvar structure. The saved values
+ * will be restored when the shell function returns. We handle the name
+ * "-" as a special case.
+ */
+
+void mklocal(char *name)
+{
+ struct localvar *lvp;
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ lvp = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct localvar));
+ if (name[0] == '-' && name[1] == '\0') {
+ char *p;
+ p = ckmalloc(sizeof(optlist));
+ lvp->text = memcpy(p, optlist, sizeof(optlist));
+ vp = NULL;
+ } else {
+ char *eq;
+
+ vpp = hashvar(name);
+ vp = *findvar(vpp, name);
+ eq = strchr(name, '=');
+ if (vp == NULL) {
+ if (eq)
+ vp = setvareq(name, VSTRFIXED);
+ else
+ vp = setvar(name, NULL, VSTRFIXED);
+ lvp->flags = VUNSET;
+ } else {
+ lvp->text = vp->text;
+ lvp->flags = vp->flags;
+ vp->flags |= VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED;
+ if (eq)
+ setvareq(name, 0);
+ }
+ }
+ lvp->vp = vp;
+ lvp->next = localvar_stack->lv;
+ localvar_stack->lv = lvp;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called after a function returns.
+ * Interrupts must be off.
+ */
+
+void
+poplocalvars(int keep)
+{
+ struct localvar_list *ll;
+ struct localvar *lvp, *next;
+ struct var *vp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ ll = localvar_stack;
+ localvar_stack = ll->next;
+
+ next = ll->lv;
+ ckfree(ll);
+
+ while ((lvp = next) != NULL) {
+ next = lvp->next;
+ vp = lvp->vp;
+ TRACE(("poplocalvar %s", vp ? vp->text : "-"));
+ if (keep) {
+ int bits = VSTRFIXED;
+
+ if (lvp->flags != VUNSET) {
+ if (vp->text == lvp->text)
+ bits |= VTEXTFIXED;
+ else if (!(lvp->flags & (VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK)))
+ ckfree(lvp->text);
+ }
+
+ vp->flags &= ~bits;
+ vp->flags |= (lvp->flags & bits);
+
+ if ((vp->flags &
+ (VEXPORT|VREADONLY|VSTRFIXED|VUNSET)) == VUNSET)
+ unsetvar(vp->text);
+ } else if (vp == NULL) { /* $- saved */
+ memcpy(optlist, lvp->text, sizeof(optlist));
+ ckfree(lvp->text);
+ optschanged();
+ } else if (lvp->flags == VUNSET) {
+ vp->flags &= ~(VSTRFIXED|VREADONLY);
+ unsetvar(vp->text);
+ } else {
+ if (vp->func)
+ (*vp->func)(strchrnul(lvp->text, '=') + 1);
+ if ((vp->flags & (VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK)) == 0)
+ ckfree(vp->text);
+ vp->flags = lvp->flags;
+ vp->text = lvp->text;
+ }
+ ckfree(lvp);
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Create a new localvar environment.
+ */
+struct localvar_list *pushlocalvars(void)
+{
+ struct localvar_list *ll;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ ll = ckmalloc(sizeof(*ll));
+ ll->lv = NULL;
+ ll->next = localvar_stack;
+ localvar_stack = ll;
+ INTON;
+
+ return ll->next;
+}
+
+
+void unwindlocalvars(struct localvar_list *stop)
+{
+ while (localvar_stack != stop)
+ poplocalvars(0);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * The unset builtin command. We unset the function before we unset the
+ * variable to allow a function to be unset when there is a readonly variable
+ * with the same name.
+ */
+
+int
+unsetcmd(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ char **ap;
+ int i;
+ int flag = 0;
+
+ while ((i = nextopt("vf")) != '\0') {
+ flag = i;
+ }
+
+ for (ap = argptr; *ap ; ap++) {
+ if (flag != 'f') {
+ unsetvar(*ap);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (flag != 'v')
+ unsetfunc(*ap);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Unset the specified variable.
+ */
+
+void unsetvar(const char *s)
+{
+ setvar(s, 0, 0);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Find the appropriate entry in the hash table from the name.
+ */
+
+STATIC struct var **
+hashvar(const char *p)
+{
+ unsigned int hashval;
+
+ hashval = ((unsigned char) *p) << 4;
+ while (*p && *p != '=')
+ hashval += (unsigned char) *p++;
+ return &vartab[hashval % VTABSIZE];
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Compares two strings up to the first = or '\0'. The first
+ * string must be terminated by '='; the second may be terminated by
+ * either '=' or '\0'.
+ */
+
+int
+varcmp(const char *p, const char *q)
+{
+ int c, d;
+
+ while ((c = *p) == (d = *q)) {
+ if (!c || c == '=')
+ goto out;
+ p++;
+ q++;
+ }
+ if (c == '=')
+ c = 0;
+ if (d == '=')
+ d = 0;
+out:
+ return c - d;
+}
+
+STATIC int
+vpcmp(const void *a, const void *b)
+{
+ return varcmp(*(const char **)a, *(const char **)b);
+}
+
+STATIC struct var **
+findvar(struct var **vpp, const char *name)
+{
+ for (; *vpp; vpp = &(*vpp)->next) {
+ if (varequal((*vpp)->text, name)) {
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ return vpp;
+}
diff --git a/usr/dash/var.h b/usr/dash/var.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1a06a3c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/usr/dash/var.h
@@ -0,0 +1,173 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * Copyright (c) 1997-2005
+ * Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)var.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/4/95
+ */
+
+#include <inttypes.h>
+
+/*
+ * Shell variables.
+ */
+
+/* flags */
+#define VEXPORT 0x01 /* variable is exported */
+#define VREADONLY 0x02 /* variable cannot be modified */
+#define VSTRFIXED 0x04 /* variable struct is statically allocated */
+#define VTEXTFIXED 0x08 /* text is statically allocated */
+#define VSTACK 0x10 /* text is allocated on the stack */
+#define VUNSET 0x20 /* the variable is not set */
+#define VNOFUNC 0x40 /* don't call the callback function */
+#define VNOSET 0x80 /* do not set variable - just readonly test */
+#define VNOSAVE 0x100 /* when text is on the heap before setvareq */
+
+
+struct var {
+ struct var *next; /* next entry in hash list */
+ int flags; /* flags are defined above */
+ const char *text; /* name=value */
+ void (*func)(const char *);
+ /* function to be called when */
+ /* the variable gets set/unset */
+};
+
+
+struct localvar {
+ struct localvar *next; /* next local variable in list */
+ struct var *vp; /* the variable that was made local */
+ int flags; /* saved flags */
+ const char *text; /* saved text */
+};
+
+struct localvar_list;
+
+
+extern struct localvar *localvars;
+extern struct var varinit[];
+
+#if ATTY
+#define vatty varinit[0]
+#define vifs varinit[1]
+#else
+#define vifs varinit[0]
+#endif
+#define vmail (&vifs)[1]
+#define vmpath (&vmail)[1]
+#define vpath (&vmpath)[1]
+#define vps1 (&vpath)[1]
+#define vps2 (&vps1)[1]
+#define vps4 (&vps2)[1]
+#define voptind (&vps4)[1]
+#ifdef WITH_LINENO
+#define vlineno (&voptind)[1]
+#endif
+#ifndef SMALL
+#ifdef WITH_LINENO
+#define vterm (&vlineno)[1]
+#else
+#define vterm (&voptind)[1]
+#endif
+#define vhistsize (&vterm)[1]
+#endif
+
+#ifdef IFS_BROKEN
+extern const char defifsvar[];
+#define defifs (defifsvar + 4)
+#else
+extern const char defifs[];
+#endif
+extern const char defpathvar[];
+#define defpath (defpathvar + 5)
+
+extern int lineno;
+extern char linenovar[];
+
+/*
+ * The following macros access the values of the above variables.
+ * They have to skip over the name. They return the null string
+ * for unset variables.
+ */
+
+#define ifsval() (vifs.text + 4)
+#define ifsset() ((vifs.flags & VUNSET) == 0)
+#define mailval() (vmail.text + 5)
+#define mpathval() (vmpath.text + 9)
+#define pathval() (vpath.text + 5)
+#define ps1val() (vps1.text + 4)
+#define ps2val() (vps2.text + 4)
+#define ps4val() (vps4.text + 4)
+#define optindval() (voptind.text + 7)
+#define linenoval() (vlineno.text + 7)
+#ifndef SMALL
+#define histsizeval() (vhistsize.text + 9)
+#define termval() (vterm.text + 5)
+#endif
+
+#if ATTY
+#define attyset() ((vatty.flags & VUNSET) == 0)
+#endif
+#define mpathset() ((vmpath.flags & VUNSET) == 0)
+
+void initvar(void);
+struct var *setvar(const char *name, const char *val, int flags);
+intmax_t setvarint(const char *, intmax_t, int);
+struct var *setvareq(char *s, int flags);
+struct strlist;
+void listsetvar(struct strlist *, int);
+char *lookupvar(const char *);
+intmax_t lookupvarint(const char *);
+char **listvars(int, int, char ***);
+#define environment() listvars(VEXPORT, VUNSET, 0)
+int showvars(const char *, int, int);
+int exportcmd(int, char **);
+int localcmd(int, char **);
+void mklocal(char *);
+struct localvar_list *pushlocalvars(void);
+void poplocalvars(int);
+void unwindlocalvars(struct localvar_list *stop);
+int unsetcmd(int, char **);
+void unsetvar(const char *);
+int varcmp(const char *, const char *);
+
+static inline int varequal(const char *a, const char *b) {
+ return !varcmp(a, b);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Search the environment of a builtin command.
+ */
+
+static inline char *bltinlookup(const char *name)
+{
+ return lookupvar(name);
+}